* gdb.texinfo: Add documentation for process record and replay.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @copying
47 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
48 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
49 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
50
51 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
52 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
53 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
54 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
55 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
56 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
57
58 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
59 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
60 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
61 @end copying
62
63 @ifnottex
64 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
65
66 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
67 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
68 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
69 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
70 @end ifset
71 Version @value{GDBVN}.
72
73 @insertcopying
74 @end ifnottex
75
76 @titlepage
77 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
78 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
79 @sp 1
80 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
81 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
82 @sp 1
83 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
84 @end ifset
85 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
86 @page
87 @tex
88 {\parskip=0pt
89 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
90 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
91 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
92 }
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
97 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
98 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
99 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
100
101 @insertcopying
102 @page
103 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
104 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
105 software in general. We will miss him.
106 @end titlepage
107 @page
108
109 @ifnottex
110 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
111
112 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
113
114 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
115
116 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
117 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
118 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
119 @end ifset
120 Version @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
137 * Process record and replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
138 * Stack:: Examining the stack
139 * Source:: Examining source files
140 * Data:: Examining data
141 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
142 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
143 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
144
145 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
146
147 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
148 * Altering:: Altering execution
149 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
150 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
151 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
152 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
153 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
154 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
155 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
156 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
157 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
158 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
159 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
160
161 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
162
163 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
164 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
165 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
166 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
167 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
168 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
169 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
170 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
171 @value{GDBN}
172 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
173 the operating system
174 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
175 how you can copy and share GDB
176 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
177 * Index:: Index
178 @end menu
179
180 @end ifnottex
181
182 @contents
183
184 @node Summary
185 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
186
187 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
188 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
189 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
190
191 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
192 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
193
194 @itemize @bullet
195 @item
196 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
197
198 @item
199 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
200
201 @item
202 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
203
204 @item
205 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
206 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
207 @end itemize
208
209 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
210 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
211 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
212
213 @cindex Modula-2
214 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
215 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
216
217 @cindex Pascal
218 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
219 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
220 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
221 syntax.
222
223 @cindex Fortran
224 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
225 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
226 underscore.
227
228 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
229 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
230
231 @menu
232 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
233 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
234 @end menu
235
236 @node Free Software
237 @unnumberedsec Free Software
238
239 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
240 General Public License
241 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
242 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
243 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
244 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
245 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
246 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
247
248 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
249 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
250 from anyone else.
251
252 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
253
254 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
255 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
256 include with the free software. Many of our most important
257 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
258 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
259 when an important free software package does not come with a free
260 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
261 gaps today.
262
263 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
264 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
265 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
266 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
267 them from the free software world.
268
269 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
270 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
271 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
272 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
273 contract to make it non-free.
274
275 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
276 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
277 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
278 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
279 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
280 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
281 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
282
283 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
284 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
285 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
286 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
287
288 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
289 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
290 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
291 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
292 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
293 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
294 community.
295
296 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
297 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
298 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
299 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
300 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
301 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
302 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
303 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
304 of the manual.
305
306 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
307 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
308 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
309 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
310 manual to replace it.
311
312 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
313 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
314 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
315 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
316 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
317 the free software community.
318
319 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
320 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
321 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
322 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
323 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
324 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
325 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
326 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
327 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
328
329 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
330 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
331 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
332 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
333 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
334 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
335 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
336 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
337
338 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
339 published by other publishers, at
340 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
341
342 @node Contributors
343 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
344
345 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
346 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
347 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
348 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
349 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
350 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
351 blow-by-blow account.
352
353 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
354
355 @quotation
356 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
357 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
358 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
359 @end quotation
360
361 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
362 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
363 releases:
364 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
365 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
366 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
367 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
368 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
369 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
370 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
371 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
372 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
373
374 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
375 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
376
377 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
378 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
379 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
380 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
381 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
382
383 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
384 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
385 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
386
387 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
388 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
389
390 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
391
392 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
393 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
394 support.
395 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
396 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
397 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
398 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
399 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
400 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
401 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
402 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
403 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
404 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
405 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
406 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
407 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
408 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
409 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
410 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
411
412 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
413
414 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
415 libraries.
416
417 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
418 about several machine instruction sets.
419
420 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
421 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
422 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
423 and RDI targets, respectively.
424
425 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
426 command-line editing and command history.
427
428 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
429 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
430
431 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
432 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
433 symbols.
434
435 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
436 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
437
438 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
439
440 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
441 processors.
442
443 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
444
445 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
446
447 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
448
449 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
450 watchpoints.
451
452 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
453
454 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
455
456 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
457 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
458
459 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
460 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
461 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
462 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
463 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
464 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
465 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
466
467 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
468 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
469
470 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
471 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
472 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
473 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
474 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
475 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
476 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
477 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
478 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
479 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
480 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
481 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
482 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
483 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
484 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
485
486 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
487 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
488
489 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
490 Hat.
491
492 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
493 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
494 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
495 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
496 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
497 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
498
499 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
500 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
501 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
502 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
503 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
504 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
505 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
506 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
507 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
508 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
509 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
510 Weigand.
511
512 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
513 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
514 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
515 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
516
517 @node Sample Session
518 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
519
520 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
521 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
522 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
523
524 @iftex
525 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
526 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
527 @end iftex
528
529 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
530 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
531
532 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
533 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
534 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
535 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
536 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
537 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
538 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
539 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
540 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
541
542 @smallexample
543 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
544 $ @b{./m4}
545 @b{define(foo,0000)}
546
547 @b{foo}
548 0000
549 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
550
551 @b{bar}
552 0000
553 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
554
555 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
556 @b{baz}
557 @b{Ctrl-d}
558 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
559 @end smallexample
560
561 @noindent
562 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
563
564 @smallexample
565 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
566 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
567 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
568 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
569 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
570 the conditions.
571 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
572 for details.
573
574 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
575 (@value{GDBP})
576 @end smallexample
577
578 @noindent
579 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
580 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
581 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
582 that examples fit in this manual.
583
584 @smallexample
585 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
590 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
591 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
592 @code{break} command.
593
594 @smallexample
595 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
596 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
597 @end smallexample
598
599 @noindent
600 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
601 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
602 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
603
604 @smallexample
605 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
606 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
607 @b{define(foo,0000)}
608
609 @b{foo}
610 0000
611 @end smallexample
612
613 @noindent
614 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
615 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
616 context where it stops.
617
618 @smallexample
619 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
620
621 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
622 at builtin.c:879
623 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
628 the next line of the current function.
629
630 @smallexample
631 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
632 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
633 : nil,
634 @end smallexample
635
636 @noindent
637 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
638 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
639 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
640 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
641
642 @smallexample
643 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
644 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
645 at input.c:530
646 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
647 @end smallexample
648
649 @noindent
650 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
651 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
652 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
653 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
654 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
655 stack frame for each active subroutine.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
659 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
660 at input.c:530
661 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
662 at builtin.c:882
663 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
664 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
665 at macro.c:71
666 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
667 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
668 @end smallexample
669
670 @noindent
671 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
672 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
673 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
674
675 @smallexample
676 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
677 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
678 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
679 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
680 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
681 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
682 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
683 : xstrdup(rq);
684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
685 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
686 @end smallexample
687
688 @noindent
689 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
690 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
691 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
692 (@code{print}) to see their values.
693
694 @smallexample
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
696 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
698 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
699 @end smallexample
700
701 @noindent
702 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
703 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
704 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
705
706 @smallexample
707 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
708 533 xfree(rquote);
709 534
710 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
711 : xstrdup (lq);
712 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
713 : xstrdup (rq);
714 537
715 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
716 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
717 540 @}
718 541
719 542 void
720 @end smallexample
721
722 @noindent
723 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
724 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
725
726 @smallexample
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
728 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
730 540 @}
731 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
732 $3 = 9
733 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
734 $4 = 7
735 @end smallexample
736
737 @noindent
738 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
739 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
740 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
741 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
742 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
743 assignments.
744
745 @smallexample
746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
747 $5 = 7
748 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
749 $6 = 9
750 @end smallexample
751
752 @noindent
753 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
754 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
755 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
756 example that caused trouble initially:
757
758 @smallexample
759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
760 Continuing.
761
762 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
763
764 baz
765 0000
766 @end smallexample
767
768 @noindent
769 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
770 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
771 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
772
773 @smallexample
774 @b{Ctrl-d}
775 Program exited normally.
776 @end smallexample
777
778 @noindent
779 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
780 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
781 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
782
783 @smallexample
784 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
785 @end smallexample
786
787 @node Invocation
788 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
789
790 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
791 The essentials are:
792 @itemize @bullet
793 @item
794 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
795 @item
796 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
797 @end itemize
798
799 @menu
800 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
801 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
802 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
803 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
804 @end menu
805
806 @node Invoking GDB
807 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
808
809 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
810 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
811
812 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
813 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
814
815 The command-line options described here are designed
816 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
817 options may effectively be unavailable.
818
819 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
820 specifying an executable program:
821
822 @smallexample
823 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
824 @end smallexample
825
826 @noindent
827 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
828 specified:
829
830 @smallexample
831 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
832 @end smallexample
833
834 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
835 to debug a running process:
836
837 @smallexample
838 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
839 @end smallexample
840
841 @noindent
842 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
843 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
844
845 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
846 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
847 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
848 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
849 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
850
851 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
852 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
853 option processing.
854 @smallexample
855 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
856 @end smallexample
857 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
858 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
859
860 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
861 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
862
863 @smallexample
864 @value{GDBP} -silent
865 @end smallexample
866
867 @noindent
868 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
869 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
870
871 @noindent
872 Type
873
874 @smallexample
875 @value{GDBP} -help
876 @end smallexample
877
878 @noindent
879 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
880 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
881
882 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
883 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
884 @samp{-x} option is used.
885
886
887 @menu
888 * File Options:: Choosing files
889 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
890 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
891 @end menu
892
893 @node File Options
894 @subsection Choosing Files
895
896 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
897 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
898 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
899 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
900 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
901 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
902 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
903 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
904 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
905 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
906 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
907 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
908 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
909
910 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
911 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
912 argument and ignore it.
913
914 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
915 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
916 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
917 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
918 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
919
920 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
921 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
922 @c it.
923
924 @table @code
925 @item -symbols @var{file}
926 @itemx -s @var{file}
927 @cindex @code{--symbols}
928 @cindex @code{-s}
929 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
930
931 @item -exec @var{file}
932 @itemx -e @var{file}
933 @cindex @code{--exec}
934 @cindex @code{-e}
935 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
936 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
937
938 @item -se @var{file}
939 @cindex @code{--se}
940 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
941 file.
942
943 @item -core @var{file}
944 @itemx -c @var{file}
945 @cindex @code{--core}
946 @cindex @code{-c}
947 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
948
949 @item -pid @var{number}
950 @itemx -p @var{number}
951 @cindex @code{--pid}
952 @cindex @code{-p}
953 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
954
955 @item -command @var{file}
956 @itemx -x @var{file}
957 @cindex @code{--command}
958 @cindex @code{-x}
959 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
960 Files,, Command files}.
961
962 @item -eval-command @var{command}
963 @itemx -ex @var{command}
964 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
965 @cindex @code{-ex}
966 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
967
968 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
969 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
970
971 @smallexample
972 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
973 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
974 @end smallexample
975
976 @item -directory @var{directory}
977 @itemx -d @var{directory}
978 @cindex @code{--directory}
979 @cindex @code{-d}
980 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
981
982 @item -r
983 @itemx -readnow
984 @cindex @code{--readnow}
985 @cindex @code{-r}
986 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
987 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
988 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
989
990 @end table
991
992 @node Mode Options
993 @subsection Choosing Modes
994
995 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
996 batch mode or quiet mode.
997
998 @table @code
999 @item -nx
1000 @itemx -n
1001 @cindex @code{--nx}
1002 @cindex @code{-n}
1003 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1004 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1005 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1006 Files}.
1007
1008 @item -quiet
1009 @itemx -silent
1010 @itemx -q
1011 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1012 @cindex @code{--silent}
1013 @cindex @code{-q}
1014 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1015 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1016
1017 @item -batch
1018 @cindex @code{--batch}
1019 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1020 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1021 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1022 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1023 in the command files.
1024
1025 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1026 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1027 make this more useful, the message
1028
1029 @smallexample
1030 Program exited normally.
1031 @end smallexample
1032
1033 @noindent
1034 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1035 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1036 mode.
1037
1038 @item -batch-silent
1039 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1040 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1041 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1042 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1043 for an interactive session.
1044
1045 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1046 messages, for example.
1047
1048 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1049 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1050
1051 @item -return-child-result
1052 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1053 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1054 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1055
1056 @itemize @bullet
1057 @item
1058 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1059 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1060 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1061 @item
1062 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1063 @item
1064 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1065 the exit code will be -1.
1066 @end itemize
1067
1068 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1069 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1070 interface.
1071
1072 @item -nowindows
1073 @itemx -nw
1074 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1075 @cindex @code{-nw}
1076 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1077 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1078 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1079
1080 @item -windows
1081 @itemx -w
1082 @cindex @code{--windows}
1083 @cindex @code{-w}
1084 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1085 used if possible.
1086
1087 @item -cd @var{directory}
1088 @cindex @code{--cd}
1089 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1090 instead of the current directory.
1091
1092 @item -fullname
1093 @itemx -f
1094 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1095 @cindex @code{-f}
1096 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1097 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1098 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1099 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1100 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1101 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1102 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1103 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1104 frame.
1105
1106 @item -epoch
1107 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1108 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1109 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1110 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1111 separate window.
1112
1113 @item -annotate @var{level}
1114 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1115 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1116 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1117 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1118 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1119 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1120 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1121 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1122 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1123
1124 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1125 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1126
1127 @item --args
1128 @cindex @code{--args}
1129 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1130 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1131 This option stops option processing.
1132
1133 @item -baud @var{bps}
1134 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1135 @cindex @code{--baud}
1136 @cindex @code{-b}
1137 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1138 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1139
1140 @item -l @var{timeout}
1141 @cindex @code{-l}
1142 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1143 for remote debugging.
1144
1145 @item -tty @var{device}
1146 @itemx -t @var{device}
1147 @cindex @code{--tty}
1148 @cindex @code{-t}
1149 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1150 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1151
1152 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1153 @item -tui
1154 @cindex @code{--tui}
1155 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1156 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1157 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1158 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1159 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1160 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1161 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1162
1163 @c @item -xdb
1164 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1165 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1166 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1167 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1168 @c systems.
1169
1170 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1171 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1172 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1173 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1174 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1175 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1176
1177 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1178 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1179 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1180 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1181 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1182 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1183
1184 @item -write
1185 @cindex @code{--write}
1186 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1187 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1188 (@pxref{Patching}).
1189
1190 @item -statistics
1191 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1192 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1193 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1194
1195 @item -version
1196 @cindex @code{--version}
1197 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1198 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1199
1200 @end table
1201
1202 @node Startup
1203 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1204 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1205
1206 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1207
1208 @enumerate
1209 @item
1210 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1211 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1212
1213 @item
1214 @cindex init file
1215 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1216 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1217 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1218 that file.
1219
1220 @item
1221 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1222 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1223 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1224 that file.
1225
1226 @item
1227 Processes command line options and operands.
1228
1229 @item
1230 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1231 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1232 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1233 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1234 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1235 @value{GDBN}.
1236
1237 @item
1238 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1239 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1240
1241 @item
1242 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1243 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1244 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1245 @end enumerate
1246
1247 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1248 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1249 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1250 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1251 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1252 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1253
1254 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1255 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1256
1257 @cindex init file name
1258 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1259 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1260 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1261 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1262 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1263 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1264 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1265 the file to the standard name.
1266
1267
1268 @node Quitting GDB
1269 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1270 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1271 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1272
1273 @table @code
1274 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1275 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1276 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1277 @itemx q
1278 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1279 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1280 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1281 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1282 error code.
1283 @end table
1284
1285 @cindex interrupt
1286 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1287 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1288 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1289 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1290 until a time when it is safe.
1291
1292 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1293 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1294 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1295
1296 @node Shell Commands
1297 @section Shell Commands
1298
1299 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1300 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1301 just use the @code{shell} command.
1302
1303 @table @code
1304 @kindex shell
1305 @cindex shell escape
1306 @item shell @var{command string}
1307 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1308 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1309 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1310 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1311 @end table
1312
1313 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1314 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1315 @value{GDBN}:
1316
1317 @table @code
1318 @kindex make
1319 @cindex calling make
1320 @item make @var{make-args}
1321 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1322 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1323 @end table
1324
1325 @node Logging Output
1326 @section Logging Output
1327 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1328 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1329
1330 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1331 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1332
1333 @table @code
1334 @kindex set logging
1335 @item set logging on
1336 Enable logging.
1337 @item set logging off
1338 Disable logging.
1339 @cindex logging file name
1340 @item set logging file @var{file}
1341 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1342 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1343 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1344 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1345 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1346 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1347 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1348 @kindex show logging
1349 @item show logging
1350 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1351 @end table
1352
1353 @node Commands
1354 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1355
1356 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1357 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1358 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1359 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1360 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1361
1362 @menu
1363 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1364 * Completion:: Command completion
1365 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1366 @end menu
1367
1368 @node Command Syntax
1369 @section Command Syntax
1370
1371 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1372 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1373 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1374 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1375 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1376 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1377
1378 @cindex abbreviation
1379 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1380 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1381 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1382 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1383 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1384 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1385 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1386
1387 @cindex repeating commands
1388 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1389 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1390 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1391 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1392 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1393 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1394 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1395
1396 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1397 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1398 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1399
1400 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1401 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1402 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1403 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1404 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1405
1406 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1407 @cindex comment
1408 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1409 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1410 Files,,Command Files}).
1411
1412 @cindex repeating command sequences
1413 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1414 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1415 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1416 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1417 for editing.
1418
1419 @node Completion
1420 @section Command Completion
1421
1422 @cindex completion
1423 @cindex word completion
1424 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1425 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1426 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1427 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1428
1429 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1430 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1431 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1432 enter it). For example, if you type
1433
1434 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1435 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1436 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1437 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1438 @smallexample
1439 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1440 @end smallexample
1441
1442 @noindent
1443 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1444 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1445
1446 @smallexample
1447 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1448 @end smallexample
1449
1450 @noindent
1451 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1452 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1453 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1454 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1455 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1456 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1457
1458 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1459 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1460 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1461 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1462 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1463 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1464 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1465 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1466 example:
1467
1468 @smallexample
1469 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1470 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1471 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1472 make_abs_section make_function_type
1473 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1474 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1475 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1476 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1477 @end smallexample
1478
1479 @noindent
1480 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1481 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1482 command.
1483
1484 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1485 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1486 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1487 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1488 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1489
1490 @cindex quotes in commands
1491 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1492 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1493 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1494 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1495 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1496 @value{GDBN} commands.
1497
1498 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1499 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1500 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1501 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1502 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1503 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1504 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1505 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1506 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1507 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1508 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1509
1510 @smallexample
1511 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1512 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1513 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1514 @end smallexample
1515
1516 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1517 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1518 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1519 place:
1520
1521 @smallexample
1522 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1523 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1524 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1525 @end smallexample
1526
1527 @noindent
1528 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1529 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1530 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1531
1532 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1533 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1534 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1535 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1536
1537 @cindex completion of structure field names
1538 @cindex structure field name completion
1539 @cindex completion of union field names
1540 @cindex union field name completion
1541 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1542 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1543 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1544 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1545 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1546 left-hand-side:
1547
1548 @smallexample
1549 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1550 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1551 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1552 @end smallexample
1553
1554 @noindent
1555 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1556 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1557 follows:
1558
1559 @smallexample
1560 struct ui_file
1561 @{
1562 int *magic;
1563 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1564 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1565 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1566 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1567 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1568 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1569 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1570 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1571 void *to_data;
1572 @}
1573 @end smallexample
1574
1575
1576 @node Help
1577 @section Getting Help
1578 @cindex online documentation
1579 @kindex help
1580
1581 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1582 using the command @code{help}.
1583
1584 @table @code
1585 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1586 @item help
1587 @itemx h
1588 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1589 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1590
1591 @smallexample
1592 (@value{GDBP}) help
1593 List of classes of commands:
1594
1595 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1596 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1597 data -- Examining data
1598 files -- Specifying and examining files
1599 internals -- Maintenance commands
1600 obscure -- Obscure features
1601 running -- Running the program
1602 stack -- Examining the stack
1603 status -- Status inquiries
1604 support -- Support facilities
1605 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1606 stopping the program
1607 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1608
1609 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1610 commands in that class.
1611 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1612 documentation.
1613 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1614 (@value{GDBP})
1615 @end smallexample
1616 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1617
1618 @item help @var{class}
1619 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1620 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1621 help display for the class @code{status}:
1622
1623 @smallexample
1624 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1625 Status inquiries.
1626
1627 List of commands:
1628
1629 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1630 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1631 info -- Generic command for showing things
1632 about the program being debugged
1633 show -- Generic command for showing things
1634 about the debugger
1635
1636 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1637 documentation.
1638 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1639 (@value{GDBP})
1640 @end smallexample
1641
1642 @item help @var{command}
1643 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1644 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1645
1646 @kindex apropos
1647 @item apropos @var{args}
1648 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1649 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1650 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1651
1652 @smallexample
1653 apropos reload
1654 @end smallexample
1655
1656 @noindent
1657 results in:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 @c @group
1661 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1662 multiple times in one run
1663 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1664 multiple times in one run
1665 @c @end group
1666 @end smallexample
1667
1668 @kindex complete
1669 @item complete @var{args}
1670 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1671 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1672 command you want completed. For example:
1673
1674 @smallexample
1675 complete i
1676 @end smallexample
1677
1678 @noindent results in:
1679
1680 @smallexample
1681 @group
1682 if
1683 ignore
1684 info
1685 inspect
1686 @end group
1687 @end smallexample
1688
1689 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1690 @end table
1691
1692 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1693 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1694 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1695 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1696 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1697 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1698
1699 @c @group
1700 @table @code
1701 @kindex info
1702 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1703 @item info
1704 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1705 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1706 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1707 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1708 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1709 @w{@code{help info}}.
1710
1711 @kindex set
1712 @item set
1713 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1714 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1715 @code{set prompt $}.
1716
1717 @kindex show
1718 @item show
1719 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1720 @value{GDBN} itself.
1721 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1722 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1723 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1724 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1725
1726 @kindex info set
1727 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1728 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1729 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1730 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1731 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1732 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1733 @end table
1734 @c @end group
1735
1736 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1737 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1738
1739 @table @code
1740 @kindex show version
1741 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1742 @item show version
1743 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1744 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1745 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1746 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1747 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1748 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1749 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1750 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1751 @value{GDBN}.
1752
1753 @kindex show copying
1754 @kindex info copying
1755 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1756 @item show copying
1757 @itemx info copying
1758 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1759
1760 @kindex show warranty
1761 @kindex info warranty
1762 @item show warranty
1763 @itemx info warranty
1764 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1765 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1766
1767 @end table
1768
1769 @node Running
1770 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1771
1772 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1773 debugging information when you compile it.
1774
1775 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1776 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1777 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1778 kill a child process.
1779
1780 @menu
1781 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1782 * Starting:: Starting your program
1783 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1784 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1785
1786 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1787 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1788 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1789 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1790
1791 * Inferiors:: Debugging multiple inferiors
1792 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1793 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1794 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1795 @end menu
1796
1797 @node Compilation
1798 @section Compiling for Debugging
1799
1800 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1801 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1802 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1803 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1804 and addresses in the executable code.
1805
1806 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1807 the compiler.
1808
1809 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1810 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1811 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1812 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1813 executables containing debugging information.
1814
1815 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1816 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1817 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1818 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1819 in pushing your luck.
1820
1821 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1822 @cindex debugging optimized code
1823 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1824 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1825 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1826 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1827 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1828 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1829
1830 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1831 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1832 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1833 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1834 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1835
1836 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1837 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1838 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1839
1840 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1841 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1842 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1843 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1844 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1845 provides macro information if you specify the options
1846 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1847 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1848 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1849 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1850 @option{-g} alone.
1851
1852 @need 2000
1853 @node Starting
1854 @section Starting your Program
1855 @cindex starting
1856 @cindex running
1857
1858 @table @code
1859 @kindex run
1860 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1861 @item run
1862 @itemx r
1863 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1864 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1865 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1866 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1867 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1868
1869 @end table
1870
1871 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1872 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1873 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1874 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1875 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1876 message like this one:
1877
1878 @smallexample
1879 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1880 Try "help target" or "continue".
1881 @end smallexample
1882
1883 @noindent
1884 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1885 first (@pxref{load}).
1886
1887 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1888 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1889 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1890 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1891 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1892 divided into four categories:
1893
1894 @table @asis
1895 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1896 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1897 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1898 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1899 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1900 the arguments.
1901 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1902 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1903 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1904
1905 @item The @emph{environment.}
1906 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1907 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1908 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1909 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1910
1911 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1912 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1913 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1914 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1915
1916 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1917 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1918 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1919 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1920 set a different device for your program.
1921 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1922
1923 @cindex pipes
1924 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1925 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1926 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1927 wrong program.
1928 @end table
1929
1930 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1931 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1932 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1933 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1934 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1935
1936 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1937 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1938 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1939 your current breakpoints.
1940
1941 @table @code
1942 @kindex start
1943 @item start
1944 @cindex run to main procedure
1945 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1946 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1947 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1948 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1949 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1950 procedure, depending on the language used.
1951
1952 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1953 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1954 the @samp{run} command.
1955
1956 @cindex elaboration phase
1957 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1958 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1959 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1960 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1961 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1962 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1963 will remain to halt execution.
1964
1965 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1966 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1967 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1968 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1969 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1970
1971 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1972 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1973 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1974 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1975 elaboration code before running your program.
1976
1977 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1978 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1979 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1980 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1981 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1982 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1983 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1984 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1985 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1986 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1987 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1988
1989 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1990 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1991 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1992 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1993
1994 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1995 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1996 environment:
1997
1998 @smallexample
1999 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2000 (@value{GDBP}) run
2001 @end smallexample
2002
2003 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2004 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2005
2006 @kindex set disable-randomization
2007 @item set disable-randomization
2008 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2009 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2010 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2011 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2012 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2013
2014 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2015 behavior using
2016
2017 @smallexample
2018 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2019 @end smallexample
2020
2021 @item set disable-randomization off
2022 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2023 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2024 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2025 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2026 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2027 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2028
2029 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2030 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2031 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2032 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2033 a code at its expected addresses.
2034
2035 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2036 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2037 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2038 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2039 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2040 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2041 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2042 a randomly chosen address.
2043
2044 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2045 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2046 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2047 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2048 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2049
2050 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2051 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2052
2053 @item show disable-randomization
2054 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2055 the virtual address space of the started program.
2056
2057 @end table
2058
2059 @node Arguments
2060 @section Your Program's Arguments
2061
2062 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2063 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2064 @code{run} command.
2065 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2066 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2067 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2068 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2069 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2070
2071 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2072 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2073 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2074 the program, not by the shell.
2075
2076 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2077 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2078
2079 @table @code
2080 @kindex set args
2081 @item set args
2082 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2083 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2084 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2085 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2086 it again without arguments.
2087
2088 @kindex show args
2089 @item show args
2090 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2091 @end table
2092
2093 @node Environment
2094 @section Your Program's Environment
2095
2096 @cindex environment (of your program)
2097 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2098 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2099 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2100 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2101 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2102 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2103 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2104
2105 @table @code
2106 @kindex path
2107 @item path @var{directory}
2108 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2109 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2110 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2111 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2112 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2113 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2114 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2115
2116 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2117 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2118 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2119 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2120 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2121 @var{directory} to the search path.
2122 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2123 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2124
2125 @kindex show paths
2126 @item show paths
2127 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2128 environment variable).
2129
2130 @kindex show environment
2131 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2132 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2133 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2134 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2135 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2136
2137 @kindex set environment
2138 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2139 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2140 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2141 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2142 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2143 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2144 null value.
2145 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2146 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2147
2148 For example, this command:
2149
2150 @smallexample
2151 set env USER = foo
2152 @end smallexample
2153
2154 @noindent
2155 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2156 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2157 are not actually required.)
2158
2159 @kindex unset environment
2160 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2161 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2162 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2163 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2164 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2165 @end table
2166
2167 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2168 the shell indicated
2169 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2170 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2171 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2172 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2173 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2174 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2175 @file{.profile}.
2176
2177 @node Working Directory
2178 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2179
2180 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2181 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2182 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2183 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2184 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2185 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2186
2187 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2188 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2189 Specify Files}.
2190
2191 @table @code
2192 @kindex cd
2193 @cindex change working directory
2194 @item cd @var{directory}
2195 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2196
2197 @kindex pwd
2198 @item pwd
2199 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2200 @end table
2201
2202 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2203 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2204 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2205 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2206 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2207 current working directory of the debuggee.
2208
2209 @node Input/Output
2210 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2211
2212 @cindex redirection
2213 @cindex i/o
2214 @cindex terminal
2215 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2216 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2217 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2218 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2219 running your program.
2220
2221 @table @code
2222 @kindex info terminal
2223 @item info terminal
2224 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2225 program is using.
2226 @end table
2227
2228 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2229 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2230
2231 @smallexample
2232 run > outfile
2233 @end smallexample
2234
2235 @noindent
2236 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2237
2238 @kindex tty
2239 @cindex controlling terminal
2240 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2241 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2242 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2243 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2244 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2245
2246 @smallexample
2247 tty /dev/ttyb
2248 @end smallexample
2249
2250 @noindent
2251 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2252 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2253 that as their controlling terminal.
2254
2255 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2256 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2257 terminal.
2258
2259 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2260 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2261 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2262 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2263
2264 @cindex inferior tty
2265 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2266 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2267 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2268 program.
2269
2270 @table @code
2271 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2272 @kindex set inferior-tty
2273 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2274
2275 @item show inferior-tty
2276 @kindex show inferior-tty
2277 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2278 @end table
2279
2280 @node Attach
2281 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2282 @kindex attach
2283 @cindex attach
2284
2285 @table @code
2286 @item attach @var{process-id}
2287 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2288 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2289 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2290 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2291 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2292
2293 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2294 executing the command.
2295 @end table
2296
2297 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2298 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2299 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2300 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2301
2302 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2303 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2304 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2305 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2306 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2307 Specify Files}.
2308
2309 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2310 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2311 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2312 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2313 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2314 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2315 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2316
2317 @table @code
2318 @kindex detach
2319 @item detach
2320 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2321 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2322 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2323 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2324 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2325 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2326 executing the command.
2327 @end table
2328
2329 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2330 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2331 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2332 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2333 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2334 Messages}).
2335
2336 @node Kill Process
2337 @section Killing the Child Process
2338
2339 @table @code
2340 @kindex kill
2341 @item kill
2342 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2343 @end table
2344
2345 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2346 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2347 is running.
2348
2349 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2350 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2351 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2352 outside the debugger.
2353
2354 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2355 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2356 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2357 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2358 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2359 breakpoint settings).
2360
2361 @node Inferiors
2362 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2363
2364 Some @value{GDBN} targets are able to run multiple processes created
2365 from a single executable. This can happen, for instance, with an
2366 embedded system reporting back several processes via the remote
2367 protocol.
2368
2369 @cindex inferior
2370 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2371 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2372 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2373 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2374 may (in future) be retained after a process exits. Each run of an
2375 executable creates a new inferior, as does each attachment to an
2376 existing process. Inferiors have unique identifiers that are
2377 different from process ids, and may optionally be named as well.
2378 Usually each inferior will also have its own distinct address space,
2379 although some embedded targets may have several inferiors running in
2380 different parts of a single space.
2381
2382 Each inferior may in turn have multiple threads running in it.
2383
2384 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @code{info inferiors}:
2385
2386 @table @code
2387 @kindex info inferiors
2388 @item info inferiors
2389 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2390
2391 @kindex set print inferior-events
2392 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2393 @item set print inferior-events
2394 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2395 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2396 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2397 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2398 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2399 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2400
2401 @kindex show print inferior-events
2402 @item show print inferior-events
2403 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2404 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2405 @end table
2406
2407 @node Threads
2408 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2409
2410 @cindex threads of execution
2411 @cindex multiple threads
2412 @cindex switching threads
2413 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2414 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2415 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2416 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2417 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2418 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2419 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2420
2421 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2422 programs:
2423
2424 @itemize @bullet
2425 @item automatic notification of new threads
2426 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2427 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2428 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2429 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2430 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2431 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2432 messages on thread start and exit.
2433 @end itemize
2434
2435 @quotation
2436 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2437 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2438 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2439 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2440 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2441 like this:
2442
2443 @smallexample
2444 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2445 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2446 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2447 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2448 @end smallexample
2449 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2450 @c doesn't support threads"?
2451 @end quotation
2452
2453 @cindex focus of debugging
2454 @cindex current thread
2455 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2456 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2457 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2458 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2459 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2460
2461 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2462 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2463 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2464 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2465 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2466 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2467 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2468 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2469 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2470 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2471
2472 @smallexample
2473 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2474 @end smallexample
2475
2476 @noindent
2477 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2478 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2479 further qualifier.
2480
2481 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2482 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2483 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2484 @c program?
2485 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2486 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2487 @c threads ab initio?
2488
2489 @cindex thread number
2490 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2491 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2492 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2493
2494 @table @code
2495 @kindex info threads
2496 @item info threads
2497 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2498 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2499
2500 @enumerate
2501 @item
2502 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2503
2504 @item
2505 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2506
2507 @item
2508 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2509 @end enumerate
2510
2511 @noindent
2512 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2513 indicates the current thread.
2514
2515 For example,
2516 @end table
2517 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2518
2519 @smallexample
2520 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2521 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2522 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2523 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2524 at threadtest.c:68
2525 @end smallexample
2526
2527 On HP-UX systems:
2528
2529 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2530 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2531 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2532 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2533 thread in your program.
2534
2535 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2536 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2537 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2538 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2539 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2540 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2541 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2542 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2543 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2544 HP-UX, you see
2545
2546 @smallexample
2547 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2548 @end smallexample
2549
2550 @noindent
2551 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2552
2553 @table @code
2554 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2555 @item info threads
2556 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2557 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2558
2559 @enumerate
2560 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2561
2562 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2563
2564 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2565 @end enumerate
2566
2567 @noindent
2568 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2569 indicates the current thread.
2570
2571 For example,
2572 @end table
2573 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2574
2575 @smallexample
2576 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2577 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2578 at quicksort.c:137
2579 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2580 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2581 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2582 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2583 @end smallexample
2584
2585 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2586 Solaris-specific command:
2587
2588 @table @code
2589 @item maint info sol-threads
2590 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2591 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2592 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2593 @end table
2594
2595 @table @code
2596 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2597 @item thread @var{threadno}
2598 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2599 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2600 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2601 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2602 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2603
2604 @smallexample
2605 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2606 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2607 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2608 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2609 @end smallexample
2610
2611 @noindent
2612 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2613 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2614 threads.
2615
2616 @kindex thread apply
2617 @cindex apply command to several threads
2618 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2619 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2620 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2621 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2622 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2623 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2624 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2625 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2626
2627 @kindex set print thread-events
2628 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2629 @item set print thread-events
2630 @itemx set print thread-events on
2631 @itemx set print thread-events off
2632 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2633 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2634 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2635 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2636 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2637
2638 @kindex show print thread-events
2639 @item show print thread-events
2640 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2641 have started and exited.
2642 @end table
2643
2644 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2645 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2646 programs with multiple threads.
2647
2648 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2649 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2650
2651 @node Processes
2652 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2653
2654 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2655 @cindex multiple processes
2656 @cindex processes, multiple
2657 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2658 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2659 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2660 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2661 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2662 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2663 will cause it to terminate.
2664
2665 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2666 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2667 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2668 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2669 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2670 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2671 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2672 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2673 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2674 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2675
2676 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2677 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2678 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2679 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2680
2681 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2682 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2683
2684 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2685 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2686
2687 @table @code
2688 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2689 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2690 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2691 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2692 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2693
2694 @table @code
2695 @item parent
2696 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2697 unimpeded. This is the default.
2698
2699 @item child
2700 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2701 unimpeded.
2702
2703 @end table
2704
2705 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2706 @item show follow-fork-mode
2707 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2708 @end table
2709
2710 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2711 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2712 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2713
2714 @table @code
2715 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2716 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2717 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2718 retain debugger control over them both.
2719
2720 @table @code
2721 @item on
2722 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2723 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2724 independently. This is the default.
2725
2726 @item off
2727 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2728 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2729 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2730 is held suspended.
2731
2732 @end table
2733
2734 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2735 @item show detach-on-fork
2736 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2737 @end table
2738
2739 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2740 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2741 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2742 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2743 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2744
2745 @table @code
2746 @kindex info forks
2747 @item info forks
2748 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2749 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2750 position (program counter) of the process.
2751
2752 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2753 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2754 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2755 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2756 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2757
2758 @kindex process @var{process-id}
2759 @item process @var{process-id}
2760 Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2761 argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2762 @samp{info forks}.
2763
2764 @end table
2765
2766 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2767 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2768 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2769 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2770
2771 @table @code
2772 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2773 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2774 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2775 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2776 allowed to run independently.
2777
2778 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2779 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2780 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2781 and remove it from the fork list.
2782
2783 @end table
2784
2785 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2786 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2787 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2788 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2789 the child process's @code{main}.
2790
2791 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2792 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2793
2794 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2795 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2796 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2797 argument.
2798
2799 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2800 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2801 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2802
2803 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2804 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2805
2806 @cindex checkpoint
2807 @cindex restart
2808 @cindex bookmark
2809 @cindex snapshot of a process
2810 @cindex rewind program state
2811
2812 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2813 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2814 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2815 later.
2816
2817 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2818 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2819 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2820 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2821 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2822
2823 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2824 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2825 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2826 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2827 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2828 start again from there.
2829
2830 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2831 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2832
2833 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2834
2835 @table @code
2836 @kindex checkpoint
2837 @item checkpoint
2838 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2839 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2840 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2841
2842 @kindex info checkpoints
2843 @item info checkpoints
2844 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2845 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2846 listed:
2847
2848 @table @code
2849 @item Checkpoint ID
2850 @item Process ID
2851 @item Code Address
2852 @item Source line, or label
2853 @end table
2854
2855 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2856 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2857 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2858 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2859 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2860 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2861 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2862
2863 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2864 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2865 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2866 the debugger.
2867
2868 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2869 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2870 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2871
2872 @end table
2873
2874 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2875 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2876 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2877 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2878 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2879 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2880 previously read data can be read again.
2881
2882 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2883 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2884 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2885 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2886 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2887 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2888
2889 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2890 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2891 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2892 different execution path this time.
2893
2894 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2895 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2896 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2897 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2898 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2899 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2900 potentially pose a problem.
2901
2902 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2903
2904 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2905 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2906 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2907 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2908 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2909 next.
2910
2911 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2912 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2913 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2914 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2915 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2916
2917 @node Stopping
2918 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2919
2920 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2921 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2922 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2923
2924 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2925 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2926 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2927 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2928 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2929 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2930 explicitly request this information at any time.
2931
2932 @table @code
2933 @kindex info program
2934 @item info program
2935 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2936 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2937 @end table
2938
2939 @menu
2940 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2941 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2942 * Signals:: Signals
2943 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2944 @end menu
2945
2946 @node Breakpoints
2947 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2948
2949 @cindex breakpoints
2950 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2951 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2952 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2953 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2954 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2955 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2956 program.
2957
2958 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2959 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2960 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2961 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2962 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2963 call).
2964
2965 @cindex watchpoints
2966 @cindex data breakpoints
2967 @cindex memory tracing
2968 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2969 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2970 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2971 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2972 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2973 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2974 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2975 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2976 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2977 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2978 same commands.
2979
2980 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2981 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2982 Automatic Display}.
2983
2984 @cindex catchpoints
2985 @cindex breakpoint on events
2986 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2987 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2988 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2989 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2990 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2991 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2992 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2993
2994 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2995 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2996 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2997 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2998 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2999 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3000 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3001 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3002 enable it again.
3003
3004 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3005 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3006 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3007 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3008 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3009 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3010 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3011
3012 @menu
3013 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3014 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3015 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3016 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3017 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3018 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3019 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3020 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3021 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3022 @end menu
3023
3024 @node Set Breaks
3025 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3026
3027 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3028 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3029 @c
3030 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3031
3032 @kindex break
3033 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3034 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3035 @cindex latest breakpoint
3036 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3037 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3038 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3039 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3040 convenience variables.
3041
3042 @table @code
3043 @item break @var{location}
3044 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3045 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3046 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3047 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3048 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3049
3050 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3051 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3052 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3053 that situation.
3054
3055 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3056 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3057 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3058
3059 @item break
3060 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3061 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3062 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3063 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3064 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3065 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3066 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3067 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3068 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3069 inside loops.
3070
3071 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3072 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3073 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3074 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3075 existed when your program stopped.
3076
3077 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3078 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3079 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3080 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3081 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3082 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3083 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3084
3085 @kindex tbreak
3086 @item tbreak @var{args}
3087 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3088 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3089 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3090 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3091
3092 @kindex hbreak
3093 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3094 @item hbreak @var{args}
3095 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3096 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3097 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3098 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3099 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3100 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3101 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3102 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3103 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3104 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3105 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3106 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3107 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3108 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3109 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3110 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3111 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3112 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3113
3114 @kindex thbreak
3115 @item thbreak @var{args}
3116 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3117 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3118 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3119 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3120 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3121 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3122 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3123 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3124
3125 @kindex rbreak
3126 @cindex regular expression
3127 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
3128 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3129 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3130 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3131 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3132 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3133 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3134 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3135 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3136
3137 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3138 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3139 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3140 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3141 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3142 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3143
3144 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3145 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3146 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3147 classes.
3148
3149 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3150 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3151 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3152
3153 @smallexample
3154 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3155 @end smallexample
3156
3157 @kindex info breakpoints
3158 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3159 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3160 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3161 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3162 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3163 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3164 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3165 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3166
3167 @table @emph
3168 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3169 @item Type
3170 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3171 @item Disposition
3172 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3173 @item Enabled or Disabled
3174 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3175 that are not enabled.
3176 @item Address
3177 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3178 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3179 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3180 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3181 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3182 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3183 @item What
3184 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3185 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3186 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3187 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3188 @end table
3189
3190 @noindent
3191 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3192 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3193 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3194 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3195 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3196 valid location.
3197
3198 @noindent
3199 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3200 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3201 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3202 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3203 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3204
3205 @noindent
3206 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3207 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3208 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3209 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3210 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3211 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3212 @end table
3213
3214 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3215 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3216 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3217 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3218
3219 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3220 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3221 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3222 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3223
3224 @itemize @bullet
3225 @item
3226 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3227 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3228
3229 @item
3230 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3231 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3232
3233 @item
3234 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3235 several places where that function is inlined.
3236 @end itemize
3237
3238 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3239 the relevant locations@footnote{
3240 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3241 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3242 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3243 info with line numbers for them.}.
3244
3245 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3246 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3247 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3248 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3249 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3250 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3251 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3252
3253 For example:
3254
3255 @smallexample
3256 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3257 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3258 stop only if i==1
3259 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3260 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3261 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3262 @end smallexample
3263
3264 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3265 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3266 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3267 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3268 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3269 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3270 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3271 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3272 that belong to that breakpoint.
3273
3274 @cindex pending breakpoints
3275 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3276 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3277 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3278 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3279 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3280 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3281 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3282 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3283 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3284 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3285 is not yet resolved.
3286
3287 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3288 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3289 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3290 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3291 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3292 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3293
3294 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3295 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3296 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3297 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3298
3299 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3300 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3301 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3302
3303 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3304 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3305 address specification to an address:
3306
3307 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3308 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3309 @table @code
3310 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3311 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3312 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3313
3314 @item set breakpoint pending on
3315 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3316 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3317
3318 @item set breakpoint pending off
3319 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3320 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3321 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3322
3323 @item show breakpoint pending
3324 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3325 @end table
3326
3327 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3328 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3329 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3330
3331 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3332 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3333 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3334 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3335 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3336 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3337 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3338 breakpoints.
3339
3340 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3341
3342 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3343 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3344 @table @code
3345 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3346 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3347 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3348 breakpoint must be used.
3349
3350 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3351 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3352 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3353 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3354 @end table
3355
3356 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3357 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3358 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3359 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3360 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3361 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3362 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3363 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3364 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3365
3366 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3367 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3368 @table @code
3369 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3370 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3371 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3372 removed from the target when it stops.
3373
3374 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3375 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3376 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3377 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3378 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3379
3380 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3381 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3382 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3383 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3384 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3385 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3386 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3387 @end table
3388
3389 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3390 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3391 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3392 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3393 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3394 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3395 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3396 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3397
3398
3399 @node Set Watchpoints
3400 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3401
3402 @cindex setting watchpoints
3403 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3404 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3405 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3406 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3407 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3408
3409 @itemize @bullet
3410 @item
3411 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3412
3413 @item
3414 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3415 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3416 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3417
3418 @item
3419 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3420 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3421 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3422 @end itemize
3423
3424 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3425 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3426 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3427 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3428 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3429 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3430 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3431 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3432 the expression changes.
3433
3434 @cindex software watchpoints
3435 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3436 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3437 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3438 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3439 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3440 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3441 culprit.)
3442
3443 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3444 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3445 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3446
3447 @table @code
3448 @kindex watch
3449 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3450 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3451 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3452 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3453 to watch the value of a single variable:
3454
3455 @smallexample
3456 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3457 @end smallexample
3458
3459 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3460 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3461 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3462 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3463 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3464 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3465
3466 @kindex rwatch
3467 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3468 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3469 by the program.
3470
3471 @kindex awatch
3472 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3473 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3474 or written into by the program.
3475
3476 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3477 @item info watchpoints
3478 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3479 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3480 @end table
3481
3482 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3483 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3484 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3485 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3486 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3487 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3488
3489 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3490 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3491 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3492 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3493 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3494 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3495 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3496 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3497
3498 @table @code
3499 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3500 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3501 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3502
3503 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3504 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3505 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3506 @end table
3507
3508 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3509 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3510 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3511
3512 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3513
3514 @smallexample
3515 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3516 @end smallexample
3517
3518 @noindent
3519 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3520
3521 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3522 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3523 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3524 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3525 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3526 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3527 will print a message like this:
3528
3529 @smallexample
3530 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3531 @end smallexample
3532
3533 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3534 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3535 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3536 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3537 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3538 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3539 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3540 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3541
3542 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3543 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3544 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3545 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3546 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3547 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3548
3549 @smallexample
3550 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3551 @end smallexample
3552
3553 @noindent
3554 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3555
3556 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3557 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3558 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3559 expression with separately allocated resources.
3560
3561 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3562 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3563 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3564
3565 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3566 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3567 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3568 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3569 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3570 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3571 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3572 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3573 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3574
3575 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3576 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3577 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3578 watched expression from every thread.
3579
3580 @quotation
3581 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3582 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3583 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3584 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3585 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3586 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3587 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3588 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3589 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3590 @end quotation
3591
3592 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3593
3594 @node Set Catchpoints
3595 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3596 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3597 @cindex exception handlers
3598 @cindex event handling
3599
3600 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3601 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3602 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3603
3604 @table @code
3605 @kindex catch
3606 @item catch @var{event}
3607 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3608 @table @code
3609 @item throw
3610 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3611 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3612
3613 @item catch
3614 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3615
3616 @item exception
3617 @cindex Ada exception catching
3618 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3619 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3620 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3621 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3622 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3623
3624 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3625 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3626 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3627 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3628 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3629 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3630 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3631 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3632
3633 @item exception unhandled
3634 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3635
3636 @item assert
3637 A failed Ada assertion.
3638
3639 @item exec
3640 @cindex break on fork/exec
3641 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3642 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3643
3644 @item fork
3645 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3646 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3647
3648 @item vfork
3649 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3650 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3651
3652 @end table
3653
3654 @item tcatch @var{event}
3655 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3656 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3657
3658 @end table
3659
3660 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3661
3662 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3663 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3664
3665 @itemize @bullet
3666 @item
3667 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3668 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3669 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3670 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3671 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3672 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3673 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3674 disabled within interactive calls.
3675
3676 @item
3677 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3678
3679 @item
3680 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3681 @end itemize
3682
3683 @cindex raise exceptions
3684 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3685 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3686 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3687 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3688 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3689 out where the exception was raised.
3690
3691 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3692 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3693 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3694 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3695
3696 @smallexample
3697 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3698 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3699 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3700 @end smallexample
3701
3702 @noindent
3703 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3704 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3705 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3706
3707 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3708 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3709 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3710 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3711 raised.
3712
3713
3714 @node Delete Breaks
3715 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3716
3717 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3718 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3719 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3720 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3721 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3722 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3723
3724 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3725 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3726 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3727 their breakpoint numbers.
3728
3729 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3730 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3731 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3732
3733 @table @code
3734 @kindex clear
3735 @item clear
3736 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3737 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3738 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3739 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3740
3741 @item clear @var{location}
3742 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3743 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3744 most useful ones are listed below:
3745
3746 @table @code
3747 @item clear @var{function}
3748 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3749 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3750
3751 @item clear @var{linenum}
3752 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3753 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3754 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3755 @end table
3756
3757 @cindex delete breakpoints
3758 @kindex delete
3759 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3760 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3761 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3762 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3763 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3764 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3765 @end table
3766
3767 @node Disabling
3768 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3769
3770 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3771 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3772 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3773 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3774 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3775
3776 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3777 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3778 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3779 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3780 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3781
3782 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3783 affects all of its locations.
3784
3785 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3786 states of enablement:
3787
3788 @itemize @bullet
3789 @item
3790 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3791 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3792 @item
3793 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3794 @item
3795 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3796 disabled.
3797 @item
3798 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3799 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3800 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3801 @end itemize
3802
3803 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3804 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3805
3806 @table @code
3807 @kindex disable
3808 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3809 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3810 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3811 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3812 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3813 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3814 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3815
3816 @kindex enable
3817 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3818 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3819 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3820
3821 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3822 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3823 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3824
3825 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3826 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3827 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3828 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3829 @end table
3830
3831 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3832 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3833 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3834 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3835 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3836 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3837 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3838 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3839 Stepping}.)
3840
3841 @node Conditions
3842 @subsection Break Conditions
3843 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3844 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3845
3846 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3847 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3848 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3849 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3850 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3851 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3852 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3853 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3854
3855 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3856 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3857 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3858 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3859 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3860
3861 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3862 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3863 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3864 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3865 one.
3866
3867 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3868 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3869 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3870 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3871 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3872 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3873 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3874 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3875 conditions for the
3876 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3877 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3878
3879 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3880 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3881 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3882 with the @code{condition} command.
3883
3884 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3885 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3886 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3887 catchpoint.
3888
3889 @table @code
3890 @kindex condition
3891 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3892 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3893 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3894 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3895 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3896 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3897 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3898 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3899 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3900 prints an error message:
3901
3902 @smallexample
3903 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3904 @end smallexample
3905
3906 @noindent
3907 @value{GDBN} does
3908 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3909 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3910 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3911
3912 @item condition @var{bnum}
3913 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3914 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3915 @end table
3916
3917 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3918 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3919 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3920 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3921 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3922 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3923 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3924 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3925 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3926 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3927 your program reaches it.
3928
3929 @table @code
3930 @kindex ignore
3931 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3932 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3933 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3934 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3935 takes no action.
3936
3937 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3938 a count of zero.
3939
3940 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3941 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3942 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3943 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3944
3945 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3946 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3947 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3948
3949 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3950 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3951 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3952 Variables}.
3953 @end table
3954
3955 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3956
3957
3958 @node Break Commands
3959 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3960
3961 @cindex breakpoint commands
3962 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3963 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3964 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3965 enable other breakpoints.
3966
3967 @table @code
3968 @kindex commands
3969 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3970 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3971 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3972 @itemx end
3973 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3974 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3975 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3976
3977 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3978 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3979
3980 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3981 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3982 recently encountered).
3983 @end table
3984
3985 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3986 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3987
3988 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3989 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3990 that resumes execution.
3991
3992 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3993 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3994 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3995 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3996 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3997
3998 @kindex silent
3999 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4000 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4001 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4002 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4003 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4004 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4005
4006 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4007 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4008 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4009
4010 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4011 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4012
4013 @smallexample
4014 break foo if x>0
4015 commands
4016 silent
4017 printf "x is %d\n",x
4018 cont
4019 end
4020 @end smallexample
4021
4022 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4023 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4024 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4025 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4026 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4027 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4028 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4029
4030 @smallexample
4031 break 403
4032 commands
4033 silent
4034 set x = y + 4
4035 cont
4036 end
4037 @end smallexample
4038
4039 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4040 @node Error in Breakpoints
4041 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4042
4043 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4044 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4045
4046 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4047 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4048 @smallexample
4049 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4050 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4051 @end smallexample
4052
4053 @noindent
4054 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4055 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4056 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4057
4058 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4059 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4060
4061 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4062 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4063 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4064
4065 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4066 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4067 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4068 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4069
4070 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4071 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4072 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4073 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4074 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4075 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4076 first in the bundle.
4077
4078 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4079 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4080 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4081 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4082 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4083 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4084 is hit.
4085
4086 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4087 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4088
4089 @smallexample
4090 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4091 @end smallexample
4092
4093 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4094 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4095 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4096 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4097 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4098 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4099 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4100 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4101
4102 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4103 adjusted breakpoints:
4104
4105 @smallexample
4106 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4107 to 0x00010410.
4108 @end smallexample
4109
4110 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4111 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4112 frequently than expected.
4113
4114 @node Continuing and Stepping
4115 @section Continuing and Stepping
4116
4117 @cindex stepping
4118 @cindex continuing
4119 @cindex resuming execution
4120 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4121 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4122 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4123 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4124 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4125 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4126 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4127 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4128
4129 @table @code
4130 @kindex continue
4131 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4132 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4133 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4134 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4135 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4136 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4137 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4138 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4139 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4140 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4141
4142 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4143 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4144 @code{continue} is ignored.
4145
4146 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4147 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4148 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4149 @code{continue}.
4150 @end table
4151
4152 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4153 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4154 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4155 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4156
4157 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4158 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4159 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4160 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4161 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4162 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4163
4164 @table @code
4165 @kindex step
4166 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4167 @item step
4168 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4169 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4170 abbreviated @code{s}.
4171
4172 @quotation
4173 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4174 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4175 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4176 @c distinction here.
4177 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4178 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4179 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4180 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4181 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4182 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4183 below.
4184 @end quotation
4185
4186 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4187 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4188 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4189 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4190 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4191 called within the line.
4192
4193 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4194 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4195 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4196 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4197 was any debugging information about the routine.
4198
4199 @item step @var{count}
4200 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4201 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4202 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4203
4204 @kindex next
4205 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4206 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4207 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4208 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4209 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4210 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4211 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4212 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4213
4214 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4215
4216
4217 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4218 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4219 @c
4220 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4221 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4222 @c function are executed without stopping.
4223
4224 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4225 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4226 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4227
4228 @kindex set step-mode
4229 @item set step-mode
4230 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4231 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4232 @itemx set step-mode on
4233 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4234 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4235 information rather than stepping over it.
4236
4237 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4238 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4239 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4240
4241 @item set step-mode off
4242 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4243 debug information. This is the default.
4244
4245 @item show step-mode
4246 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4247 source line debug information.
4248
4249 @kindex finish
4250 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4251 @item finish
4252 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4253 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4254 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4255
4256 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4257 ,Returning from a Function}).
4258
4259 @kindex until
4260 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4261 @cindex run until specified location
4262 @item until
4263 @itemx u
4264 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4265 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4266 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4267 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4268 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4269 than the address of the jump.
4270
4271 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4272 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4273 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4274 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4275 through the next iteration.
4276
4277 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4278 stack frame.
4279
4280 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4281 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4282 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4283 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4284 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4285
4286 @smallexample
4287 (@value{GDBP}) f
4288 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4289 206 expand_input();
4290 (@value{GDBP}) until
4291 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4292 @end smallexample
4293
4294 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4295 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4296 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4297 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4298 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4299 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4300 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4301
4302 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4303 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4304 argument.
4305
4306 @item until @var{location}
4307 @itemx u @var{location}
4308 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4309 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4310 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4311 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4312 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4313 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4314 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4315 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4316 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4317 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4318 invocations have returned.
4319
4320 @smallexample
4321 94 int factorial (int value)
4322 95 @{
4323 96 if (value > 1) @{
4324 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4325 98 @}
4326 99 return (value);
4327 100 @}
4328 @end smallexample
4329
4330
4331 @kindex advance @var{location}
4332 @itemx advance @var{location}
4333 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4334 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4335 @ref{Specify Location}.
4336 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4337 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4338 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4339 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4340
4341
4342 @kindex stepi
4343 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4344 @item stepi
4345 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4346 @itemx si
4347 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4348
4349 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4350 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4351 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4352 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4353
4354 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4355
4356 @need 750
4357 @kindex nexti
4358 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4359 @item nexti
4360 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4361 @itemx ni
4362 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4363 proceed until the function returns.
4364
4365 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4366 @end table
4367
4368 @node Signals
4369 @section Signals
4370 @cindex signals
4371
4372 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4373 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4374 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4375 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4376 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4377 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4378 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4379 requested an alarm).
4380
4381 @cindex fatal signals
4382 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4383 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4384 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4385 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4386 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4387 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4388
4389 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4390 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4391 signal.
4392
4393 @cindex handling signals
4394 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4395 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4396 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4397 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4398 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4399
4400 @table @code
4401 @kindex info signals
4402 @kindex info handle
4403 @item info signals
4404 @itemx info handle
4405 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4406 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4407 the defined types of signals.
4408
4409 @item info signals @var{sig}
4410 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4411
4412 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4413
4414 @kindex handle
4415 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4416 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4417 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4418 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4419 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4420 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4421 say what change to make.
4422 @end table
4423
4424 @c @group
4425 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4426 Their full names are:
4427
4428 @table @code
4429 @item nostop
4430 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4431 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4432
4433 @item stop
4434 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4435 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4436
4437 @item print
4438 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4439
4440 @item noprint
4441 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4442 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4443
4444 @item pass
4445 @itemx noignore
4446 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4447 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4448 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4449
4450 @item nopass
4451 @itemx ignore
4452 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4453 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4454 @end table
4455 @c @end group
4456
4457 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4458 program until you
4459 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4460 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4461 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4462 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4463 program sees that signal when you continue.
4464
4465 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4466 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4467 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4468 erroneous signals.
4469
4470 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4471 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4472 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4473 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4474 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4475 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4476 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4477 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4478 Program a Signal}.
4479
4480 @cindex extra signal information
4481 @anchor{extra signal information}
4482
4483 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
4484 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
4485 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
4486 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
4487 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
4488 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
4489 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
4490 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
4491 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
4492 system header.
4493
4494 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
4495 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
4496
4497 @smallexample
4498 @group
4499 (@value{GDBP}) continue
4500 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
4501 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
4502 69 *(int *)p = 0;
4503 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
4504 type = struct @{
4505 int si_signo;
4506 int si_errno;
4507 int si_code;
4508 union @{
4509 int _pad[28];
4510 struct @{...@} _kill;
4511 struct @{...@} _timer;
4512 struct @{...@} _rt;
4513 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
4514 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
4515 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
4516 @} _sifields;
4517 @}
4518 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
4519 type = struct @{
4520 void *si_addr;
4521 @}
4522 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
4523 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
4524 @end group
4525 @end smallexample
4526
4527 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
4528
4529 @node Thread Stops
4530 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4531
4532 @cindex stopped threads
4533 @cindex threads, stopped
4534
4535 @cindex continuing threads
4536 @cindex threads, continuing
4537
4538 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4539 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4540 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4541 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4542 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4543 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4544 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4545 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4546 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4547
4548 @menu
4549 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
4550 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
4551 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
4552 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
4553 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
4554 @end menu
4555
4556 @node All-Stop Mode
4557 @subsection All-Stop Mode
4558
4559 @cindex all-stop mode
4560
4561 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4562 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4563 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4564 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4565 underfoot.
4566
4567 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4568 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4569 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4570
4571 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4572 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4573 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4574 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4575 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4576 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4577 stops.
4578
4579 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4580 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4581 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4582 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4583
4584 @cindex automatic thread selection
4585 @cindex switching threads automatically
4586 @cindex threads, automatic switching
4587 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
4588 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
4589 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
4590 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
4591 thread.
4592
4593 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
4594 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
4595
4596 @table @code
4597 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4598 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4599 @cindex lock scheduler
4600 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4601 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4602 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4603 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
4604 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
4605 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
4606 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4607 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4608 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4609 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4610 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
4611 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
4612
4613 @item show scheduler-locking
4614 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4615 @end table
4616
4617 @node Non-Stop Mode
4618 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
4619
4620 @cindex non-stop mode
4621
4622 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
4623 @c with more details.
4624
4625 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
4626 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
4627 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
4628 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
4629 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
4630 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
4631
4632 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
4633 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
4634 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
4635 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
4636 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
4637 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
4638 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
4639 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
4640 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
4641 independently and simultaneously.
4642
4643 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
4644 or attach to your program:
4645
4646 @smallexample
4647 # Enable the async interface.
4648 set target-async 1
4649
4650 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
4651 set pagination off
4652
4653 # Finally, turn it on!
4654 set non-stop on
4655 @end smallexample
4656
4657 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
4658
4659 @table @code
4660 @kindex set non-stop
4661 @item set non-stop on
4662 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
4663 @item set non-stop off
4664 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
4665 @kindex show non-stop
4666 @item show non-stop
4667 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
4668 @end table
4669
4670 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
4671 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
4672 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
4673 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
4674 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
4675 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
4676 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
4677 default.
4678
4679 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
4680 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
4681 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
4682
4683 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
4684 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
4685 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
4686 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
4687 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
4688
4689 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
4690 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
4691 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
4692 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
4693 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
4694
4695 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
4696
4697 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
4698 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
4699 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
4700 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
4701 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
4702 previously current thread.
4703
4704 @node Background Execution
4705 @subsection Background Execution
4706
4707 @cindex foreground execution
4708 @cindex background execution
4709 @cindex asynchronous execution
4710 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
4711
4712 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
4713 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
4714 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
4715 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
4716 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
4717 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
4718
4719 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
4720 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
4721 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
4722
4723 @table @code
4724 @kindex set target-async
4725 @item set target-async on
4726 Enable asynchronous mode.
4727 @item set target-async off
4728 Disable asynchronous mode.
4729 @kindex show target-async
4730 @item show target-async
4731 Show the current target-async setting.
4732 @end table
4733
4734 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
4735 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
4736
4737 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
4738 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
4739 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
4740 are:
4741
4742 @table @code
4743 @kindex run&
4744 @item run
4745 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
4746
4747 @item attach
4748 @kindex attach&
4749 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
4750
4751 @item step
4752 @kindex step&
4753 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
4754
4755 @item stepi
4756 @kindex stepi&
4757 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
4758
4759 @item next
4760 @kindex next&
4761 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
4762
4763 @item nexti
4764 @kindex nexti&
4765 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
4766
4767 @item continue
4768 @kindex continue&
4769 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
4770
4771 @item finish
4772 @kindex finish&
4773 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
4774
4775 @item until
4776 @kindex until&
4777 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
4778
4779 @end table
4780
4781 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
4782 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
4783 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
4784 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
4785 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
4786 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
4787
4788 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
4789 using the @code{interrupt} command.
4790
4791 @table @code
4792 @kindex interrupt
4793 @item interrupt
4794 @itemx interrupt -a
4795
4796 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
4797 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
4798 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
4799 use @code{interrupt -a}.
4800 @end table
4801
4802 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4803 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4804
4805 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4806 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4807 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4808
4809 @table @code
4810 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4811 @cindex thread breakpoints
4812 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4813 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4814 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4815 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4816 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4817 specify some source line.
4818
4819 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4820 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4821 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4822 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4823 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4824
4825 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4826 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4827 program.
4828
4829 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4830 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4831 breakpoint condition, like this:
4832
4833 @smallexample
4834 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4835 @end smallexample
4836
4837 @end table
4838
4839 @node Interrupted System Calls
4840 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
4841
4842 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4843 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4844 @cindex premature return from system calls
4845 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
4846 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
4847 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4848 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4849 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4850 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4851 stop execution.
4852
4853 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4854 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4855 style anyways.
4856
4857 For example, do not write code like this:
4858
4859 @smallexample
4860 sleep (10);
4861 @end smallexample
4862
4863 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4864 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4865
4866 Instead, write this:
4867
4868 @smallexample
4869 int unslept = 10;
4870 while (unslept > 0)
4871 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4872 @end smallexample
4873
4874 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4875 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4876 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4877 @value{GDBN}.
4878
4879 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4880 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4881 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4882 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4883
4884
4885 @node Reverse Execution
4886 @chapter Running programs backward
4887 @cindex reverse execution
4888 @cindex running programs backward
4889
4890 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
4891 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
4892 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
4893 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
4894
4895 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
4896 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
4897 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
4898 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
4899 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
4900 all target environments can support reverse execution.
4901
4902 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
4903 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
4904 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
4905 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
4906 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
4907 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
4908 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
4909 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
4910 prior values@footnote{
4911 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
4912 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
4913 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
4914
4915 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
4916 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
4917 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
4918 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
4919 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
4920 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
4921 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
4922 }.
4923
4924 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
4925 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
4926
4927 @table @code
4928 @kindex reverse-continue
4929 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
4930 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4931 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4932 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
4933 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
4934 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
4935 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
4936
4937 @kindex reverse-step
4938 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
4939 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4940 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
4941 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
4942
4943 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
4944 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
4945 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
4946 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
4947 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
4948 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
4949
4950 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
4951 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
4952
4953 @kindex reverse-stepi
4954 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
4955 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4956 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
4957 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
4958 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
4959 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
4960 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
4961
4962 @kindex reverse-next
4963 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
4964 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4965 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
4966 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
4967 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
4968 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
4969 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
4970 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
4971 line of a function back to its return to its caller
4972 @footnote{Unles the code is too heavily optimized.}.
4973
4974 @kindex reverse-nexti
4975 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
4976 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4977 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
4978 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
4979 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
4980 another instruction, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
4981 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
4982 frame) is reached.
4983
4984 @kindex reverse-finish
4985 @item reverse-finish
4986 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
4987 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
4988 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
4989 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
4990
4991 @kindex set exec-direction
4992 @item set exec-direction
4993 Set the direction of target execution.
4994 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
4995 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
4996 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
4997 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
4998 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
4999 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
5000 @item set exec-direction forward
5001 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
5002 This is the default.
5003 @end table
5004
5005
5006 @node Process record and replay
5007 @chapter Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
5008 @cindex process record and replay
5009 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
5010
5011 In a architecture environment that supports process record and replay,
5012 process record and replay target can record a log of the process execution,
5013 and replay it with both forward and reverse execute commands.
5014
5015 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record for
5016 the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in replay mode. So inferior
5017 will not really execute and all the execution events are taken from the
5018 execution log. Just the values of registers (include pc register) and
5019 memory of the inferior will be changed.
5020
5021 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will debug in record mode. So inferior will
5022 execute normally and @value{GDBN} will record the execution log.
5023
5024 If you are debugging in a architecture environment that supports
5025 process record and replay, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
5026
5027 @table @code
5028 @kindex target record
5029 @kindex record
5030 @kindex rec
5031 @item target record
5032 This a standard command to start process record and replay target.
5033 Process record and replay target can only debug a process that already
5034 running. Therefore you need to first start the process @code{run},
5035 and then start the recording @code{target record}.
5036
5037 Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are the aliases of @code{target record}.
5038
5039 Displaced stepping function will disable when process record and replay
5040 target is opened. Because process record and replay target doesn't
5041 support displaced stepping function.
5042
5043 If inferior in non-stop mode (non-stop) or in asynchronous mode
5044 (target-async), process record and replay target can't be open because
5045 it doesn't support these two modes.
5046
5047 @kindex record stop
5048 @kindex rec s
5049 @item record stop
5050 Stop process record and replay target at once. When Process record and
5051 replay target stops, all the execution log will be deleted and the inferior
5052 will either be terminated, or remain in its final state.
5053
5054 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at the
5055 end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the next
5056 instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if you record
5057 for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process will be left in
5058 the same state as if recording never happened.
5059
5060 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped while
5061 in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log but at some
5062 earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live'' at that earlier state,
5063 and it will then be possible to continue debugging the process ``live'' from
5064 that state.
5065
5066 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it, process
5067 record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
5068
5069 @kindex set record insn-number-max
5070 @item set record insn-number-max @var{limit}
5071 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000.
5072
5073 In this case, if record instructions number is bigger than @var{limit},
5074 @value{GDBN} will auto delete the earliest recorded instruction execute
5075 log.
5076
5077 If set to 0, @value{GDBN} will not delete the earliest recorded instruction
5078 execute log. Record instructions number limit function will disable.
5079
5080 @kindex show record insn-number-max
5081 @item show record insn-number-max
5082 Show the value of recorded instructions limit.
5083
5084 @kindex set record stop-at-limit
5085 @item set record stop-at-limit on
5086 Set the behavior when record instructions limit is reached.
5087 This is the default mode. Meaning that @value{GDBN} will stop ask user
5088 want close @code{record stop-at-limit} or stop inferior.
5089
5090 @item set record stop-at-limit off
5091 This mean that @value{GDBN} will auto delete the oldest record to make
5092 room for each new one.
5093
5094 @kindex show record stop-at-limit
5095 @item show record stop-at-limit
5096 Show the value of record stop-at-limit.
5097
5098 @kindex info record insn-number
5099 @item info record insn-number
5100 Show the current number of recorded instructions.
5101
5102 @kindex record delete
5103 @kindex rec del
5104 @item record delete
5105 When record target running in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
5106 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
5107 from the current address. It means you will abandon the previously
5108 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
5109 @end table
5110
5111
5112 @node Stack
5113 @chapter Examining the Stack
5114
5115 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5116 stopped and how it got there.
5117
5118 @cindex call stack
5119 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5120 is generated.
5121 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5122 the arguments of the call,
5123 and the local variables of the function being called.
5124 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5125 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5126 stack}.
5127
5128 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5129 stack allow you to see all of this information.
5130
5131 @cindex selected frame
5132 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5133 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5134 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5135 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5136 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5137 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5138
5139 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5140 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5141 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5142
5143 @menu
5144 * Frames:: Stack frames
5145 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
5146 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
5147 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5148
5149 @end menu
5150
5151 @node Frames
5152 @section Stack Frames
5153
5154 @cindex frame, definition
5155 @cindex stack frame
5156 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5157 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5158 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5159 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5160 which the function is executing.
5161
5162 @cindex initial frame
5163 @cindex outermost frame
5164 @cindex innermost frame
5165 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5166 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5167 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5168 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5169 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5170 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5171 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5172 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5173
5174 @cindex frame pointer
5175 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5176 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5177 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5178 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5179 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5180 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5181
5182 @cindex frame number
5183 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5184 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5185 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5186 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5187 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5188
5189 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5190 @c underflow problems.
5191 @cindex frameless execution
5192 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5193 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5194 @smallexample
5195 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5196 @end smallexample
5197 generates functions without a frame.)
5198 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5199 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5200 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5201 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5202 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5203 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5204 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5205
5206 @table @code
5207 @kindex frame@r{, command}
5208 @cindex current stack frame
5209 @item frame @var{args}
5210 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5211 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5212 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5213 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5214
5215 @kindex select-frame
5216 @cindex selecting frame silently
5217 @item select-frame
5218 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5219 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5220 @code{frame}.
5221 @end table
5222
5223 @node Backtrace
5224 @section Backtraces
5225
5226 @cindex traceback
5227 @cindex call stack traces
5228 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5229 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5230 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5231 stack.
5232
5233 @table @code
5234 @kindex backtrace
5235 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5236 @item backtrace
5237 @itemx bt
5238 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5239 frames in the stack.
5240
5241 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5242 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5243
5244 @item backtrace @var{n}
5245 @itemx bt @var{n}
5246 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5247
5248 @item backtrace -@var{n}
5249 @itemx bt -@var{n}
5250 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5251
5252 @item backtrace full
5253 @itemx bt full
5254 @itemx bt full @var{n}
5255 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
5256 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5257 number of frames to print, as described above.
5258 @end table
5259
5260 @kindex where
5261 @kindex info stack
5262 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5263 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5264
5265 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5266 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5267 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5268 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5269 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5270 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5271 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5272 multi-threaded program.
5273
5274 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5275 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5276 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5277 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5278 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5279 line number.
5280
5281 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5282 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5283
5284 @smallexample
5285 @group
5286 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5287 at builtin.c:993
5288 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
5289 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5290 at macro.c:71
5291 (More stack frames follow...)
5292 @end group
5293 @end smallexample
5294
5295 @noindent
5296 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5297 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5298 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5299
5300 @noindent
5301 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
5302 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
5303 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
5304 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
5305 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
5306
5307 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
5308 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5309 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5310 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5311 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5312 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5313 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5314 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5315 such a backtrace might look like:
5316
5317 @smallexample
5318 @group
5319 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5320 at builtin.c:993
5321 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5322 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5323 at macro.c:71
5324 (More stack frames follow...)
5325 @end group
5326 @end smallexample
5327
5328 @noindent
5329 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5330 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5331
5332 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5333 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5334 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5335
5336 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5337 @cindex program entry point
5338 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
5339 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5340 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5341 @code{main}@footnote{
5342 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5343 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5344 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
5345 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
5346 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
5347 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
5348
5349 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
5350 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
5351
5352 @table @code
5353 @item set backtrace past-main
5354 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
5355 @kindex set backtrace
5356 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
5357
5358 @item set backtrace past-main off
5359 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
5360 default.
5361
5362 @item show backtrace past-main
5363 @kindex show backtrace
5364 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
5365
5366 @item set backtrace past-entry
5367 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
5368 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
5369 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
5370 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
5371
5372 @item set backtrace past-entry off
5373 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
5374 application. This is the default.
5375
5376 @item show backtrace past-entry
5377 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
5378
5379 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
5380 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
5381 @cindex backtrace limit
5382 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
5383 unlimited.
5384
5385 @item show backtrace limit
5386 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
5387 @end table
5388
5389 @node Selection
5390 @section Selecting a Frame
5391
5392 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
5393 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
5394 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
5395 of the stack frame just selected.
5396
5397 @table @code
5398 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
5399 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
5400 @item frame @var{n}
5401 @itemx f @var{n}
5402 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
5403 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
5404 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
5405 @code{main}.
5406
5407 @item frame @var{addr}
5408 @itemx f @var{addr}
5409 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
5410 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
5411 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
5412 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
5413 switches between them.
5414
5415 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
5416 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
5417
5418 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
5419 pointer and a program counter.
5420
5421 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
5422 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
5423
5424 @kindex up
5425 @item up @var{n}
5426 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5427 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
5428 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
5429
5430 @kindex down
5431 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
5432 @item down @var{n}
5433 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5434 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
5435 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
5436 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
5437 @end table
5438
5439 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
5440 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
5441 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5442 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
5443
5444 @need 1000
5445 For example:
5446
5447 @smallexample
5448 @group
5449 (@value{GDBP}) up
5450 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
5451 at env.c:10
5452 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
5453 @end group
5454 @end smallexample
5455
5456 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
5457 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
5458 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
5459 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
5460 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
5461 for details.
5462
5463 @table @code
5464 @kindex down-silently
5465 @kindex up-silently
5466 @item up-silently @var{n}
5467 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
5468 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
5469 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
5470 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
5471 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
5472 distracting.
5473 @end table
5474
5475 @node Frame Info
5476 @section Information About a Frame
5477
5478 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
5479 stack frame.
5480
5481 @table @code
5482 @item frame
5483 @itemx f
5484 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
5485 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
5486 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
5487 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
5488 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5489
5490 @kindex info frame
5491 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
5492 @item info frame
5493 @itemx info f
5494 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
5495 including:
5496
5497 @itemize @bullet
5498 @item
5499 the address of the frame
5500 @item
5501 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
5502 @item
5503 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
5504 @item
5505 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
5506 @item
5507 the address of the frame's arguments
5508 @item
5509 the address of the frame's local variables
5510 @item
5511 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
5512 @item
5513 which registers were saved in the frame
5514 @end itemize
5515
5516 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
5517 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
5518 the usual conventions.
5519
5520 @item info frame @var{addr}
5521 @itemx info f @var{addr}
5522 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
5523 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
5524 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
5525 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
5526 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5527
5528 @kindex info args
5529 @item info args
5530 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
5531
5532 @item info locals
5533 @kindex info locals
5534 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
5535 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
5536 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
5537
5538 @kindex info catch
5539 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
5540 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
5541 @item info catch
5542 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
5543 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
5544 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
5545 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
5546 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
5547
5548 @end table
5549
5550
5551 @node Source
5552 @chapter Examining Source Files
5553
5554 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
5555 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
5556 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
5557 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
5558 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
5559 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
5560 source files by explicit command.
5561
5562 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
5563 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
5564 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
5565
5566 @menu
5567 * List:: Printing source lines
5568 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
5569 * Edit:: Editing source files
5570 * Search:: Searching source files
5571 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
5572 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
5573 @end menu
5574
5575 @node List
5576 @section Printing Source Lines
5577
5578 @kindex list
5579 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
5580 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5581 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
5582 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
5583 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
5584
5585 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
5586
5587 @table @code
5588 @item list @var{linenum}
5589 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
5590 current source file.
5591
5592 @item list @var{function}
5593 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
5594 @var{function}.
5595
5596 @item list
5597 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
5598 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
5599 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
5600 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
5601 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
5602
5603 @item list -
5604 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5605 @end table
5606
5607 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
5608 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
5609 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
5610
5611 @table @code
5612 @kindex set listsize
5613 @item set listsize @var{count}
5614 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
5615 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
5616
5617 @kindex show listsize
5618 @item show listsize
5619 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
5620 @end table
5621
5622 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
5623 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
5624 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
5625 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
5626 each repetition moves up in the source file.
5627
5628 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
5629 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
5630 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
5631 to specify some source line.
5632
5633 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
5634
5635 @table @code
5636 @item list @var{linespec}
5637 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
5638
5639 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
5640 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
5641 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
5642 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5643 the same source file as the first linespec.
5644
5645 @item list ,@var{last}
5646 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5647
5648 @item list @var{first},
5649 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5650
5651 @item list +
5652 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5653
5654 @item list -
5655 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5656
5657 @item list
5658 As described in the preceding table.
5659 @end table
5660
5661 @node Specify Location
5662 @section Specifying a Location
5663 @cindex specifying location
5664 @cindex linespec
5665
5666 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5667 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5668 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5669 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5670
5671 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5672 @value{GDBN} understands:
5673
5674 @table @code
5675 @item @var{linenum}
5676 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5677
5678 @item -@var{offset}
5679 @itemx +@var{offset}
5680 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5681 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5682 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5683 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5684 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5685 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5686 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5687 linespec.
5688
5689 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5690 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5691
5692 @item @var{function}
5693 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5694 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5695
5696 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5697 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5698 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5699 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5700 functions in different source files.
5701
5702 @item *@var{address}
5703 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5704 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5705 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5706 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5707 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5708 source files.
5709
5710 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5711 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5712 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5713 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5714 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5715 of @var{address}:
5716
5717 @table @code
5718 @item @var{expression}
5719 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5720
5721 @item @var{funcaddr}
5722 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5723 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5724 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5725 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5726 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5727 (although the Pascal form also works).
5728
5729 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5730 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5731
5732 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5733 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5734 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5735 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5736 functions with identical names in different source files.
5737 @end table
5738
5739 @end table
5740
5741
5742 @node Edit
5743 @section Editing Source Files
5744 @cindex editing source files
5745
5746 @kindex edit
5747 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5748 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5749 The editing program of your choice
5750 is invoked with the current line set to
5751 the active line in the program.
5752 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5753 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5754
5755 @table @code
5756 @item edit @var{location}
5757 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5758 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5759 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5760 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5761 command most commonly used:
5762
5763 @table @code
5764 @item edit @var{number}
5765 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5766
5767 @item edit @var{function}
5768 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5769 @end table
5770
5771 @end table
5772
5773 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5774 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5775 @footnote{
5776 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5777 following command-line syntax:
5778 @smallexample
5779 ex +@var{number} file
5780 @end smallexample
5781 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5782 the file where to start editing.}.
5783 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5784 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5785 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5786 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5787 @smallexample
5788 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5789 export EDITOR
5790 gdb @dots{}
5791 @end smallexample
5792 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5793 @smallexample
5794 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5795 gdb @dots{}
5796 @end smallexample
5797
5798 @node Search
5799 @section Searching Source Files
5800 @cindex searching source files
5801
5802 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5803 regular expression.
5804
5805 @table @code
5806 @kindex search
5807 @kindex forward-search
5808 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5809 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5810 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5811 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5812 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5813 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5814 @code{fo}.
5815
5816 @kindex reverse-search
5817 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5818 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5819 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5820 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5821 this command as @code{rev}.
5822 @end table
5823
5824 @node Source Path
5825 @section Specifying Source Directories
5826
5827 @cindex source path
5828 @cindex directories for source files
5829 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5830 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5831 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5832 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5833 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5834 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5835 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5836
5837 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5838 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5839 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5840 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5841 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5842 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5843 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5844 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5845 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5846 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5847 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5848
5849 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5850 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5851 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5852 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5853 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5854 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5855
5856 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5857 source files.
5858
5859 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5860 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5861 each line is in the file.
5862
5863 @kindex directory
5864 @kindex dir
5865 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5866 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5867 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5868
5869 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5870 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5871
5872 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5873 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5874 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5875 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5876 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5877 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5878 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5879 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5880 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5881 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5882 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5883 name to look up the sources.
5884
5885 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5886 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5887 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5888 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5889 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5890 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5891 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5892 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5893
5894 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5895 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5896 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5897 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5898 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5899 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5900 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5901
5902 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5903 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5904 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5905 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5906 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5907 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5908 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5909 command.
5910
5911 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5912 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5913 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5914 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5915 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5916 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5917 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5918
5919 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
5920 @cindex default source path substitution
5921 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
5922 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
5923 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
5924 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
5925 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
5926 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
5927 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
5928 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
5929 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
5930 together.
5931
5932 @table @code
5933 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5934 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5935 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5936 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5937 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5938 part of absolute file names) or
5939 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5940 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5941
5942 @kindex cdir
5943 @kindex cwd
5944 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5945 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5946 @cindex compilation directory
5947 @cindex current directory
5948 @cindex working directory
5949 @cindex directory, current
5950 @cindex directory, compilation
5951 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5952 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5953 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5954 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5955 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5956 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5957
5958 @item directory
5959 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5960
5961 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5962 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5963
5964 @item show directories
5965 @kindex show directories
5966 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5967
5968 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5969 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5970 @kindex set substitute-path
5971 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5972 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5973 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5974
5975 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5976 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5977
5978 @smallexample
5979 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5980 @end smallexample
5981
5982 @noindent
5983 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5984 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5985 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5986
5987 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5988 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5989 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5990 the substitution.
5991
5992 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5993
5994 @smallexample
5995 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5996 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5997 @end smallexample
5998
5999 @noindent
6000 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
6001 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
6002 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
6003 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
6004
6005
6006 @item unset substitute-path [path]
6007 @kindex unset substitute-path
6008 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
6009 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
6010 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
6011
6012 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
6013
6014 @item show substitute-path [path]
6015 @kindex show substitute-path
6016 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
6017 which would rewrite that path, if any.
6018
6019 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
6020 rules.
6021
6022 @end table
6023
6024 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
6025 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
6026 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
6027
6028 @enumerate
6029 @item
6030 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
6031
6032 @item
6033 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
6034 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
6035 directories in one command.
6036 @end enumerate
6037
6038 @node Machine Code
6039 @section Source and Machine Code
6040 @cindex source line and its code address
6041
6042 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
6043 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
6044 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
6045 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
6046 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6047 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
6048 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
6049 well as hex.
6050
6051 @table @code
6052 @kindex info line
6053 @item info line @var{linespec}
6054 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
6055 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
6056 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
6057 @end table
6058
6059 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
6060 the object code for the first line of function
6061 @code{m4_changequote}:
6062
6063 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
6064 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
6065 @smallexample
6066 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
6067 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
6068 @end smallexample
6069
6070 @noindent
6071 @cindex code address and its source line
6072 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
6073 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
6074 @smallexample
6075 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
6076 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
6077 @end smallexample
6078
6079 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
6080 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
6081 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
6082 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
6083 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
6084 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
6085 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
6086 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6087 Variables}).
6088
6089 @table @code
6090 @kindex disassemble
6091 @cindex assembly instructions
6092 @cindex instructions, assembly
6093 @cindex machine instructions
6094 @cindex listing machine instructions
6095 @item disassemble
6096 @itemx disassemble /m
6097 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
6098 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
6099 the @code{/m} modifier.
6100 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
6101 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
6102 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
6103 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
6104 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
6105 @end table
6106
6107 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
6108 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
6109
6110 @smallexample
6111 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
6112 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
6113 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
6114 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
6115 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6116 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
6117 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
6118 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
6119 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
6120 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6121 End of assembler dump.
6122 @end smallexample
6123
6124 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86:
6125
6126 @smallexample
6127 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
6128 Dump of assembler code for function main:
6129 5 @{
6130 0x08048330 <main+0>: push %ebp
6131 0x08048331 <main+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6132 0x08048333 <main+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6133 0x08048336 <main+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6134 0x08048339 <main+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6135
6136 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
6137 0x0804833c <main+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6138 0x08048343 <main+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6139
6140 7 return 0;
6141 8 @}
6142 0x08048348 <main+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6143 0x0804834d <main+29>: leave
6144 0x0804834e <main+30>: ret
6145
6146 End of assembler dump.
6147 @end smallexample
6148
6149 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
6150 mnemonics or other syntax.
6151
6152 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
6153 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
6154 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
6155 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
6156 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
6157
6158 @table @code
6159 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
6160 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
6161 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
6162 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
6163 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
6164 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
6165
6166 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
6167 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
6168 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
6169 assemblers for x86-based targets.
6170
6171 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
6172 @item show disassembly-flavor
6173 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
6174 @end table
6175
6176 @table @code
6177 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
6178 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
6179 @item set disassemble-next-line
6180 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
6181 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
6182 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
6183 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
6184 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
6185 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
6186 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
6187 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
6188 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
6189 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
6190 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
6191 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
6192 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
6193 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
6194 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
6195 instruction.
6196 @end table
6197
6198
6199 @node Data
6200 @chapter Examining Data
6201
6202 @cindex printing data
6203 @cindex examining data
6204 @kindex print
6205 @kindex inspect
6206 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
6207 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
6208 @c different window or something like that.
6209 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
6210 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
6211 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
6212 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
6213 Different Languages}).
6214
6215 @table @code
6216 @item print @var{expr}
6217 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
6218 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
6219 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
6220 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
6221 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
6222 Formats}.
6223
6224 @item print
6225 @itemx print /@var{f}
6226 @cindex reprint the last value
6227 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
6228 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
6229 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6230 @end table
6231
6232 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6233 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6234 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6235
6236 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6237 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6238 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6239 Table}.
6240
6241 @menu
6242 * Expressions:: Expressions
6243 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6244 * Variables:: Program variables
6245 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6246 * Output Formats:: Output formats
6247 * Memory:: Examining memory
6248 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
6249 * Print Settings:: Print settings
6250 * Value History:: Value history
6251 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6252 * Registers:: Registers
6253 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6254 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6255 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6256 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6257 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6258 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6259 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6260 character set than GDB does
6261 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6262 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
6263 @end menu
6264
6265 @node Expressions
6266 @section Expressions
6267
6268 @cindex expressions
6269 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
6270 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
6271 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
6272 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
6273 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
6274 you compiled your program to include this information; see
6275 @ref{Compilation}.
6276
6277 @cindex arrays in expressions
6278 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
6279 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
6280 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
6281 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
6282 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
6283 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
6284
6285 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
6286 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
6287 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
6288 languages.
6289
6290 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
6291 expressions regardless of your programming language.
6292
6293 @cindex casts, in expressions
6294 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
6295 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
6296 at that address in memory.
6297 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
6298
6299 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
6300 to programming languages:
6301
6302 @table @code
6303 @item @@
6304 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
6305 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
6306
6307 @item ::
6308 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
6309 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
6310
6311 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
6312 @cindex type casting memory
6313 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
6314 @cindex casts, to view memory
6315 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
6316 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
6317 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
6318 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
6319 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
6320 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
6321 @end table
6322
6323 @node Ambiguous Expressions
6324 @section Ambiguous Expressions
6325 @cindex ambiguous expressions
6326
6327 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
6328 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
6329 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
6330 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
6331 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
6332 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
6333 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
6334
6335 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
6336 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
6337 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
6338 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
6339 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
6340 as well.
6341
6342 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
6343 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
6344 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
6345 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
6346 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
6347 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
6348 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
6349 choices.
6350
6351 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
6352 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
6353 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
6354
6355 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
6356 @smallexample
6357 @group
6358 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
6359 [0] cancel
6360 [1] all
6361 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
6362 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
6363 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
6364 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
6365 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
6366 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
6367 > 2 4 6
6368 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
6369 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
6370 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
6371 Multiple breakpoints were set.
6372 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
6373 breakpoints.
6374 (@value{GDBP})
6375 @end group
6376 @end smallexample
6377
6378 @table @code
6379 @kindex set multiple-symbols
6380 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
6381 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
6382
6383 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
6384 is ambiguous.
6385
6386 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
6387 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
6388 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
6389 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
6390 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
6391 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
6392 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
6393 in the use of the menu.
6394
6395 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
6396 when an ambiguity is detected.
6397
6398 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
6399 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
6400
6401 @kindex show multiple-symbols
6402 @item show multiple-symbols
6403 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
6404 @end table
6405
6406 @node Variables
6407 @section Program Variables
6408
6409 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
6410 in your program.
6411
6412 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
6413 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
6414
6415 @itemize @bullet
6416 @item
6417 global (or file-static)
6418 @end itemize
6419
6420 @noindent or
6421
6422 @itemize @bullet
6423 @item
6424 visible according to the scope rules of the
6425 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
6426 @end itemize
6427
6428 @noindent This means that in the function
6429
6430 @smallexample
6431 foo (a)
6432 int a;
6433 @{
6434 bar (a);
6435 @{
6436 int b = test ();
6437 bar (b);
6438 @}
6439 @}
6440 @end smallexample
6441
6442 @noindent
6443 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
6444 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
6445 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
6446 the block where @code{b} is declared.
6447
6448 @cindex variable name conflict
6449 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
6450 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
6451 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
6452 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
6453 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
6454 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
6455 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
6456
6457 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
6458 @ifnotinfo
6459 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
6460 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
6461 @end ifnotinfo
6462 @smallexample
6463 @var{file}::@var{variable}
6464 @var{function}::@var{variable}
6465 @end smallexample
6466
6467 @noindent
6468 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
6469 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
6470 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
6471 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
6472
6473 @smallexample
6474 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
6475 @end smallexample
6476
6477 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
6478 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
6479 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
6480 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
6481 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
6482 @c conflict?? --mew
6483
6484 @cindex wrong values
6485 @cindex variable values, wrong
6486 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
6487 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
6488 @quotation
6489 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
6490 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
6491 scope, and just before exit.
6492 @end quotation
6493 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
6494 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
6495 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
6496 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
6497 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
6498 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
6499 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
6500 variable definitions may be gone.
6501
6502 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
6503 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
6504 when compiling.
6505
6506 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
6507 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
6508 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
6509 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
6510 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
6511 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
6512 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
6513
6514 @smallexample
6515 No symbol "foo" in current context.
6516 @end smallexample
6517
6518 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
6519 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
6520 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
6521 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
6522 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
6523 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
6524 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
6525 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
6526 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
6527 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
6528 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
6529
6530 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
6531 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
6532 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
6533 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
6534
6535 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
6536 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
6537 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
6538 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
6539 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
6540 For program code
6541
6542 @smallexample
6543 char var0[] = "A";
6544 signed char var1[] = "A";
6545 @end smallexample
6546
6547 You get during debugging
6548 @smallexample
6549 (gdb) print var0
6550 $1 = "A"
6551 (gdb) print var1
6552 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
6553 @end smallexample
6554
6555 @node Arrays
6556 @section Artificial Arrays
6557
6558 @cindex artificial array
6559 @cindex arrays
6560 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
6561 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
6562 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
6563 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
6564 program.
6565
6566 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
6567 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
6568 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
6569 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
6570 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
6571 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
6572 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
6573 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
6574 example. If a program says
6575
6576 @smallexample
6577 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
6578 @end smallexample
6579
6580 @noindent
6581 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
6582
6583 @smallexample
6584 p *array@@len
6585 @end smallexample
6586
6587 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
6588 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
6589 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
6590 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
6591 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
6592
6593 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
6594 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
6595 The value need not be in memory:
6596 @smallexample
6597 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
6598 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6599 @end smallexample
6600
6601 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
6602 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
6603 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
6604 @smallexample
6605 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
6606 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6607 @end smallexample
6608
6609 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
6610 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
6611 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
6612 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
6613 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6614 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
6615 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
6616 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
6617 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
6618 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
6619
6620 @smallexample
6621 set $i = 0
6622 p dtab[$i++]->fv
6623 @key{RET}
6624 @key{RET}
6625 @dots{}
6626 @end smallexample
6627
6628 @node Output Formats
6629 @section Output Formats
6630
6631 @cindex formatted output
6632 @cindex output formats
6633 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
6634 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
6635 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
6636 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
6637 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
6638
6639 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
6640 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
6641 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
6642 letters supported are:
6643
6644 @table @code
6645 @item x
6646 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
6647 hexadecimal.
6648
6649 @item d
6650 Print as integer in signed decimal.
6651
6652 @item u
6653 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
6654
6655 @item o
6656 Print as integer in octal.
6657
6658 @item t
6659 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
6660 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
6661 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
6662 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
6663
6664 @item a
6665 @cindex unknown address, locating
6666 @cindex locate address
6667 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
6668 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
6669 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
6670
6671 @smallexample
6672 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
6673 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
6674 @end smallexample
6675
6676 @noindent
6677 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
6678 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
6679
6680 @item c
6681 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
6682 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
6683 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
6684 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
6685
6686 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
6687 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
6688 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
6689 data.
6690
6691 @item f
6692 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
6693 using typical floating point syntax.
6694
6695 @item s
6696 @cindex printing strings
6697 @cindex printing byte arrays
6698 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
6699 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
6700 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
6701 natural types.
6702
6703 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
6704 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
6705 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
6706 array.
6707 @end table
6708
6709 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
6710
6711 @smallexample
6712 p/x $pc
6713 @end smallexample
6714
6715 @noindent
6716 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
6717 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
6718
6719 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
6720 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
6721 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
6722
6723 @node Memory
6724 @section Examining Memory
6725
6726 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
6727 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
6728
6729 @cindex examining memory
6730 @table @code
6731 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
6732 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
6733 @itemx x @var{addr}
6734 @itemx x
6735 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
6736 @end table
6737
6738 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
6739 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
6740 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
6741 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
6742 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
6743
6744 @table @r
6745 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
6746 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
6747 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
6748 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
6749 @c 4.1.2.
6750
6751 @item @var{f}, the display format
6752 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
6753 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
6754 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
6755 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
6756 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
6757
6758 @item @var{u}, the unit size
6759 The unit size is any of
6760
6761 @table @code
6762 @item b
6763 Bytes.
6764 @item h
6765 Halfwords (two bytes).
6766 @item w
6767 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6768 @item g
6769 Giant words (eight bytes).
6770 @end table
6771
6772 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6773 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6774 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6775
6776 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
6777 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6778 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6779 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6780 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6781 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6782 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6783 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6784 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6785 a value from memory).
6786 @end table
6787
6788 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6789 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6790 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6791 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6792 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6793
6794 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6795 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6796 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6797 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6798 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6799
6800 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6801 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6802 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6803 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6804 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6805 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6806 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6807 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6808 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6809
6810 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6811 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6812 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6813 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6814 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6815 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6816 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6817
6818 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6819 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6820 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6821 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6822 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6823 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6824 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6825 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6826 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6827
6828 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6829 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6830 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6831
6832 @cindex remote memory comparison
6833 @cindex verify remote memory image
6834 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6835 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6836 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6837 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6838 situations.
6839
6840 @table @code
6841 @kindex compare-sections
6842 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6843 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6844 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6845 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6846 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6847 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6848 remote request.
6849 @end table
6850
6851 @node Auto Display
6852 @section Automatic Display
6853 @cindex automatic display
6854 @cindex display of expressions
6855
6856 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6857 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6858 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6859 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6860 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6861 The automatic display looks like this:
6862
6863 @smallexample
6864 2: foo = 38
6865 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6866 @end smallexample
6867
6868 @noindent
6869 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6870 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6871 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6872 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6873 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6874 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6875
6876 @table @code
6877 @kindex display
6878 @item display @var{expr}
6879 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6880 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6881
6882 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6883
6884 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6885 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6886 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6887 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6888 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6889
6890 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6891 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6892 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6893 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6894 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6895 @end table
6896
6897 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6898 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6899 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6900
6901 @table @code
6902 @kindex delete display
6903 @kindex undisplay
6904 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6905 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6906 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6907
6908 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6909 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6910
6911 @kindex disable display
6912 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6913 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6914 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6915 enabled again later.
6916
6917 @kindex enable display
6918 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6919 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6920 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6921
6922 @item display
6923 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6924 done when your program stops.
6925
6926 @kindex info display
6927 @item info display
6928 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6929 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6930 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6931 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6932 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6933 @end table
6934
6935 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6936 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6937 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6938 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6939 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6940 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6941 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6942 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6943 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6944 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6945 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6946
6947 @node Print Settings
6948 @section Print Settings
6949
6950 @cindex format options
6951 @cindex print settings
6952 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6953 and symbols are printed.
6954
6955 @noindent
6956 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6957
6958 @table @code
6959 @kindex set print
6960 @item set print address
6961 @itemx set print address on
6962 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6963 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6964 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6965 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6966 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6967 @code{set print address on}:
6968
6969 @smallexample
6970 @group
6971 (@value{GDBP}) f
6972 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6973 at input.c:530
6974 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6975 @end group
6976 @end smallexample
6977
6978 @item set print address off
6979 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6980 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6981
6982 @smallexample
6983 @group
6984 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6985 (@value{GDBP}) f
6986 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6987 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6988 @end group
6989 @end smallexample
6990
6991 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6992 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6993 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6994 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6995
6996 @kindex show print
6997 @item show print address
6998 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6999 @end table
7000
7001 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
7002 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
7003 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
7004 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
7005 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
7006 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
7007 it prints a symbolic address:
7008
7009 @table @code
7010 @item set print symbol-filename on
7011 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
7012 @cindex symbol, source file and line
7013 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
7014 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7015
7016 @item set print symbol-filename off
7017 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
7018 default.
7019
7020 @item show print symbol-filename
7021 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
7022 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7023 @end table
7024
7025 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
7026 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
7027 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
7028
7029 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
7030 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
7031
7032 @table @code
7033 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
7034 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
7035 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
7036 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
7037 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
7038 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
7039
7040 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
7041 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
7042 symbolic address.
7043 @end table
7044
7045 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
7046 @cindex pointer, finding referent
7047 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
7048 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
7049 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
7050 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
7051 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
7052 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
7053
7054 @smallexample
7055 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
7056 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
7057 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
7058 @end smallexample
7059
7060 @quotation
7061 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
7062 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
7063 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
7064 @end quotation
7065
7066 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
7067
7068 @table @code
7069 @item set print array
7070 @itemx set print array on
7071 @cindex pretty print arrays
7072 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
7073 but uses more space. The default is off.
7074
7075 @item set print array off
7076 Return to compressed format for arrays.
7077
7078 @item show print array
7079 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
7080 arrays.
7081
7082 @cindex print array indexes
7083 @item set print array-indexes
7084 @itemx set print array-indexes on
7085 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
7086 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
7087 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
7088
7089 @item set print array-indexes off
7090 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
7091
7092 @item show print array-indexes
7093 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
7094 arrays.
7095
7096 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
7097 @cindex number of array elements to print
7098 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
7099 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
7100 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
7101 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
7102 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
7103 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
7104 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
7105
7106 @item show print elements
7107 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
7108 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
7109
7110 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
7111 @kindex set print frame-arguments
7112 @cindex printing frame argument values
7113 @cindex print all frame argument values
7114 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
7115 @cindex do not print frame argument values
7116 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
7117 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
7118 values are:
7119
7120 @table @code
7121 @item all
7122 The values of all arguments are printed.
7123
7124 @item scalars
7125 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
7126 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
7127 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
7128 only scalar arguments are shown:
7129
7130 @smallexample
7131 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
7132 at frame-args.c:23
7133 @end smallexample
7134
7135 @item none
7136 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
7137 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
7138
7139 @smallexample
7140 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
7141 at frame-args.c:23
7142 @end smallexample
7143 @end table
7144
7145 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
7146 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
7147 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
7148 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
7149 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
7150 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
7151 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
7152 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
7153 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
7154 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
7155
7156 @item show print frame-arguments
7157 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
7158
7159 @item set print repeats
7160 @cindex repeated array elements
7161 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
7162 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
7163 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
7164 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
7165 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
7166 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
7167 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
7168
7169 @item show print repeats
7170 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
7171 elements.
7172
7173 @item set print null-stop
7174 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
7175 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
7176 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
7177 contain only short strings.
7178 The default is off.
7179
7180 @item show print null-stop
7181 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
7182 @sc{null} character.
7183
7184 @item set print pretty on
7185 @cindex print structures in indented form
7186 @cindex indentation in structure display
7187 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
7188 per line, like this:
7189
7190 @smallexample
7191 @group
7192 $1 = @{
7193 next = 0x0,
7194 flags = @{
7195 sweet = 1,
7196 sour = 1
7197 @},
7198 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
7199 @}
7200 @end group
7201 @end smallexample
7202
7203 @item set print pretty off
7204 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
7205
7206 @smallexample
7207 @group
7208 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
7209 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
7210 @end group
7211 @end smallexample
7212
7213 @noindent
7214 This is the default format.
7215
7216 @item show print pretty
7217 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
7218
7219 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
7220 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
7221 @cindex octal escapes in strings
7222 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
7223 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
7224 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
7225 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
7226 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
7227
7228 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
7229 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
7230 international character sets, and is the default.
7231
7232 @item show print sevenbit-strings
7233 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7234
7235 @item set print union on
7236 @cindex unions in structures, printing
7237 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
7238 and other unions. This is the default setting.
7239
7240 @item set print union off
7241 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
7242 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
7243 instead.
7244
7245 @item show print union
7246 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
7247 structures and other unions.
7248
7249 For example, given the declarations
7250
7251 @smallexample
7252 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
7253 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
7254 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
7255 Bug_forms;
7256
7257 struct thing @{
7258 Species it;
7259 union @{
7260 Tree_forms tree;
7261 Bug_forms bug;
7262 @} form;
7263 @};
7264
7265 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
7266 @end smallexample
7267
7268 @noindent
7269 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
7270
7271 @smallexample
7272 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
7273 @end smallexample
7274
7275 @noindent
7276 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
7277
7278 @smallexample
7279 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
7280 @end smallexample
7281
7282 @noindent
7283 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
7284 and in Pascal.
7285 @end table
7286
7287 @need 1000
7288 @noindent
7289 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
7290
7291 @table @code
7292 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
7293 @item set print demangle
7294 @itemx set print demangle on
7295 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
7296 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
7297 linkage. The default is on.
7298
7299 @item show print demangle
7300 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
7301
7302 @item set print asm-demangle
7303 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
7304 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
7305 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
7306 The default is off.
7307
7308 @item show print asm-demangle
7309 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
7310 or demangled form.
7311
7312 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
7313 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
7314 @kindex set demangle-style
7315 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
7316 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
7317 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
7318
7319 @table @code
7320 @item auto
7321 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
7322
7323 @item gnu
7324 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
7325 This is the default.
7326
7327 @item hp
7328 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
7329
7330 @item lucid
7331 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
7332
7333 @item arm
7334 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
7335 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
7336 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
7337 require further enhancement to permit that.
7338
7339 @end table
7340 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
7341
7342 @item show demangle-style
7343 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
7344
7345 @item set print object
7346 @itemx set print object on
7347 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
7348 @cindex display derived types
7349 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
7350 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
7351 the virtual function table.
7352
7353 @item set print object off
7354 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
7355 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
7356
7357 @item show print object
7358 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
7359
7360 @item set print static-members
7361 @itemx set print static-members on
7362 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
7363 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
7364
7365 @item set print static-members off
7366 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
7367
7368 @item show print static-members
7369 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
7370
7371 @item set print pascal_static-members
7372 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
7373 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
7374 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
7375 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
7376
7377 @item set print pascal_static-members off
7378 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
7379
7380 @item show print pascal_static-members
7381 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
7382
7383 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
7384 @item set print vtbl
7385 @itemx set print vtbl on
7386 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
7387 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
7388 @cindex VTBL display
7389 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
7390 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7391 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7392
7393 @item set print vtbl off
7394 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
7395
7396 @item show print vtbl
7397 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
7398 @end table
7399
7400 @node Value History
7401 @section Value History
7402
7403 @cindex value history
7404 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
7405 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
7406 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
7407 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
7408 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
7409 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
7410 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
7411 symbol table.
7412
7413 @cindex @code{$}
7414 @cindex @code{$$}
7415 @cindex history number
7416 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
7417 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
7418 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
7419 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
7420 history number.
7421
7422 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
7423 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
7424 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
7425 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
7426 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
7427 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
7428 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
7429
7430 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
7431 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
7432
7433 @smallexample
7434 p *$
7435 @end smallexample
7436
7437 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
7438 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
7439
7440 @smallexample
7441 p *$.next
7442 @end smallexample
7443
7444 @noindent
7445 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
7446 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
7447
7448 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
7449 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
7450
7451 @smallexample
7452 print x
7453 set x=5
7454 @end smallexample
7455
7456 @noindent
7457 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
7458 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
7459
7460 @table @code
7461 @kindex show values
7462 @item show values
7463 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
7464 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
7465 values} does not change the history.
7466
7467 @item show values @var{n}
7468 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
7469
7470 @item show values +
7471 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
7472 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
7473 @end table
7474
7475 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
7476 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
7477
7478 @node Convenience Vars
7479 @section Convenience Variables
7480
7481 @cindex convenience variables
7482 @cindex user-defined variables
7483 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
7484 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
7485 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
7486 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
7487 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
7488
7489 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
7490 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
7491 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7492 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
7493 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
7494
7495 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
7496 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
7497 For example:
7498
7499 @smallexample
7500 set $foo = *object_ptr
7501 @end smallexample
7502
7503 @noindent
7504 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
7505 @code{object_ptr}.
7506
7507 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
7508 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
7509 value with another assignment at any time.
7510
7511 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
7512 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
7513 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
7514 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
7515
7516 @table @code
7517 @kindex show convenience
7518 @cindex show all user variables
7519 @item show convenience
7520 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
7521 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
7522
7523 @kindex init-if-undefined
7524 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
7525 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
7526 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
7527 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
7528 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
7529 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
7530 override default values used in a command script.
7531
7532 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
7533 any side-effects do not occur.
7534 @end table
7535
7536 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
7537 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
7538 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
7539
7540 @smallexample
7541 set $i = 0
7542 print bar[$i++]->contents
7543 @end smallexample
7544
7545 @noindent
7546 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
7547
7548 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
7549 values likely to be useful.
7550
7551 @table @code
7552 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
7553 @item $_
7554 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
7555 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
7556 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
7557 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
7558 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
7559 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
7560 to the type of @code{$__}.
7561
7562 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
7563 @item $__
7564 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
7565 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
7566 to match the format in which the data was printed.
7567
7568 @item $_exitcode
7569 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
7570 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
7571 the program being debugged terminates.
7572
7573 @item $_siginfo
7574 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
7575 The variable @code{$_siginfo} is bound to extra signal information
7576 inspection (@pxref{extra signal information}).
7577 @end table
7578
7579 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
7580 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
7581 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
7582
7583 @cindex convenience functions
7584 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
7585 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
7586 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
7587 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
7588 @value{GDBN}.
7589
7590 @table @code
7591 @item help function
7592 @kindex help function
7593 @cindex show all convenience functions
7594 Print a list of all convenience functions.
7595 @end table
7596
7597 @node Registers
7598 @section Registers
7599
7600 @cindex registers
7601 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
7602 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
7603 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
7604 your machine.
7605
7606 @table @code
7607 @kindex info registers
7608 @item info registers
7609 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
7610 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7611
7612 @kindex info all-registers
7613 @cindex floating point registers
7614 @item info all-registers
7615 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
7616 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7617
7618 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
7619 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
7620 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
7621 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
7622 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
7623 @end table
7624
7625 @cindex stack pointer register
7626 @cindex program counter register
7627 @cindex process status register
7628 @cindex frame pointer register
7629 @cindex standard registers
7630 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
7631 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
7632 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
7633 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
7634 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
7635 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
7636 register that contains the processor status. For example,
7637 you could print the program counter in hex with
7638
7639 @smallexample
7640 p/x $pc
7641 @end smallexample
7642
7643 @noindent
7644 or print the instruction to be executed next with
7645
7646 @smallexample
7647 x/i $pc
7648 @end smallexample
7649
7650 @noindent
7651 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
7652 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
7653 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
7654 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
7655 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
7656 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
7657 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
7658
7659 @smallexample
7660 set $sp += 4
7661 @end smallexample
7662
7663 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
7664 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
7665 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
7666 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
7667 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
7668 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
7669 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
7670
7671 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
7672 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
7673 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
7674 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
7675 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
7676 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
7677 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
7678
7679 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
7680 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
7681 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
7682 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
7683 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
7684 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
7685 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
7686 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
7687 prints the data in both formats.
7688
7689 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
7690 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
7691 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
7692 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
7693 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
7694 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
7695 registers in @code{struct} notation:
7696
7697 @smallexample
7698 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
7699 $1 = @{
7700 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
7701 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
7702 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
7703 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
7704 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
7705 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
7706 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
7707 @}
7708 @end smallexample
7709
7710 @noindent
7711 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
7712 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
7713 value to a @code{struct} member:
7714
7715 @smallexample
7716 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
7717 @end smallexample
7718
7719 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
7720 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
7721 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
7722 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
7723 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
7724 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
7725
7726 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
7727 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
7728 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
7729 frame makes no difference.
7730
7731 @node Floating Point Hardware
7732 @section Floating Point Hardware
7733 @cindex floating point
7734
7735 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
7736 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
7737
7738 @table @code
7739 @kindex info float
7740 @item info float
7741 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
7742 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
7743 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
7744 the ARM and x86 machines.
7745 @end table
7746
7747 @node Vector Unit
7748 @section Vector Unit
7749 @cindex vector unit
7750
7751 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
7752 more information about the status of the vector unit.
7753
7754 @table @code
7755 @kindex info vector
7756 @item info vector
7757 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
7758 layout vary depending on the hardware.
7759 @end table
7760
7761 @node OS Information
7762 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
7763 @cindex OS information
7764
7765 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
7766 you debug your program.
7767
7768 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
7769 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
7770 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
7771 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
7772 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
7773 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
7774 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
7775 structure.
7776
7777 @table @code
7778 @item info udot
7779 @kindex info udot
7780 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
7781 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
7782 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
7783 the @code{examine} command.
7784 @end table
7785
7786 @cindex auxiliary vector
7787 @cindex vector, auxiliary
7788 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7789 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7790 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7791 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7792 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7793 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7794 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7795 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7796 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7797 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7798 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7799
7800 @table @code
7801 @kindex info auxv
7802 @item info auxv
7803 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7804 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7805 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7806 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7807 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7808 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7809 an unrecognized tag.
7810 @end table
7811
7812 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
7813 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
7814 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
7815 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
7816
7817 @table @code
7818 @kindex info os processes
7819 @item info os processes
7820 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
7821 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
7822 the command corresponding to the process.
7823 @end table
7824
7825 @node Memory Region Attributes
7826 @section Memory Region Attributes
7827 @cindex memory region attributes
7828
7829 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7830 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7831 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7832 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7833 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7834 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7835 user can override the fetched regions.
7836
7837 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7838 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7839 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7840 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7841 all memory.
7842
7843 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7844 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7845
7846 @table @code
7847 @kindex mem
7848 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7849 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7850 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7851 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7852 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7853 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7854
7855 @item mem auto
7856 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7857 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7858
7859 @kindex delete mem
7860 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7861 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7862 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7863
7864 @kindex disable mem
7865 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7866 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7867 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7868 It may be enabled again later.
7869
7870 @kindex enable mem
7871 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7872 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7873
7874 @kindex info mem
7875 @item info mem
7876 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7877 for each region:
7878
7879 @table @emph
7880 @item Memory Region Number
7881 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7882 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7883 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7884
7885 @item Lo Address
7886 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7887
7888 @item Hi Address
7889 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7890
7891 @item Attributes
7892 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7893 @end table
7894 @end table
7895
7896
7897 @subsection Attributes
7898
7899 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7900 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7901 write accesses to a memory region.
7902
7903 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7904 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7905 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7906
7907 @table @code
7908 @item ro
7909 Memory is read only.
7910 @item wo
7911 Memory is write only.
7912 @item rw
7913 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7914 @end table
7915
7916 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7917 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7918 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7919 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7920 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7921
7922 @table @code
7923 @item 8
7924 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7925 @item 16
7926 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7927 @item 32
7928 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7929 @item 64
7930 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7931 @end table
7932
7933 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7934 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7935 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7936 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7937 @c
7938 @c @table @code
7939 @c @item hwbreak
7940 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7941 @c @item swbreak (default)
7942 @c @end table
7943
7944 @subsubsection Data Cache
7945 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7946 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7947 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7948 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7949 registers.
7950
7951 @table @code
7952 @item cache
7953 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7954 @item nocache
7955 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7956 @end table
7957
7958 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7959 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7960 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7961 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7962 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7963
7964 @table @code
7965 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7966 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7967 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7968 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7969 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7970 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7971 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7972 The default value is @code{on}.
7973 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7974 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7975 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7976 @end table
7977
7978
7979 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7980 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7981 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7982 @c
7983 @c @table @code
7984 @c @item verify
7985 @c @item noverify (default)
7986 @c @end table
7987
7988 @node Dump/Restore Files
7989 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7990 @cindex dump/restore files
7991 @cindex append data to a file
7992 @cindex dump data to a file
7993 @cindex restore data from a file
7994
7995 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7996 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7997 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7998 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7999 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
8000 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
8001 files.
8002
8003 @table @code
8004
8005 @kindex dump
8006 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8007 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8008 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8009 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
8010
8011 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
8012 @table @code
8013 @item binary
8014 Raw binary form.
8015 @item ihex
8016 Intel hex format.
8017 @item srec
8018 Motorola S-record format.
8019 @item tekhex
8020 Tektronix Hex format.
8021 @end table
8022
8023 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
8024 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
8025 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
8026 form.
8027
8028 @kindex append
8029 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8030 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8031 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8032 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
8033 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
8034
8035 @kindex restore
8036 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
8037 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
8038 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
8039 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
8040 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
8041
8042 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
8043 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
8044 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
8045 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
8046 from that location.
8047
8048 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
8049 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
8050 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
8051 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
8052
8053 @end table
8054
8055 @node Core File Generation
8056 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
8057 @cindex dump core from inferior
8058
8059 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
8060 image of a running process and its process status (register values
8061 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
8062 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
8063 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
8064 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
8065 the post-mortem debugging mode.
8066
8067 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
8068 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
8069 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
8070
8071 @table @code
8072 @kindex gcore
8073 @kindex generate-core-file
8074 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
8075 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
8076 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
8077 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
8078 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
8079 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
8080
8081 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
8082 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
8083 @end table
8084
8085 @node Character Sets
8086 @section Character Sets
8087 @cindex character sets
8088 @cindex charset
8089 @cindex translating between character sets
8090 @cindex host character set
8091 @cindex target character set
8092
8093 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
8094 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
8095 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
8096 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
8097 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
8098 @dfn{target character set}.
8099
8100 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
8101 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
8102 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
8103 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
8104 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
8105 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
8106 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
8107 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
8108 character and string literals in expressions.
8109
8110 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
8111 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
8112 target-charset} command, described below.
8113
8114 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
8115 support:
8116
8117 @table @code
8118 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
8119 @kindex set target-charset
8120 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
8121 list of supported target character sets, type
8122 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8123
8124 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
8125 @kindex set host-charset
8126 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
8127
8128 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
8129 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
8130 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
8131 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
8132 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
8133
8134 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
8135 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8136 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
8137
8138 @item set charset @var{charset}
8139 @kindex set charset
8140 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
8141 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8142 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
8143 for both host and target.
8144
8145 @item show charset
8146 @kindex show charset
8147 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
8148
8149 @item show host-charset
8150 @kindex show host-charset
8151 Show the name of the current host character set.
8152
8153 @item show target-charset
8154 @kindex show target-charset
8155 Show the name of the current target character set.
8156
8157 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
8158 @kindex set target-wide-charset
8159 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
8160 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
8161 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
8162 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8163
8164 @item show target-wide-charset
8165 @kindex show target-wide-charset
8166 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
8167 @end table
8168
8169 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
8170 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
8171 @file{charset-test.c}:
8172
8173 @smallexample
8174 #include <stdio.h>
8175
8176 char ascii_hello[]
8177 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
8178 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
8179 char ibm1047_hello[]
8180 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
8181 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
8182
8183 main ()
8184 @{
8185 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8186 @}
8187 @end smallexample
8188
8189 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
8190 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
8191 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
8192
8193 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
8194
8195 @smallexample
8196 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
8197 $ gdb -nw charset-test
8198 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
8199 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8200 @dots{}
8201 (@value{GDBP})
8202 @end smallexample
8203
8204 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
8205 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
8206 strings:
8207
8208 @smallexample
8209 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8210 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
8211 (@value{GDBP})
8212 @end smallexample
8213
8214 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
8215 initial character set:
8216 @smallexample
8217 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
8218 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8219 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
8220 (@value{GDBP})
8221 @end smallexample
8222
8223 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
8224 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
8225 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
8226 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
8227 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
8228
8229 @smallexample
8230 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8231 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
8232 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8233 $2 = 72 'H'
8234 (@value{GDBP})
8235 @end smallexample
8236
8237 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
8238 literals you use in expressions:
8239
8240 @smallexample
8241 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8242 $3 = 43 '+'
8243 (@value{GDBP})
8244 @end smallexample
8245
8246 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
8247 character.
8248
8249 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
8250 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
8251 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
8252
8253 @smallexample
8254 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8255 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
8256 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8257 $5 = 200 '\310'
8258 (@value{GDBP})
8259 @end smallexample
8260
8261 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
8262 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
8263
8264 @smallexample
8265 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8266 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
8267 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8268 @end smallexample
8269
8270 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
8271 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
8272 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
8273 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
8274 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
8275
8276 @smallexample
8277 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
8278 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8279 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
8280 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
8281 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8282 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
8283 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8284 $7 = 72 '\110'
8285 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8286 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
8287 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8288 $9 = 200 'H'
8289 (@value{GDBP})
8290 @end smallexample
8291
8292 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
8293 string literals you use in expressions:
8294
8295 @smallexample
8296 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8297 $10 = 78 '+'
8298 (@value{GDBP})
8299 @end smallexample
8300
8301 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
8302 character.
8303
8304 @node Caching Remote Data
8305 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
8306 @cindex caching data of remote targets
8307
8308 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
8309 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
8310 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
8311 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
8312 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
8313 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
8314 volatile registers are in use.
8315
8316 @table @code
8317 @kindex set remotecache
8318 @item set remotecache on
8319 @itemx set remotecache off
8320 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
8321 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
8322
8323 @kindex show remotecache
8324 @item show remotecache
8325 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
8326
8327 @kindex info dcache
8328 @item info dcache
8329 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
8330 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
8331 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
8332 state (invalid, dirty, valid). This command is useful for debugging
8333 the data cache operation.
8334 @end table
8335
8336 @node Searching Memory
8337 @section Search Memory
8338 @cindex searching memory
8339
8340 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
8341 @code{find} command.
8342
8343 @table @code
8344 @kindex find
8345 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8346 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8347 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
8348 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
8349 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
8350 @end table
8351
8352 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
8353 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
8354
8355 @table @r
8356 @item @var{s}, search query size
8357 The size of each search query value.
8358
8359 @table @code
8360 @item b
8361 bytes
8362 @item h
8363 halfwords (two bytes)
8364 @item w
8365 words (four bytes)
8366 @item g
8367 giant words (eight bytes)
8368 @end table
8369
8370 All values are interpreted in the current language.
8371 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
8372 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
8373
8374 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
8375 value's type in the current language.
8376 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
8377 pattern as a mixture of types.
8378 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
8379 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
8380 which is typically four bytes.
8381
8382 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
8383 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
8384 @end table
8385
8386 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
8387 (@code{"}).
8388 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
8389 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
8390
8391 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
8392 number of matches found.
8393
8394 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
8395 @samp{$_}.
8396 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
8397
8398 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
8399
8400 @smallexample
8401 void
8402 hello ()
8403 @{
8404 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
8405 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
8406 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
8407 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
8408 printf ("%s\n", hello);
8409 @}
8410 @end smallexample
8411
8412 @noindent
8413 you get during debugging:
8414
8415 @smallexample
8416 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
8417 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8418 1 pattern found
8419 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
8420 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8421 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8422 2 patterns found
8423 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
8424 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8425 1 pattern found
8426 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
8427 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
8428 1 pattern found
8429 (gdb) print $numfound
8430 $1 = 1
8431 (gdb) print $_
8432 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
8433 @end smallexample
8434
8435 @node Macros
8436 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
8437
8438 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
8439 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
8440 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
8441 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
8442 where it was defined.
8443
8444 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
8445 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
8446 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
8447 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
8448
8449 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
8450 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
8451 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
8452 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
8453 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
8454 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
8455 see @ref{List}.
8456
8457 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
8458 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
8459 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
8460
8461 @table @code
8462
8463 @kindex macro expand
8464 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
8465 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
8466 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
8467 @item macro expand @var{expression}
8468 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
8469 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
8470 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
8471 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
8472 it can be any string of tokens.
8473
8474 @kindex macro exp1
8475 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
8476 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
8477 @cindex expand macro once
8478 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
8479 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
8480 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
8481 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
8482 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
8483 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
8484 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
8485 can be any string of tokens.
8486
8487 @kindex info macro
8488 @cindex macro definition, showing
8489 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
8490 @item info macro @var{macro}
8491 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
8492 source location or compiler command-line where that definition was established.
8493
8494 @kindex macro define
8495 @cindex user-defined macros
8496 @cindex defining macros interactively
8497 @cindex macros, user-defined
8498 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
8499 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
8500 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
8501 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
8502 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
8503 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
8504 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
8505 @var{arglist}.
8506
8507 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
8508 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
8509 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
8510 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
8511 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
8512
8513 @kindex macro undef
8514 @item macro undef @var{macro}
8515 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
8516 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
8517 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
8518 in the program being debugged.
8519
8520 @kindex macro list
8521 @item macro list
8522 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
8523 @end table
8524
8525 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
8526 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
8527 show our source files:
8528
8529 @smallexample
8530 $ cat sample.c
8531 #include <stdio.h>
8532 #include "sample.h"
8533
8534 #define M 42
8535 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8536
8537 main ()
8538 @{
8539 #define N 28
8540 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8541 #undef N
8542 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8543 #define N 1729
8544 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8545 @}
8546 $ cat sample.h
8547 #define Q <
8548 $
8549 @end smallexample
8550
8551 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
8552 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
8553 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
8554 information.
8555
8556 @smallexample
8557 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
8558 $
8559 @end smallexample
8560
8561 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
8562
8563 @smallexample
8564 $ gdb -nw sample
8565 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
8566 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8567 GDB is free software, @dots{}
8568 (@value{GDBP})
8569 @end smallexample
8570
8571 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
8572 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
8573 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
8574
8575 @smallexample
8576 (@value{GDBP}) list main
8577 3
8578 4 #define M 42
8579 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8580 6
8581 7 main ()
8582 8 @{
8583 9 #define N 28
8584 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8585 11 #undef N
8586 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8587 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
8588 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
8589 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8590 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
8591 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
8592 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
8593 #define Q <
8594 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
8595 expands to: (42 + 1)
8596 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
8597 expands to: once (M + 1)
8598 (@value{GDBP})
8599 @end smallexample
8600
8601 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
8602 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
8603 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
8604 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
8605
8606 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
8607 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
8608
8609 @smallexample
8610 (@value{GDBP}) break main
8611 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
8612 (@value{GDBP}) run
8613 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
8614
8615 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
8616 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8617 (@value{GDBP})
8618 @end smallexample
8619
8620 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
8621
8622 @smallexample
8623 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8624 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
8625 #define N 28
8626 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8627 expands to: 28 < 42
8628 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8629 $1 = 1
8630 (@value{GDBP})
8631 @end smallexample
8632
8633 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
8634 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
8635 thereof) in force at each point:
8636
8637 @smallexample
8638 (@value{GDBP}) next
8639 Hello, world!
8640 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8641 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8642 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
8643 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
8644 (@value{GDBP}) next
8645 We're so creative.
8646 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8647 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8648 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
8649 #define N 1729
8650 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8651 expands to: 1729 < 42
8652 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8653 $2 = 0
8654 (@value{GDBP})
8655 @end smallexample
8656
8657 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
8658 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
8659 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
8660 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
8661
8662 @smallexample
8663 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
8664 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
8665 -D__STDC__=1
8666 (@value{GDBP})
8667 @end smallexample
8668
8669
8670 @node Tracepoints
8671 @chapter Tracepoints
8672 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
8673 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
8674
8675 @cindex tracepoints
8676 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
8677 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
8678 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
8679 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
8680 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
8681 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
8682 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
8683
8684 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
8685 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
8686 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
8687 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
8688 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
8689 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
8690 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
8691 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
8692 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
8693 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
8694 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
8695
8696 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
8697 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
8698 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
8699 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
8700 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
8701 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
8702 Packets}.
8703
8704 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
8705
8706 @menu
8707 * Set Tracepoints::
8708 * Analyze Collected Data::
8709 * Tracepoint Variables::
8710 @end menu
8711
8712 @node Set Tracepoints
8713 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
8714
8715 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
8716 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
8717 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
8718 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
8719 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
8720 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
8721 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
8722
8723 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
8724 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
8725 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
8726 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
8727 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
8728 tracepoint was hit.
8729
8730 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Conditional
8731 expressions and ignore counts on tracepoints have no effect, and
8732 tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN} commands when they are
8733 hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific either.
8734
8735 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
8736 conditions and actions.
8737
8738 @menu
8739 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
8740 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
8741 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
8742 * Tracepoint Actions::
8743 * Listing Tracepoints::
8744 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
8745 @end menu
8746
8747 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
8748 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
8749
8750 @table @code
8751 @cindex set tracepoint
8752 @kindex trace
8753 @item trace @var{location}
8754 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
8755 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
8756 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
8757 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
8758 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
8759 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
8760 changing its actions doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
8761 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
8762 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.
8763
8764 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
8765
8766 @smallexample
8767 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
8768
8769 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
8770
8771 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
8772
8773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
8774
8775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
8776 @end smallexample
8777
8778 @noindent
8779 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
8780
8781 @vindex $tpnum
8782 @cindex last tracepoint number
8783 @cindex recent tracepoint number
8784 @cindex tracepoint number
8785 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
8786 of the most recently set tracepoint.
8787
8788 @kindex delete tracepoint
8789 @cindex tracepoint deletion
8790 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8791 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
8792 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
8793 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
8794
8795 Examples:
8796
8797 @smallexample
8798 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
8799
8800 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
8801 @end smallexample
8802
8803 @noindent
8804 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
8805 @end table
8806
8807 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8808 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8809
8810 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
8811
8812 @table @code
8813 @kindex disable tracepoint
8814 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8815 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
8816 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
8817 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
8818 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
8819
8820 @kindex enable tracepoint
8821 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8822 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
8823 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
8824 run.
8825 @end table
8826
8827 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
8828 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
8829
8830 @table @code
8831 @kindex passcount
8832 @cindex tracepoint pass count
8833 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
8834 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
8835 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
8836 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
8837 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
8838 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
8839 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
8840 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
8841 user.
8842
8843 Examples:
8844
8845 @smallexample
8846 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
8847 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
8848
8849 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
8850 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
8851 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8852 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
8853 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
8854 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
8855 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
8856 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
8857 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
8858 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
8859 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
8860 @end smallexample
8861 @end table
8862
8863 @node Tracepoint Actions
8864 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
8865
8866 @table @code
8867 @kindex actions
8868 @cindex tracepoint actions
8869 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8870 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
8871 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
8872 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
8873 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
8874 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
8875 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
8876 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
8877 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
8878 @code{while-stepping}.
8879
8880 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
8881 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
8882 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
8883
8884 @smallexample
8885 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
8886
8887 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
8888
8889 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
8890 @end smallexample
8891
8892 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
8893 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
8894 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
8895 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
8896 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
8897 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
8898 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
8899 @code{end} command.
8900
8901 @smallexample
8902 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8903 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8904 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
8905 > collect bar,baz
8906 > collect $regs
8907 > while-stepping 12
8908 > collect $fp, $sp
8909 > end
8910 end
8911 @end smallexample
8912
8913 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
8914 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
8915 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
8916 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8917 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8918 special arguments are supported:
8919
8920 @table @code
8921 @item $regs
8922 collect all registers
8923
8924 @item $args
8925 collect all function arguments
8926
8927 @item $locals
8928 collect all local variables.
8929 @end table
8930
8931 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8932 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8933 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8934
8935 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8936 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8937
8938 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8939 @item while-stepping @var{n}
8940 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8941 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8942 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8943 its own @code{end} command):
8944
8945 @smallexample
8946 > while-stepping 12
8947 > collect $regs, myglobal
8948 > end
8949 >
8950 @end smallexample
8951
8952 @noindent
8953 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8954 @code{stepping}.
8955 @end table
8956
8957 @node Listing Tracepoints
8958 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
8959
8960 @table @code
8961 @kindex info tracepoints
8962 @kindex info tp
8963 @cindex information about tracepoints
8964 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8965 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
8966 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
8967 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
8968 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
8969 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
8970
8971 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
8972 tracing:
8973
8974 @itemize @bullet
8975 @item
8976 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8977 @item
8978 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8979 @item
8980 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command. The actions
8981 are prefixed with an @samp{A} so as to distinguish them from commands.
8982 @end itemize
8983
8984 @smallexample
8985 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8986 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
8987 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
8988 pass count 1200
8989 step count 20
8990 A while-stepping 20
8991 A collect globfoo, $regs
8992 A end
8993 A collect globfoo2
8994 A end
8995 (@value{GDBP})
8996 @end smallexample
8997
8998 @noindent
8999 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
9000 @end table
9001
9002 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
9003 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
9004
9005 @table @code
9006 @kindex tstart
9007 @cindex start a new trace experiment
9008 @cindex collected data discarded
9009 @item tstart
9010 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
9011 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
9012 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
9013 experiment.
9014
9015 @kindex tstop
9016 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
9017 @item tstop
9018 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
9019 stops collecting data.
9020
9021 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
9022 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
9023 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
9024
9025 @kindex tstatus
9026 @cindex status of trace data collection
9027 @cindex trace experiment, status of
9028 @item tstatus
9029 This command displays the status of the current trace data
9030 collection.
9031 @end table
9032
9033 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
9034
9035 @smallexample
9036 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
9037 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9038 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
9039 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
9040 > while-stepping 11
9041 > collect $regs
9042 > end
9043 > end
9044 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
9045 [time passes @dots{}]
9046 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
9047 @end smallexample
9048
9049
9050 @node Analyze Collected Data
9051 @section Using the Collected Data
9052
9053 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
9054 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
9055 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
9056 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
9057 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
9058 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
9059 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
9060 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
9061 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
9062 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
9063 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
9064 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
9065 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
9066 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
9067 the buffer will fail.
9068
9069 @menu
9070 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
9071 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
9072 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
9073 @end menu
9074
9075 @node tfind
9076 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
9077
9078 @kindex tfind
9079 @cindex select trace snapshot
9080 @cindex find trace snapshot
9081 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
9082 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
9083 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
9084 snapshot is selected.
9085
9086 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
9087
9088 @table @code
9089 @item tfind start
9090 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
9091 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
9092
9093 @item tfind none
9094 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
9095
9096 @item tfind end
9097 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
9098
9099 @item tfind
9100 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
9101
9102 @item tfind -
9103 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
9104 retracing earlier steps.
9105
9106 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
9107 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
9108 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
9109 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
9110 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
9111
9112 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
9113 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
9114 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
9115 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
9116 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
9117
9118 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
9119 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
9120 addresses.
9121
9122 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
9123 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
9124 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
9125
9126 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
9127 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
9128 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
9129 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
9130 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
9131 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
9132 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
9133 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
9134 @end table
9135
9136 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
9137 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
9138 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
9139 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
9140 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
9141 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
9142 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
9143 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
9144 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
9145 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
9146 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
9147 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
9148 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
9149 tracepoint as the current one.
9150
9151 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
9152 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
9153 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
9154 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
9155 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
9156
9157 @smallexample
9158 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9159 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
9160 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
9161 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
9162 > tfind
9163 > end
9164
9165 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
9166 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
9167 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
9168 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
9169 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
9170 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
9171 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
9172 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
9173 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
9174 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
9175 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
9176 @end smallexample
9177
9178 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
9179 the buffer:
9180
9181 @smallexample
9182 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9183 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
9184 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
9185 > tfind line
9186 > end
9187
9188 Frame 0, X = 1
9189 Frame 7, X = 2
9190 Frame 13, X = 255
9191 @end smallexample
9192
9193 @node tdump
9194 @subsection @code{tdump}
9195 @kindex tdump
9196 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
9197 @cindex tracepoint data, display
9198
9199 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
9200 the current trace snapshot.
9201
9202 @smallexample
9203 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
9204 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9205 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
9206 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
9207 > end
9208
9209 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
9210
9211 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
9212 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
9213 at gdb_test.c:444
9214 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
9215
9216 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
9217 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
9218 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
9219 d1 0x18 24
9220 d2 0x80 128
9221 d3 0x33 51
9222 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
9223 d5 0x22 34
9224 d6 0xe0 224
9225 d7 0x380035 3670069
9226 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
9227 a1 0x3000668 50333288
9228 a2 0x100 256
9229 a3 0x322000 3284992
9230 a4 0x3000698 50333336
9231 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
9232 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
9233 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
9234 ps 0x0 0
9235 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
9236 fpcontrol 0x0 0
9237 fpstatus 0x0 0
9238 fpiaddr 0x0 0
9239 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
9240 p1 = (void *) 0x11
9241 p2 = (void *) 0x22
9242 p3 = (void *) 0x33
9243 p4 = (void *) 0x44
9244 p5 = (void *) 0x55
9245 p6 = (void *) 0x66
9246 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
9247
9248 (@value{GDBP})
9249 @end smallexample
9250
9251 @node save-tracepoints
9252 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
9253 @kindex save-tracepoints
9254 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
9255
9256 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
9257 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
9258 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
9259 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
9260 Files}).
9261
9262 @node Tracepoint Variables
9263 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
9264 @cindex tracepoint variables
9265 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
9266
9267 @table @code
9268 @vindex $trace_frame
9269 @item (int) $trace_frame
9270 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
9271 snapshot is selected.
9272
9273 @vindex $tracepoint
9274 @item (int) $tracepoint
9275 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
9276
9277 @vindex $trace_line
9278 @item (int) $trace_line
9279 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
9280
9281 @vindex $trace_file
9282 @item (char []) $trace_file
9283 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
9284
9285 @vindex $trace_func
9286 @item (char []) $trace_func
9287 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
9288 @end table
9289
9290 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
9291 use @code{output} instead.
9292
9293 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
9294 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
9295 data.
9296
9297 @smallexample
9298 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9299
9300 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
9301 > output $trace_file
9302 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
9303 > tfind
9304 > end
9305 @end smallexample
9306
9307 @node Overlays
9308 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
9309 @cindex overlays
9310
9311 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
9312 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
9313 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
9314 use overlays.
9315
9316 @menu
9317 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
9318 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
9319 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
9320 mapped by asking the inferior.
9321 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
9322 @end menu
9323
9324 @node How Overlays Work
9325 @section How Overlays Work
9326 @cindex mapped overlays
9327 @cindex unmapped overlays
9328 @cindex load address, overlay's
9329 @cindex mapped address
9330 @cindex overlay area
9331
9332 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
9333 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
9334 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
9335 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
9336 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
9337
9338 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
9339 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
9340 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
9341 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
9342 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
9343 largest overlay as well.
9344
9345 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
9346 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
9347 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
9348 there.
9349
9350 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
9351 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
9352 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
9353
9354 @smallexample
9355 @group
9356 Data Instruction Larger
9357 Address Space Address Space Address Space
9358 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
9359 | | | | | |
9360 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
9361 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
9362 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
9363 | and heap | | | | | |
9364 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
9365 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
9366 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
9367 | | | | | |
9368 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
9369 address | | | | | |
9370 | overlay | <-' | | |
9371 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
9372 | | <---. | | load address
9373 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
9374 | | | |
9375 +-----------+ | |
9376 +-----------+
9377 | |
9378 +-----------+
9379
9380 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
9381 @end group
9382 @end smallexample
9383
9384 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
9385 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
9386 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
9387 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
9388 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
9389 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
9390 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
9391 program and the overlay area.
9392
9393 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
9394 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
9395 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
9396 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
9397 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
9398 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
9399 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
9400
9401 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
9402 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
9403 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
9404
9405 @itemize @bullet
9406
9407 @item
9408 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
9409 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
9410 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
9411 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
9412
9413 @item
9414 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
9415 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
9416 your program's performance.
9417
9418 @item
9419 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
9420 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
9421 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
9422 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
9423 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
9424 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
9425 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
9426
9427 @item
9428 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
9429 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
9430 instruction and data spaces.
9431
9432 @end itemize
9433
9434 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
9435 improved in many ways:
9436
9437 @itemize @bullet
9438
9439 @item
9440 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
9441 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
9442 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
9443 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
9444 area in the usual way.
9445
9446 @item
9447 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
9448 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
9449
9450 @item
9451 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
9452 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
9453 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
9454 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
9455 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
9456 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
9457 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
9458
9459 @end itemize
9460
9461
9462 @node Overlay Commands
9463 @section Overlay Commands
9464
9465 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
9466 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
9467 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
9468 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
9469 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
9470 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
9471
9472 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
9473 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
9474
9475 @table @code
9476 @item overlay off
9477 @kindex overlay
9478 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
9479 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
9480 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
9481 overlay support is disabled.
9482
9483 @item overlay manual
9484 @cindex manual overlay debugging
9485 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9486 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
9487 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
9488 commands described below.
9489
9490 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
9491 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
9492 @cindex map an overlay
9493 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
9494 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
9495 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
9496 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
9497 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
9498 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
9499
9500 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
9501 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
9502 @cindex unmap an overlay
9503 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
9504 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
9505 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
9506 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
9507
9508 @item overlay auto
9509 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9510 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
9511 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
9512 Overlay Debugging}.
9513
9514 @item overlay load-target
9515 @itemx overlay load
9516 @cindex reloading the overlay table
9517 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
9518 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
9519 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
9520 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
9521 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
9522
9523 @item overlay list-overlays
9524 @itemx overlay list
9525 @cindex listing mapped overlays
9526 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
9527 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
9528
9529 @end table
9530
9531 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
9532 of the function the address falls in:
9533
9534 @smallexample
9535 (@value{GDBP}) print main
9536 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
9537 @end smallexample
9538 @noindent
9539 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
9540 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
9541 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
9542 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
9543
9544 @smallexample
9545 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9546 No sections are mapped.
9547 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9548 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
9549 @end smallexample
9550 @noindent
9551 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
9552 name normally:
9553
9554 @smallexample
9555 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9556 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
9557 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
9558 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9559 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
9560 @end smallexample
9561
9562 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
9563 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
9564 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
9565 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
9566 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
9567
9568 @itemize @bullet
9569 @item
9570 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
9571 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
9572 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
9573 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
9574 @item
9575 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
9576 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
9577 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
9578 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
9579 breakpoints properly.
9580 @end itemize
9581
9582
9583 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
9584 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
9585 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
9586
9587 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
9588 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
9589 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
9590 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
9591 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
9592 current state of the overlays.
9593
9594 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
9595 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
9596
9597 @table @asis
9598
9599 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
9600 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
9601
9602 @smallexample
9603 struct
9604 @{
9605 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
9606 unsigned long vma;
9607
9608 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
9609 unsigned long size;
9610
9611 /* The overlay's load address. */
9612 unsigned long lma;
9613
9614 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
9615 zero otherwise. */
9616 unsigned long mapped;
9617 @}
9618 @end smallexample
9619
9620 @item @code{_novlys}:
9621 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
9622 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
9623
9624 @end table
9625
9626 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
9627 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
9628 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
9629 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
9630 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
9631 currently mapped.
9632
9633 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
9634 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
9635 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
9636 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
9637 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
9638 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
9639 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
9640 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
9641 are not being executed.
9642
9643 @node Overlay Sample Program
9644 @section Overlay Sample Program
9645 @cindex overlay example program
9646
9647 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
9648 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
9649 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
9650 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
9651 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
9652 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
9653 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
9654
9655 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
9656 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
9657 suite. The program consists of the following files from
9658 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
9659
9660 @table @file
9661 @item overlays.c
9662 The main program file.
9663 @item ovlymgr.c
9664 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
9665 @item foo.c
9666 @itemx bar.c
9667 @itemx baz.c
9668 @itemx grbx.c
9669 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
9670 @item d10v.ld
9671 @itemx m32r.ld
9672 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
9673 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
9674 @end table
9675
9676 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
9677 cross-compiler like this:
9678
9679 @smallexample
9680 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
9681 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
9682 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
9683 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
9684 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
9685 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
9686 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
9687 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
9688 @end smallexample
9689
9690 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
9691 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
9692 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
9693
9694
9695 @node Languages
9696 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
9697 @cindex languages
9698
9699 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
9700 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
9701 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
9702 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
9703 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
9704 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
9705
9706 @cindex working language
9707 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
9708 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
9709 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
9710 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
9711 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
9712 language}.
9713
9714 @menu
9715 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
9716 * Show:: Displaying the language
9717 * Checks:: Type and range checks
9718 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
9719 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
9720 @end menu
9721
9722 @node Setting
9723 @section Switching Between Source Languages
9724
9725 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
9726 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
9727 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
9728 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
9729 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
9730 are printed, etc.
9731
9732 In addition to the working language, every source file that
9733 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
9734 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
9735 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
9736 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
9737 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
9738 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
9739 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
9740 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
9741 Displaying the Language}.
9742
9743 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
9744 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
9745 another language. In that case, make the
9746 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
9747 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
9748 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
9749
9750 @menu
9751 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
9752 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
9753 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
9754 @end menu
9755
9756 @node Filenames
9757 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
9758
9759 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
9760 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
9761
9762 @table @file
9763 @item .ada
9764 @itemx .ads
9765 @itemx .adb
9766 @itemx .a
9767 Ada source file.
9768
9769 @item .c
9770 C source file
9771
9772 @item .C
9773 @itemx .cc
9774 @itemx .cp
9775 @itemx .cpp
9776 @itemx .cxx
9777 @itemx .c++
9778 C@t{++} source file
9779
9780 @item .m
9781 Objective-C source file
9782
9783 @item .f
9784 @itemx .F
9785 Fortran source file
9786
9787 @item .mod
9788 Modula-2 source file
9789
9790 @item .s
9791 @itemx .S
9792 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
9793 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
9794 @end table
9795
9796 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
9797 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
9798
9799 @node Manually
9800 @subsection Setting the Working Language
9801
9802 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
9803 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
9804 your program.
9805
9806 @kindex set language
9807 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
9808 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
9809 a language, such as
9810 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
9811 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
9812
9813 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
9814 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
9815 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
9816 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
9817 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
9818 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
9819 command such as:
9820
9821 @smallexample
9822 print a = b + c
9823 @end smallexample
9824
9825 @noindent
9826 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
9827 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
9828 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
9829 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
9830
9831 @node Automatically
9832 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
9833
9834 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
9835 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
9836 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
9837 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
9838 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
9839 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
9840 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
9841 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
9842 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
9843
9844 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
9845 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
9846 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
9847 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
9848 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
9849
9850 @node Show
9851 @section Displaying the Language
9852
9853 The following commands help you find out which language is the
9854 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
9855
9856 @table @code
9857 @item show language
9858 @kindex show language
9859 Display the current working language. This is the
9860 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
9861 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
9862
9863 @item info frame
9864 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
9865 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
9866 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
9867 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
9868 information listed here.
9869
9870 @item info source
9871 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
9872 Display the source language of this source file.
9873 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
9874 information listed here.
9875 @end table
9876
9877 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
9878 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
9879 with a language explicitly:
9880
9881 @table @code
9882 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
9883 @kindex set extension-language
9884 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
9885 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
9886
9887 @item info extensions
9888 @kindex info extensions
9889 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
9890 @end table
9891
9892 @node Checks
9893 @section Type and Range Checking
9894
9895 @quotation
9896 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
9897 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
9898 section documents the intended facilities.
9899 @end quotation
9900 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
9901
9902 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
9903 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
9904 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
9905 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
9906 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
9907 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
9908 errors when your program is running.
9909
9910 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
9911 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
9912 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
9913 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
9914 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
9915 automatically based on your program's source language.
9916 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
9917 settings of supported languages.
9918
9919 @menu
9920 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9921 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9922 @end menu
9923
9924 @cindex type checking
9925 @cindex checks, type
9926 @node Type Checking
9927 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9928
9929 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9930 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9931 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9932 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9933
9934 @smallexample
9935 1 + 2 @result{} 3
9936 @exdent but
9937 @error{} 1 + 2.3
9938 @end smallexample
9939
9940 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9941 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9942
9943 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9944 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9945 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9946 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9947 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9948 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9949 also issues a warning.
9950
9951 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9952 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9953 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9954 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9955 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9956 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9957
9958 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9959 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9960 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9961 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9962 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9963 details on specific languages.
9964
9965 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9966
9967 @kindex set check type
9968 @kindex show check type
9969 @table @code
9970 @item set check type auto
9971 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9972 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9973 each language.
9974
9975 @item set check type on
9976 @itemx set check type off
9977 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9978 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9979 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9980 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9981 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9982
9983 @item set check type warn
9984 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9985 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9986 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9987 numbers and structures.
9988
9989 @item show type
9990 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9991 is setting it automatically.
9992 @end table
9993
9994 @cindex range checking
9995 @cindex checks, range
9996 @node Range Checking
9997 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9998
9999 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
10000 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
10001 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
10002 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
10003 not exceed the bounds of the array.
10004
10005 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
10006 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
10007 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
10008 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
10009
10010 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
10011 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
10012 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
10013 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
10014 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
10015 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
10016
10017 @smallexample
10018 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
10019 @end smallexample
10020
10021 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
10022 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
10023 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
10024
10025 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
10026
10027 @kindex set check range
10028 @kindex show check range
10029 @table @code
10030 @item set check range auto
10031 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
10032 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
10033 each language.
10034
10035 @item set check range on
10036 @itemx set check range off
10037 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
10038 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
10039 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
10040 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
10041
10042 @item set check range warn
10043 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
10044 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
10045 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
10046 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
10047 systems).
10048
10049 @item show range
10050 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
10051 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
10052 @end table
10053
10054 @node Supported Languages
10055 @section Supported Languages
10056
10057 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
10058 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
10059 @c This is false ...
10060 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
10061 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
10062 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
10063 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
10064 language.
10065
10066 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
10067 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
10068 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
10069 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
10070 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
10071 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
10072 language reference or tutorial.
10073
10074 @menu
10075 * C:: C and C@t{++}
10076 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
10077 * Fortran:: Fortran
10078 * Pascal:: Pascal
10079 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
10080 * Ada:: Ada
10081 @end menu
10082
10083 @node C
10084 @subsection C and C@t{++}
10085
10086 @cindex C and C@t{++}
10087 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
10088
10089 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
10090 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
10091 together.
10092
10093 @cindex C@t{++}
10094 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
10095 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
10096 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
10097 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
10098 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
10099 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
10100 compiler (@code{aCC}).
10101
10102 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
10103 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
10104 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
10105 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
10106 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
10107 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
10108
10109 @menu
10110 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
10111 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
10112 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
10113 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
10114 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
10115 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
10116 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
10117 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
10118 @end menu
10119
10120 @node C Operators
10121 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
10122
10123 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
10124
10125 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10126 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10127 often defined on groups of types.
10128
10129 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
10130
10131 @itemize @bullet
10132
10133 @item
10134 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
10135 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
10136
10137 @item
10138 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
10139 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
10140
10141 @item
10142 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
10143
10144 @item
10145 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
10146
10147 @end itemize
10148
10149 @noindent
10150 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
10151 in order of increasing precedence:
10152
10153 @table @code
10154 @item ,
10155 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
10156 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
10157 expression being the last expression evaluated.
10158
10159 @item =
10160 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
10161 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
10162
10163 @item @var{op}=
10164 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
10165 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
10166 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
10167 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
10168 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
10169
10170 @item ?:
10171 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
10172 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
10173 integral type.
10174
10175 @item ||
10176 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10177
10178 @item &&
10179 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
10180
10181 @item |
10182 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10183
10184 @item ^
10185 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10186
10187 @item &
10188 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
10189
10190 @item ==@r{, }!=
10191 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
10192 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
10193
10194 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
10195 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
10196 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
10197 and non-zero for true.
10198
10199 @item <<@r{, }>>
10200 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
10201
10202 @item @@
10203 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10204
10205 @item +@r{, }-
10206 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
10207 pointer types.
10208
10209 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
10210 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
10211 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
10212 integral types.
10213
10214 @item ++@r{, }--
10215 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
10216 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
10217 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
10218 operation takes place.
10219
10220 @item *
10221 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
10222 @code{++}.
10223
10224 @item &
10225 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
10226
10227 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
10228 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
10229 to examine the address
10230 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
10231 stored.
10232
10233 @item -
10234 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
10235 precedence as @code{++}.
10236
10237 @item !
10238 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
10239 @code{++}.
10240
10241 @item ~
10242 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
10243 @code{++}.
10244
10245
10246 @item .@r{, }->
10247 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
10248 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
10249 pointer based on the stored type information.
10250 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
10251
10252 @item .*@r{, }->*
10253 Dereferences of pointers to members.
10254
10255 @item []
10256 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
10257 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10258
10259 @item ()
10260 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10261
10262 @item ::
10263 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
10264 and @code{class} types.
10265
10266 @item ::
10267 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
10268 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
10269 above.
10270 @end table
10271
10272 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
10273 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
10274 predefined meaning.
10275
10276 @node C Constants
10277 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
10278
10279 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
10280
10281 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
10282 following ways:
10283
10284 @itemize @bullet
10285 @item
10286 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
10287 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
10288 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
10289 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
10290 @code{long} value.
10291
10292 @item
10293 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
10294 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
10295 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
10296 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
10297 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
10298 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
10299 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
10300 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
10301 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
10302 constant.
10303
10304 @item
10305 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
10306 integral equivalents.
10307
10308 @item
10309 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
10310 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
10311 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
10312 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
10313 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
10314 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
10315 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
10316 @samp{\n} for newline.
10317
10318 @item
10319 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
10320 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
10321 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
10322 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
10323 characters.
10324
10325 @item
10326 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
10327 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
10328
10329 @item
10330 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
10331 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
10332 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
10333 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
10334 @end itemize
10335
10336 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
10337 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
10338
10339 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
10340 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
10341
10342 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
10343 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
10344 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
10345 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
10346 @quotation
10347 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
10348 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
10349 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
10350 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
10351 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
10352 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
10353 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
10354 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
10355 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
10356 C@t{++} code.
10357 @end quotation
10358
10359 @enumerate
10360
10361 @cindex member functions
10362 @item
10363 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
10364
10365 @smallexample
10366 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
10367 @end smallexample
10368
10369 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
10370 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
10371 @item
10372 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
10373 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
10374 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
10375 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
10376
10377 @cindex call overloaded functions
10378 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
10379 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
10380 @item
10381 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
10382 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
10383 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
10384 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
10385 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
10386 default arguments.
10387
10388 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
10389 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
10390 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
10391 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
10392 number of function arguments.
10393
10394 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
10395 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
10396 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
10397
10398 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
10399 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
10400 @smallexample
10401 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
10402 @end smallexample
10403
10404 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
10405 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
10406
10407 @cindex reference declarations
10408 @item
10409 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
10410 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
10411 dereferenced.
10412
10413 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
10414 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
10415 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
10416 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
10417 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
10418
10419 @item
10420 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
10421 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
10422 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
10423 necessary, for example in an expression like
10424 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
10425 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
10426 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
10427 @end enumerate
10428
10429 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
10430 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
10431 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
10432 invoking user-defined operators.
10433
10434 @node C Defaults
10435 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
10436
10437 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
10438
10439 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
10440 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
10441 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10442 selects the working language.
10443
10444 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
10445 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
10446 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
10447 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
10448 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
10449 for further details.
10450
10451 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
10452 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
10453 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
10454
10455 @node C Checks
10456 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
10457
10458 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
10459
10460 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
10461 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
10462 considers two variables type equivalent if:
10463
10464 @itemize @bullet
10465 @item
10466 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
10467 enumerated tag.
10468
10469 @item
10470 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
10471 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
10472
10473 @ignore
10474 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
10475 @c FIXME--beers?
10476 @item
10477 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
10478 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
10479 compilers.)
10480 @end ignore
10481 @end itemize
10482
10483 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
10484 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
10485 that is not itself an array.
10486
10487 @node Debugging C
10488 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
10489
10490 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
10491 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
10492 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
10493 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
10494
10495 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
10496 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
10497 ,Expressions}.
10498
10499 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
10500 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
10501
10502 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
10503
10504 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
10505 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
10506
10507 @table @code
10508 @cindex break in overloaded functions
10509 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
10510 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
10511 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
10512 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
10513 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
10514
10515 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
10516 @item rbreak @var{regex}
10517 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
10518 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
10519 classes.
10520 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
10521
10522 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
10523 @item catch throw
10524 @itemx catch catch
10525 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
10526 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
10527
10528 @cindex inheritance
10529 @item ptype @var{typename}
10530 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
10531 @var{typename}.
10532 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
10533
10534 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
10535 @item set print demangle
10536 @itemx show print demangle
10537 @itemx set print asm-demangle
10538 @itemx show print asm-demangle
10539 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
10540 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
10541 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10542
10543 @item set print object
10544 @itemx show print object
10545 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
10546 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10547
10548 @item set print vtbl
10549 @itemx show print vtbl
10550 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
10551 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10552 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10553 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10554
10555 @kindex set overload-resolution
10556 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
10557 @item set overload-resolution on
10558 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
10559 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
10560 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
10561 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
10562 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
10563 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
10564
10565 @item set overload-resolution off
10566 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
10567 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10568 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
10569 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
10570 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10571 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
10572 argument types.
10573
10574 @kindex show overload-resolution
10575 @item show overload-resolution
10576 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
10577
10578 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
10579 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
10580 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
10581 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
10582 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
10583 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
10584 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
10585 @end table
10586
10587 @node Decimal Floating Point
10588 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
10589 @cindex decimal floating point format
10590
10591 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
10592 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
10593 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
10594 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
10595
10596 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
10597 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
10598 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
10599 target.
10600
10601 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
10602 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
10603 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
10604
10605 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
10606 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
10607 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
10608
10609 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
10610 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
10611 @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
10612
10613 @node Objective-C
10614 @subsection Objective-C
10615
10616 @cindex Objective-C
10617 This section provides information about some commands and command
10618 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
10619 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
10620 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
10621
10622 @menu
10623 * Method Names in Commands::
10624 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
10625 @end menu
10626
10627 @node Method Names in Commands
10628 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
10629
10630 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
10631 names as line specifications:
10632
10633 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
10634 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
10635 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
10636 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
10637 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
10638 @itemize
10639 @item @code{clear}
10640 @item @code{break}
10641 @item @code{info line}
10642 @item @code{jump}
10643 @item @code{list}
10644 @end itemize
10645
10646 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
10647
10648 @smallexample
10649 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
10650 @end smallexample
10651
10652 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
10653 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
10654 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
10655 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
10656 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
10657 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
10658 debugged, enter:
10659
10660 @smallexample
10661 break -[Fruit create]
10662 @end smallexample
10663
10664 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
10665 enter:
10666
10667 @smallexample
10668 list +[NSText initialize]
10669 @end smallexample
10670
10671 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
10672 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
10673 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
10674 is also possible to specify just a method name:
10675
10676 @smallexample
10677 break create
10678 @end smallexample
10679
10680 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
10681 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
10682 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
10683 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
10684 none apply.
10685
10686 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
10687 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
10688
10689 @smallexample
10690 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
10691 @end smallexample
10692
10693 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
10694 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
10695 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
10696 @kindex print-object
10697 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
10698
10699 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
10700
10701 @smallexample
10702 print -[@var{object} hash]
10703 @end smallexample
10704
10705 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
10706 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
10707 @noindent
10708 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
10709 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
10710 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
10711 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
10712 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
10713 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
10714
10715 @node Fortran
10716 @subsection Fortran
10717 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
10718
10719 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
10720 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
10721
10722 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
10723 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
10724 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
10725 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
10726 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
10727 underscore.
10728
10729 @menu
10730 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
10731 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
10732 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
10733 @end menu
10734
10735 @node Fortran Operators
10736 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
10737
10738 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
10739
10740 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10741 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
10742 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
10743
10744 @table @code
10745 @item **
10746 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
10747 of the second one.
10748
10749 @item :
10750 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
10751 represent a section of array.
10752
10753 @item %
10754 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
10755 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
10756 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
10757 union type.
10758 @end table
10759
10760 @node Fortran Defaults
10761 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
10762
10763 @cindex Fortran Defaults
10764
10765 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
10766 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
10767 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
10768 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
10769
10770 @node Special Fortran Commands
10771 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
10772
10773 @cindex Special Fortran commands
10774
10775 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
10776 such as displaying common blocks.
10777
10778 @table @code
10779 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
10780 @kindex info common
10781 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
10782 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
10783 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
10784 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
10785 printed.
10786 @end table
10787
10788 @node Pascal
10789 @subsection Pascal
10790
10791 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
10792 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
10793 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
10794 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
10795 syntax.
10796
10797 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
10798 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
10799 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
10800
10801 @node Modula-2
10802 @subsection Modula-2
10803
10804 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
10805
10806 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
10807 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
10808 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
10809 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10810 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
10811 table.
10812
10813 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
10814 @menu
10815 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
10816 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
10817 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
10818 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
10819 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
10820 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
10821 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
10822 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10823 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10824 @end menu
10825
10826 @node M2 Operators
10827 @subsubsection Operators
10828 @cindex Modula-2 operators
10829
10830 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10831 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10832 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
10833 following definitions hold:
10834
10835 @itemize @bullet
10836
10837 @item
10838 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
10839 their subranges.
10840
10841 @item
10842 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
10843
10844 @item
10845 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
10846
10847 @item
10848 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
10849 @var{type}}.
10850
10851 @item
10852 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
10853
10854 @item
10855 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
10856
10857 @item
10858 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
10859 @end itemize
10860
10861 @noindent
10862 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
10863 increasing precedence:
10864
10865 @table @code
10866 @item ,
10867 Function argument or array index separator.
10868
10869 @item :=
10870 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
10871 @var{value}.
10872
10873 @item <@r{, }>
10874 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
10875 types.
10876
10877 @item <=@r{, }>=
10878 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
10879 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
10880 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
10881
10882 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
10883 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
10884 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
10885 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
10886 comment character.
10887
10888 @item IN
10889 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
10890 Same precedence as @code{<}.
10891
10892 @item OR
10893 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10894
10895 @item AND@r{, }&
10896 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10897
10898 @item @@
10899 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10900
10901 @item +@r{, }-
10902 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
10903 and difference on set types.
10904
10905 @item *
10906 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
10907 on set types.
10908
10909 @item /
10910 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
10911 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
10912
10913 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
10914 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
10915 precedence as @code{*}.
10916
10917 @item -
10918 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
10919
10920 @item ^
10921 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
10922
10923 @item NOT
10924 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
10925 @code{^}.
10926
10927 @item .
10928 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10929 precedence as @code{^}.
10930
10931 @item []
10932 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
10933
10934 @item ()
10935 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
10936 as @code{^}.
10937
10938 @item ::@r{, }.
10939 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10940 @end table
10941
10942 @quotation
10943 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10944 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10945 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10946 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10947 @end quotation
10948
10949
10950 @node Built-In Func/Proc
10951 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10952 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10953
10954 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10955 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10956
10957 @table @var
10958
10959 @item a
10960 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10961
10962 @item c
10963 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10964
10965 @item i
10966 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10967
10968 @item m
10969 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10970 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10971 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10972
10973 @item n
10974 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10975
10976 @item r
10977 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10978
10979 @item t
10980 represents a type.
10981
10982 @item v
10983 represents a variable.
10984
10985 @item x
10986 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10987 explanation of the function for details.
10988 @end table
10989
10990 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10991
10992 @table @code
10993 @item ABS(@var{n})
10994 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10995
10996 @item CAP(@var{c})
10997 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10998 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10999
11000 @item CHR(@var{i})
11001 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
11002
11003 @item DEC(@var{v})
11004 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
11005
11006 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
11007 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
11008 new value.
11009
11010 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
11011 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
11012 set.
11013
11014 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
11015 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
11016
11017 @item HIGH(@var{a})
11018 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
11019
11020 @item INC(@var{v})
11021 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
11022
11023 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
11024 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
11025 new value.
11026
11027 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
11028 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
11029 there. Returns the new set.
11030
11031 @item MAX(@var{t})
11032 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
11033
11034 @item MIN(@var{t})
11035 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
11036
11037 @item ODD(@var{i})
11038 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
11039
11040 @item ORD(@var{x})
11041 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
11042 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
11043 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
11044 integral, character and enumerated types.
11045
11046 @item SIZE(@var{x})
11047 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
11048
11049 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
11050 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
11051
11052 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
11053 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
11054
11055 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
11056 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
11057 @end table
11058
11059 @quotation
11060 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
11061 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
11062 an error.
11063 @end quotation
11064
11065 @cindex Modula-2 constants
11066 @node M2 Constants
11067 @subsubsection Constants
11068
11069 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
11070 ways:
11071
11072 @itemize @bullet
11073
11074 @item
11075 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
11076 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
11077 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
11078 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
11079
11080 @item
11081 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
11082 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
11083 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
11084 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
11085 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
11086 digits.
11087
11088 @item
11089 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
11090 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
11091 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
11092 followed by a @samp{C}.
11093
11094 @item
11095 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
11096 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
11097 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
11098 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
11099 sequences.
11100
11101 @item
11102 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
11103
11104 @item
11105 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
11106 @code{FALSE}.
11107
11108 @item
11109 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
11110
11111 @item
11112 Set constants are not yet supported.
11113 @end itemize
11114
11115 @node M2 Types
11116 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
11117 @cindex Modula-2 types
11118
11119 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
11120 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
11121 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
11122 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
11123 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
11124 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
11125
11126 The first example contains the following section of code:
11127
11128 @smallexample
11129 VAR
11130 s: SET OF CHAR ;
11131 r: [20..40] ;
11132 @end smallexample
11133
11134 @noindent
11135 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
11136 @code{r} and @code{s}.
11137
11138 @smallexample
11139 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11140 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
11141 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11142 SET OF CHAR
11143 (@value{GDBP}) print r
11144 21
11145 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
11146 [20..40]
11147 @end smallexample
11148
11149 @noindent
11150 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
11151
11152 @smallexample
11153 VAR
11154 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
11155 @end smallexample
11156
11157 @noindent
11158 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
11159
11160 @smallexample
11161 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11162 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
11163 @end smallexample
11164
11165 @noindent
11166 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
11167 expressions using the debugger.
11168
11169 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
11170 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
11171
11172 @smallexample
11173 VAR
11174 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
11175 @end smallexample
11176
11177 @smallexample
11178 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11179 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
11180 @end smallexample
11181
11182 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
11183 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
11184 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
11185 above.
11186
11187 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
11188
11189 @smallexample
11190 TYPE
11191 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
11192 t = [blue..yellow] ;
11193 VAR
11194 s: t ;
11195 BEGIN
11196 s := blue ;
11197 @end smallexample
11198
11199 @noindent
11200 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
11201 and value of a variable.
11202
11203 @smallexample
11204 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11205 $1 = blue
11206 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
11207 type = [blue..yellow]
11208 @end smallexample
11209
11210 @noindent
11211 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
11212 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
11213 their @code{C} counterparts.
11214
11215 @smallexample
11216 VAR
11217 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
11218 BEGIN
11219 s[1] := 1 ;
11220 @end smallexample
11221
11222 @smallexample
11223 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11224 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
11225 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11226 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
11227 @end smallexample
11228
11229 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
11230 pointer types as shown in this example:
11231
11232 @smallexample
11233 VAR
11234 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
11235 BEGIN
11236 NEW(s) ;
11237 s^[1] := 1 ;
11238 @end smallexample
11239
11240 @noindent
11241 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
11242
11243 @smallexample
11244 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11245 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
11246 @end smallexample
11247
11248 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
11249 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
11250 types:
11251
11252 @smallexample
11253 TYPE
11254 foo = RECORD
11255 f1: CARDINAL ;
11256 f2: CHAR ;
11257 f3: myarray ;
11258 END ;
11259
11260 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
11261 myrange = [-2..2] ;
11262 VAR
11263 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
11264 @end smallexample
11265
11266 @noindent
11267 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
11268 below.
11269
11270 @smallexample
11271 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11272 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
11273 f1 : CARDINAL;
11274 f2 : CHAR;
11275 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
11276 END
11277 @end smallexample
11278
11279 @node M2 Defaults
11280 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
11281 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
11282
11283 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
11284 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
11285 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
11286 selected the working language.
11287
11288 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
11289 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
11290 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
11291 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
11292
11293 @node Deviations
11294 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
11295 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
11296
11297 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
11298 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
11299
11300 @itemize @bullet
11301 @item
11302 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
11303 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
11304 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
11305 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
11306 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
11307 returned a pointer.)
11308
11309 @item
11310 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
11311 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
11312 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
11313 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
11314
11315 @item
11316 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
11317 argument.
11318
11319 @item
11320 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
11321 @end itemize
11322
11323 @node M2 Checks
11324 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
11325 @cindex Modula-2 checks
11326
11327 @quotation
11328 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
11329 range checking.
11330 @end quotation
11331 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
11332
11333 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
11334
11335 @itemize @bullet
11336 @item
11337 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
11338 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
11339
11340 @item
11341 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
11342 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
11343 @end itemize
11344
11345 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
11346 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
11347
11348 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
11349 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
11350
11351 @node M2 Scope
11352 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
11353 @cindex scope
11354 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
11355 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
11356 @ifinfo
11357 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
11358 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
11359 @end ifinfo
11360 @ifnotinfo
11361 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
11362 @end ifnotinfo
11363
11364 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
11365 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
11366 similar syntax:
11367
11368 @smallexample
11369
11370 @var{module} . @var{id}
11371 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
11372 @end smallexample
11373
11374 @noindent
11375 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
11376 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
11377 identifier within your program, except another module.
11378
11379 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
11380 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
11381 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
11382 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
11383
11384 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
11385 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
11386 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
11387 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
11388 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
11389 @var{module}.
11390
11391 @node GDB/M2
11392 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
11393
11394 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
11395 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
11396 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
11397 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
11398 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
11399 analogue in Modula-2.
11400
11401 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
11402 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
11403 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
11404 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
11405 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
11406 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
11407
11408 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
11409 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
11410 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
11411
11412 @node Ada
11413 @subsection Ada
11414 @cindex Ada
11415
11416 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
11417 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
11418 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
11419 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
11420 to be difficult.
11421
11422
11423 @cindex expressions in Ada
11424 @menu
11425 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
11426 and semantics supported by Ada mode
11427 in @value{GDBN}.
11428 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
11429 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
11430 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
11431 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
11432 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
11433 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
11434 @end menu
11435
11436 @node Ada Mode Intro
11437 @subsubsection Introduction
11438 @cindex Ada mode, general
11439
11440 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
11441 syntax, with some extensions.
11442 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
11443
11444 @itemize @bullet
11445 @item
11446 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
11447 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
11448 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
11449 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
11450
11451 @item
11452 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
11453 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11454
11455 @item
11456 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11457 @end itemize
11458
11459 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
11460 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
11461 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
11462 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
11463 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
11464
11465 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
11466 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
11467 was translated from an Ada source file.
11468
11469 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
11470 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
11471 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
11472 middle (to allow based literals).
11473
11474 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
11475 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
11476 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
11477 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
11478 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
11479 functions to procedures elsewhere.
11480
11481 @node Omissions from Ada
11482 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
11483 @cindex Ada, omissions from
11484
11485 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
11486
11487 @itemize @bullet
11488 @item
11489 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
11490
11491 @itemize @minus
11492 @item
11493 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
11494 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
11495
11496 @item
11497 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
11498
11499 @item
11500 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
11501
11502 @item
11503 @t{'Tag}.
11504
11505 @item
11506 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
11507 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
11508
11509 @item
11510 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
11511 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
11512
11513 @item
11514 @t{'Address}.
11515 @end itemize
11516
11517 @item
11518 The names in
11519 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
11520 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
11521 not currently available.
11522
11523 @item
11524 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
11525 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
11526 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
11527 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
11528 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
11529 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
11530 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
11531 indeterminate values.
11532
11533 @item
11534 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
11535 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
11536 are not implemented.
11537
11538 @item
11539 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
11540 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
11541 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
11542 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
11543 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
11544
11545 @smallexample
11546 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
11547 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
11548 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
11549 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
11550 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
11551 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
11552 @end smallexample
11553
11554 Changing a
11555 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
11556 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
11557 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
11558 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
11559 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
11560 declared to have a type such as:
11561
11562 @smallexample
11563 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
11564 Id : Integer;
11565 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
11566 end record;
11567 @end smallexample
11568
11569 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
11570 assignments:
11571
11572 @smallexample
11573 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
11574 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
11575 @end smallexample
11576
11577 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
11578 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
11579 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
11580 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
11581 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
11582 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
11583 redundant component associations, although which component values are
11584 assigned in such cases is not defined.
11585
11586 @item
11587 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
11588
11589 @item
11590 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
11591 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
11592 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
11593 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
11594 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
11595 the proper resolution.
11596
11597 @item
11598 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
11599
11600 @item
11601 Entry calls are not implemented.
11602
11603 @item
11604 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
11605 formats are not supported.
11606
11607 @item
11608 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
11609
11610 @item
11611 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
11612 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
11613 context.
11614 Should your program
11615 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
11616 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
11617 @end itemize
11618
11619 @node Additions to Ada
11620 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
11621 @cindex Ada, deviations from
11622
11623 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
11624 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
11625
11626 @itemize @bullet
11627 @item
11628 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
11629 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
11630 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
11631 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
11632 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
11633 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
11634 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
11635 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
11636
11637 @item
11638 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
11639 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
11640 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
11641
11642 @item
11643 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
11644 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
11645
11646 @item
11647 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
11648 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
11649 @end itemize
11650
11651 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
11652 additions specific to Ada:
11653
11654 @itemize @bullet
11655 @item
11656 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
11657 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
11658
11659 @smallexample
11660 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
11661 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
11662 @end smallexample
11663
11664 @item
11665 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
11666 the value of its right-hand operand.
11667 This allows, for example,
11668 complex conditional breaks:
11669
11670 @smallexample
11671 (@value{GDBP}) break f
11672 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
11673 @end smallexample
11674
11675 @item
11676 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
11677 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
11678 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
11679 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
11680 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
11681 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
11682 in strings. For example,
11683 @smallexample
11684 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
11685 @end smallexample
11686 @noindent
11687 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
11688 after each period.
11689
11690 @item
11691 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
11692 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
11693 to write
11694
11695 @smallexample
11696 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
11697 @end smallexample
11698
11699 @item
11700 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
11701 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
11702 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
11703 of 3 might print as
11704
11705 @smallexample
11706 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
11707 @end smallexample
11708
11709 @noindent
11710 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
11711 clause.
11712
11713 @item
11714 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
11715 multi-character subsequence of
11716 their names (an exact match gets preference).
11717 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
11718 in place of @t{a'length}.
11719
11720 @item
11721 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
11722 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
11723 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
11724 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
11725 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
11726 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
11727 For example,
11728 @smallexample
11729 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
11730 @end smallexample
11731
11732 @item
11733 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
11734 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
11735 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
11736 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
11737 object.
11738
11739 @end itemize
11740
11741 @node Stopping Before Main Program
11742 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
11743
11744 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
11745 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
11746 before reaching the main procedure.
11747 As defined in the Ada Reference
11748 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
11749 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
11750 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
11751 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
11752
11753 @node Ada Tasks
11754 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
11755 @cindex Ada, tasking
11756
11757 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
11758 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
11759
11760 @table @code
11761 @kindex info tasks
11762 @item info tasks
11763 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
11764
11765
11766 @smallexample
11767 @iftex
11768 @leftskip=0.5cm
11769 @end iftex
11770 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11771 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11772 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11773 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
11774 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
11775 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
11776
11777 @end smallexample
11778
11779 @noindent
11780 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
11781 task currently being inspected.
11782
11783 @table @asis
11784 @item ID
11785 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
11786
11787 @item TID
11788 The Ada task ID.
11789
11790 @item P-ID
11791 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
11792
11793 @item Pri
11794 The base priority of the task.
11795
11796 @item State
11797 Current state of the task.
11798
11799 @table @code
11800 @item Unactivated
11801 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
11802 executing.
11803
11804 @item Runnable
11805 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
11806 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
11807
11808 @item Terminated
11809 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
11810 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
11811 terminated themselves.
11812
11813 @item Child Activation Wait
11814 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
11815
11816 @item Accept Statement
11817 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
11818
11819 @item Waiting on entry call
11820 The task is waiting on an entry call.
11821
11822 @item Async Select Wait
11823 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
11824 select statement.
11825
11826 @item Delay Sleep
11827 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
11828 alternative open.
11829
11830 @item Child Termination Wait
11831 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
11832 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
11833 waiting on a terminate Phase.
11834
11835 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
11836 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
11837 finish terminating.
11838
11839 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
11840 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
11841 @end table
11842
11843 @item Name
11844 Name of the task in the program.
11845
11846 @end table
11847
11848 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
11849 @item info task @var{taskno}
11850 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
11851 the following example:
11852 @smallexample
11853 @iftex
11854 @leftskip=0.5cm
11855 @end iftex
11856 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11857 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11858 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11859 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
11860 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
11861 Ada Task: 0x807c468
11862 Name: task_1
11863 Thread: 0x807f378
11864 Parent: 1 (main_task)
11865 Base Priority: 15
11866 State: Runnable
11867 @end smallexample
11868
11869 @item task
11870 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
11871 @cindex current Ada task ID
11872 This command prints the ID of the current task.
11873
11874 @smallexample
11875 @iftex
11876 @leftskip=0.5cm
11877 @end iftex
11878 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11879 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11880 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11881 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
11882 (@value{GDBP}) task
11883 [Current task is 2]
11884 @end smallexample
11885
11886 @item task @var{taskno}
11887 @cindex Ada task switching
11888 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
11889 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
11890 from the current task to the given task.
11891
11892 @smallexample
11893 @iftex
11894 @leftskip=0.5cm
11895 @end iftex
11896 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11897 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11898 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11899 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
11900 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
11901 [Switching to task 1]
11902 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
11903 (@value{GDBP}) bt
11904 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
11905 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
11906 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
11907 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
11908 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
11909 @end smallexample
11910
11911 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
11912 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
11913 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
11914 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
11915 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
11916 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
11917 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
11918 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
11919 in @ref{Specify Location}.
11920
11921 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
11922 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
11923 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
11924 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
11925 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
11926
11927 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
11928 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
11929 program.
11930
11931 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
11932 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
11933 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
11934
11935 For example,
11936
11937 @smallexample
11938 @iftex
11939 @leftskip=0.5cm
11940 @end iftex
11941 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11942 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11943 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11944 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
11945 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
11946 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
11947 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
11948 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
11949 (@value{GDBP}) cont
11950 Continuing.
11951 task # 1 running
11952 task # 2 running
11953
11954 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
11955 15 flush;
11956 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11957 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11958 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11959 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
11960 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
11961 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
11962 @end smallexample
11963 @end table
11964
11965 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
11966 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
11967 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
11968
11969 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
11970 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
11971 the platform being used.
11972 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
11973 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
11974 as usual.
11975
11976 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
11977 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
11978 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
11979 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
11980 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
11981 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
11982
11983 @node Ada Glitches
11984 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
11985 @cindex Ada, problems
11986
11987 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
11988 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
11989 @value{GDBN},
11990 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
11991 and the GNU Ada compiler.
11992
11993 @itemize @bullet
11994 @item
11995 Currently, the debugger
11996 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
11997 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
11998 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
11999 to get it printed properly.
12000
12001 @item
12002 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
12003 storage are invisible to the debugger.
12004
12005 @item
12006 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
12007 argument lists are treated as positional).
12008
12009 @item
12010 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
12011
12012 @item
12013 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
12014 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
12015 the host machine.
12016
12017 @item
12018 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
12019 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
12020 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
12021 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
12022 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
12023 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
12024 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
12025 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
12026 you can usually resolve the confusion
12027 by qualifying the problematic names with package
12028 @code{Standard} explicitly.
12029 @end itemize
12030
12031 @node Unsupported Languages
12032 @section Unsupported Languages
12033
12034 @cindex unsupported languages
12035 @cindex minimal language
12036 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
12037 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
12038 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
12039 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
12040 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
12041 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
12042
12043 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
12044 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
12045 language.
12046
12047 @node Symbols
12048 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
12049
12050 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
12051 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
12052 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
12053 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
12054 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
12055 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
12056 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12057
12058 @cindex symbol names
12059 @cindex names of symbols
12060 @cindex quoting names
12061 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
12062 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
12063 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
12064 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
12065 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
12066 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
12067 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
12068 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
12069
12070 @smallexample
12071 p 'foo.c'::x
12072 @end smallexample
12073
12074 @noindent
12075 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
12076
12077 @table @code
12078 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
12079 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
12080 @kindex set case-sensitive
12081 @item set case-sensitive on
12082 @itemx set case-sensitive off
12083 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
12084 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
12085 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
12086 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
12087 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
12088 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
12089 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
12090 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
12091 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
12092 case-insensitive matches.
12093
12094 @kindex show case-sensitive
12095 @item show case-sensitive
12096 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
12097 lookups.
12098
12099 @kindex info address
12100 @cindex address of a symbol
12101 @item info address @var{symbol}
12102 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
12103 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
12104 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
12105 is always stored.
12106
12107 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
12108 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
12109 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
12110
12111 @kindex info symbol
12112 @cindex symbol from address
12113 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
12114 @item info symbol @var{addr}
12115 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
12116 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
12117 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
12118
12119 @smallexample
12120 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
12121 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
12122 @end smallexample
12123
12124 @noindent
12125 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
12126 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
12127
12128 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
12129 library containing the symbol is also printed:
12130
12131 @smallexample
12132 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
12133 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
12134 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
12135 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
12136 @end smallexample
12137
12138 @kindex whatis
12139 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
12140 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
12141 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
12142 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
12143 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
12144 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
12145 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
12146 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
12147 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
12148 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
12149 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
12150
12151 @kindex ptype
12152 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
12153 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
12154 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
12155 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
12156
12157 For example, for this variable declaration:
12158
12159 @smallexample
12160 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
12161 @end smallexample
12162
12163 @noindent
12164 the two commands give this output:
12165
12166 @smallexample
12167 @group
12168 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
12169 type = struct complex
12170 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
12171 type = struct complex @{
12172 double real;
12173 double imag;
12174 @}
12175 @end group
12176 @end smallexample
12177
12178 @noindent
12179 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
12180 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
12181
12182 @cindex incomplete type
12183 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
12184 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
12185 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
12186 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
12187 given these declarations:
12188
12189 @smallexample
12190 struct foo;
12191 struct foo *fooptr;
12192 @end smallexample
12193
12194 @noindent
12195 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
12196
12197 @smallexample
12198 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
12199 $1 = <incomplete type>
12200 @end smallexample
12201
12202 @noindent
12203 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
12204 completely specified.
12205
12206 @kindex info types
12207 @item info types @var{regexp}
12208 @itemx info types
12209 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
12210 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
12211 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
12212 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
12213 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
12214 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
12215 name is @code{value}.
12216
12217 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
12218 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
12219 lists all source files where a type is defined.
12220
12221 @kindex info scope
12222 @cindex local variables
12223 @item info scope @var{location}
12224 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
12225 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
12226 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
12227 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
12228 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
12229
12230 @smallexample
12231 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
12232 Scope for command_line_handler:
12233 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
12234 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
12235 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
12236 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
12237 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
12238 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
12239 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
12240 @end smallexample
12241
12242 @noindent
12243 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
12244 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
12245 collect}.
12246
12247 @kindex info source
12248 @item info source
12249 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
12250 the function containing the current point of execution:
12251 @itemize @bullet
12252 @item
12253 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
12254 @item
12255 the directory it was compiled in,
12256 @item
12257 its length, in lines,
12258 @item
12259 which programming language it is written in,
12260 @item
12261 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
12262 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
12263 @item
12264 whether the debugging information includes information about
12265 preprocessor macros.
12266 @end itemize
12267
12268
12269 @kindex info sources
12270 @item info sources
12271 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
12272 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
12273 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
12274
12275 @kindex info functions
12276 @item info functions
12277 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
12278
12279 @item info functions @var{regexp}
12280 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
12281 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
12282 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
12283 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
12284 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
12285 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
12286 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
12287
12288 @kindex info variables
12289 @item info variables
12290 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
12291 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
12292
12293 @item info variables @var{regexp}
12294 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
12295 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
12296 @var{regexp}.
12297
12298 @kindex info classes
12299 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
12300 @item info classes
12301 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
12302 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
12303 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12304 expression.
12305
12306 @kindex info selectors
12307 @item info selectors
12308 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
12309 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
12310 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12311 expression.
12312
12313 @ignore
12314 This was never implemented.
12315 @kindex info methods
12316 @item info methods
12317 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
12318 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
12319 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
12320 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
12321 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
12322 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
12323 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
12324 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
12325 @end ignore
12326
12327 @cindex reloading symbols
12328 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
12329 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
12330 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
12331 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
12332 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
12333
12334 @table @code
12335 @kindex set symbol-reloading
12336 @item set symbol-reloading on
12337 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
12338 object file with a particular name is seen again.
12339
12340 @item set symbol-reloading off
12341 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
12342 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
12343 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
12344 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
12345 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
12346 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
12347 name.
12348
12349 @kindex show symbol-reloading
12350 @item show symbol-reloading
12351 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
12352 @end table
12353
12354 @cindex opaque data types
12355 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
12356 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
12357 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
12358 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
12359 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
12360 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
12361 another source file. The default is on.
12362
12363 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
12364 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
12365
12366 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
12367 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
12368 is printed as follows:
12369 @smallexample
12370 @{<no data fields>@}
12371 @end smallexample
12372
12373 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
12374 @item show opaque-type-resolution
12375 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
12376
12377 @kindex set print symbol-loading
12378 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
12379 @item set print symbol-loading
12380 @itemx set print symbol-loading on
12381 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
12382 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to enable or
12383 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
12384 By default, these messages will be printed, and normally this is what
12385 you want. Disabling these messages is useful when debugging applications
12386 with lots of shared libraries where the quantity of output can be more
12387 annoying than useful.
12388
12389 @kindex show print symbol-loading
12390 @item show print symbol-loading
12391 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
12392
12393 @kindex maint print symbols
12394 @cindex symbol dump
12395 @kindex maint print psymbols
12396 @cindex partial symbol dump
12397 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
12398 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
12399 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
12400 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
12401 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
12402 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
12403 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
12404 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
12405 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
12406 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
12407 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
12408 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
12409 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
12410 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
12411 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
12412 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
12413 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
12414
12415 @kindex maint info symtabs
12416 @kindex maint info psymtabs
12417 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
12418 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12419 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12420 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12421 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
12422 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
12423
12424 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
12425 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
12426 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
12427 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
12428 structure in more detail. For example:
12429
12430 @smallexample
12431 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
12432 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
12433 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
12434 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
12435 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
12436 readin no
12437 fullname (null)
12438 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
12439 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
12440 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
12441 dependencies (none)
12442 @}
12443 @}
12444 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
12445 (@value{GDBP})
12446 @end smallexample
12447 @noindent
12448 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
12449 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
12450 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
12451 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
12452 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
12453
12454 @smallexample
12455 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
12456 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
12457 line 1574.
12458 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
12459 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
12460 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
12461 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
12462 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
12463 dirname (null)
12464 fullname (null)
12465 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
12466 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
12467 debugformat DWARF 2
12468 @}
12469 @}
12470 (@value{GDBP})
12471 @end smallexample
12472 @end table
12473
12474
12475 @node Altering
12476 @chapter Altering Execution
12477
12478 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
12479 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
12480 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
12481 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
12482 program.
12483
12484 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
12485 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
12486 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
12487
12488 @menu
12489 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
12490 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
12491 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
12492 * Returning:: Returning from a function
12493 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
12494 * Patching:: Patching your program
12495 @end menu
12496
12497 @node Assignment
12498 @section Assignment to Variables
12499
12500 @cindex assignment
12501 @cindex setting variables
12502 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
12503 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
12504
12505 @smallexample
12506 print x=4
12507 @end smallexample
12508
12509 @noindent
12510 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
12511 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
12512 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
12513 information on operators in supported languages.
12514
12515 @kindex set variable
12516 @cindex variables, setting
12517 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
12518 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
12519 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
12520 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
12521 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
12522
12523 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
12524 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
12525 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
12526 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
12527 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
12528 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
12529 command @code{set width}:
12530
12531 @smallexample
12532 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
12533 type = double
12534 (@value{GDBP}) p width
12535 $4 = 13
12536 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
12537 Invalid syntax in expression.
12538 @end smallexample
12539
12540 @noindent
12541 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
12542 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
12543
12544 @smallexample
12545 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
12546 @end smallexample
12547
12548 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
12549 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
12550 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
12551 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
12552 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
12553 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
12554
12555 @smallexample
12556 @group
12557 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
12558 type = double
12559 (@value{GDBP}) p g
12560 $1 = 1
12561 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
12562 (@value{GDBP}) p g
12563 $2 = 1
12564 (@value{GDBP}) r
12565 The program being debugged has been started already.
12566 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
12567 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
12568 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
12569 Invalid bfd target.
12570 (@value{GDBP}) show g
12571 The current BFD target is "=4".
12572 @end group
12573 @end smallexample
12574
12575 @noindent
12576 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
12577 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
12578 @code{g}, use
12579
12580 @smallexample
12581 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
12582 @end smallexample
12583
12584 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
12585 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
12586 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
12587 same length or shorter.
12588 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
12589 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
12590
12591 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
12592 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
12593 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
12594 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
12595 and representation in memory), and
12596
12597 @smallexample
12598 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
12599 @end smallexample
12600
12601 @noindent
12602 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
12603
12604 @node Jumping
12605 @section Continuing at a Different Address
12606
12607 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
12608 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
12609 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
12610
12611 @table @code
12612 @kindex jump
12613 @item jump @var{linespec}
12614 @itemx jump @var{location}
12615 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
12616 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
12617 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
12618 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
12619 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
12620 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
12621
12622 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
12623 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
12624 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
12625 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
12626 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
12627 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
12628 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
12629 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
12630 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
12631 @end table
12632
12633 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
12634 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
12635 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
12636 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
12637 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
12638 example,
12639
12640 @smallexample
12641 set $pc = 0x485
12642 @end smallexample
12643
12644 @noindent
12645 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
12646 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
12647 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
12648
12649 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
12650 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
12651 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
12652 detail.
12653
12654 @c @group
12655 @node Signaling
12656 @section Giving your Program a Signal
12657 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
12658
12659 @table @code
12660 @kindex signal
12661 @item signal @var{signal}
12662 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
12663 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
12664 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
12665 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
12666
12667 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
12668 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
12669 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
12670 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
12671 signal.
12672
12673 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
12674 after executing the command.
12675 @end table
12676 @c @end group
12677
12678 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
12679 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
12680 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
12681 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
12682 passes the signal directly to your program.
12683
12684
12685 @node Returning
12686 @section Returning from a Function
12687
12688 @table @code
12689 @cindex returning from a function
12690 @kindex return
12691 @item return
12692 @itemx return @var{expression}
12693 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
12694 command. If you give an
12695 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
12696 value.
12697 @end table
12698
12699 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
12700 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
12701 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
12702 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
12703
12704 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
12705 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
12706 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
12707 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
12708 of functions.
12709
12710 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
12711 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
12712 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
12713 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
12714 selected stack frame returns naturally.
12715
12716 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
12717 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
12718 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
12719 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
12720 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
12721 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
12722 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
12723 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
12724 assignment into the right register(s).
12725
12726 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
12727 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
12728 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
12729 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
12730 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
12731 into a @code{long long int}:
12732
12733 @smallexample
12734 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
12735 29 return 31;
12736 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
12737 Make func return now? (y or n) y
12738 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
12739 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
12740 (@value{GDBP})
12741 @end smallexample
12742
12743 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
12744 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
12745 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
12746 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
12747 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
12748 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
12749 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
12750 an appropriate cast explicitly:
12751
12752 @smallexample
12753 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
12754 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
12755 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
12756 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
12757 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
12758 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
12759 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
12760 (@value{GDBP})
12761 @end smallexample
12762
12763 @node Calling
12764 @section Calling Program Functions
12765
12766 @table @code
12767 @cindex calling functions
12768 @cindex inferior functions, calling
12769 @item print @var{expr}
12770 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
12771 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
12772 debugged.
12773
12774 @kindex call
12775 @item call @var{expr}
12776 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
12777 returned values.
12778
12779 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
12780 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
12781 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
12782 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
12783 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
12784 value history.
12785 @end table
12786
12787 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
12788 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
12789 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
12790 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
12791
12792 @table @code
12793 @item set unwindonsignal
12794 @kindex set unwindonsignal
12795 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
12796 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
12797 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
12798 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
12799 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
12800 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
12801 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
12802 received.
12803
12804 @item show unwindonsignal
12805 @kindex show unwindonsignal
12806 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
12807 @value{GDBN}.
12808 @end table
12809
12810 @cindex weak alias functions
12811 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
12812 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
12813 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
12814 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
12815 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
12816 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
12817 function instead.
12818
12819 @node Patching
12820 @section Patching Programs
12821
12822 @cindex patching binaries
12823 @cindex writing into executables
12824 @cindex writing into corefiles
12825
12826 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
12827 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
12828 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
12829 patching your program's binary.
12830
12831 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
12832 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
12833 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
12834 repairs.
12835
12836 @table @code
12837 @kindex set write
12838 @item set write on
12839 @itemx set write off
12840 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
12841 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
12842 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
12843
12844 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
12845 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
12846 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
12847
12848 @item show write
12849 @kindex show write
12850 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
12851 as well as reading.
12852 @end table
12853
12854 @node GDB Files
12855 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
12856
12857 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
12858 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
12859 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
12860 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
12861
12862 @menu
12863 * Files:: Commands to specify files
12864 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
12865 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
12866 * Data Files:: GDB data files
12867 @end menu
12868
12869 @node Files
12870 @section Commands to Specify Files
12871
12872 @cindex symbol table
12873 @cindex core dump file
12874
12875 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
12876 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
12877 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
12878 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
12879
12880 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
12881 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
12882 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
12883 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
12884 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
12885 new files are useful.
12886
12887 @table @code
12888 @cindex executable file
12889 @kindex file
12890 @item file @var{filename}
12891 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
12892 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
12893 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
12894 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
12895 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
12896 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
12897 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
12898 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
12899
12900 @cindex unlinked object files
12901 @cindex patching object files
12902 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
12903 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
12904 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
12905 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
12906 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
12907 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
12908 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
12909 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
12910
12911 @item file
12912 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
12913 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
12914
12915 @kindex exec-file
12916 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12917 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
12918 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
12919 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
12920 discard information on the executable file.
12921
12922 @kindex symbol-file
12923 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12924 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
12925 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
12926 table and program to run from the same file.
12927
12928 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
12929 program's symbol table.
12930
12931 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
12932 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
12933 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
12934 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
12935 @value{GDBN}.
12936
12937 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
12938 executing it once.
12939
12940 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
12941 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
12942 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
12943 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
12944 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
12945 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
12946 optimized code.
12947
12948 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
12949 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
12950 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
12951 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
12952 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
12953
12954 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
12955 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
12956 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
12957 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
12958 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
12959 Warnings and Messages}.)
12960
12961 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
12962 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
12963 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
12964 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
12965 in stabs format.
12966
12967 @kindex readnow
12968 @cindex reading symbols immediately
12969 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
12970 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12971 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12972 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
12973 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
12974 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
12975 entire symbol table available.
12976
12977 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
12978 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
12979 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
12980 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
12981 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
12982 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
12983 @c files.
12984
12985 @kindex core-file
12986 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
12987 @itemx core
12988 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
12989 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
12990 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
12991 executable file itself for other parts.
12992
12993 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
12994 to be used.
12995
12996 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
12997 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
12998 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
12999 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
13000 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
13001
13002 @kindex add-symbol-file
13003 @cindex dynamic linking
13004 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
13005 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
13006 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
13007 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
13008 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
13009 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
13010 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
13011 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
13012 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
13013 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
13014 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
13015 @var{address} as an expression.
13016
13017 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
13018 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
13019 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
13020 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
13021 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
13022
13023 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
13024 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
13025 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
13026 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
13027 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
13028 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
13029 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
13030 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
13031 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
13032
13033 @itemize @bullet
13034 @item
13035 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
13036 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
13037 @item
13038 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
13039 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
13040 @item
13041 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
13042 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
13043 @end itemize
13044
13045 @noindent
13046 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
13047 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
13048 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
13049 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
13050 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
13051 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
13052 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
13053 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
13054 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
13055 way.
13056
13057 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
13058
13059 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
13060 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
13061 @cindex load symbols from memory
13062 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
13063 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
13064 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
13065 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
13066 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
13067 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
13068 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
13069 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
13070 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
13071
13072 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
13073 @kindex assf
13074 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
13075 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
13076 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
13077 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
13078 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
13079 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
13080 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
13081 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
13082 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
13083 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
13084
13085 @kindex section
13086 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
13087 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
13088 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
13089 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
13090 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
13091 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
13092 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
13093 their addresses.
13094
13095 @kindex info files
13096 @kindex info target
13097 @item info files
13098 @itemx info target
13099 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
13100 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
13101 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
13102 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
13103 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
13104 current ones.
13105
13106 @kindex maint info sections
13107 @item maint info sections
13108 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
13109 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
13110 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
13111 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
13112 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
13113 may be arbitrarily combined):
13114
13115 @table @code
13116 @item ALLOBJ
13117 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
13118 @item @var{sections}
13119 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
13120 @item @var{section-flags}
13121 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
13122 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
13123 @table @code
13124 @item ALLOC
13125 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
13126 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
13127 @item LOAD
13128 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
13129 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
13130 @item RELOC
13131 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
13132 @item READONLY
13133 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
13134 @item CODE
13135 Section contains executable code only.
13136 @item DATA
13137 Section contains data only (no executable code).
13138 @item ROM
13139 Section will reside in ROM.
13140 @item CONSTRUCTOR
13141 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
13142 @item HAS_CONTENTS
13143 Section is not empty.
13144 @item NEVER_LOAD
13145 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
13146 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
13147 A notification to the linker that the section contains
13148 COFF shared library information.
13149 @item IS_COMMON
13150 Section contains common symbols.
13151 @end table
13152 @end table
13153 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
13154 @cindex read-only sections
13155 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
13156 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
13157 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
13158 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
13159 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
13160 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
13161 enhancement to debugging performance.
13162
13163 The default is off.
13164
13165 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
13166 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
13167 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
13168 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
13169
13170 @item show trust-readonly-sections
13171 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
13172 @end table
13173
13174 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
13175 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
13176 name and remembers it that way.
13177
13178 @cindex shared libraries
13179 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
13180 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
13181 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
13182
13183 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
13184 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
13185
13186 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
13187 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
13188 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
13189 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
13190 debugging a core file).
13191
13192 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
13193 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
13194
13195 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
13196 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
13197 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
13198
13199 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
13200 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
13201 particularly large or there are many of them.
13202
13203 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
13204 commands:
13205
13206 @table @code
13207 @kindex set auto-solib-add
13208 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
13209 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
13210 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
13211 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
13212 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
13213 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
13214 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
13215
13216 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
13217 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
13218 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
13219 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
13220 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
13221 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
13222 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
13223 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
13224 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
13225
13226 @kindex show auto-solib-add
13227 @item show auto-solib-add
13228 Display the current autoloading mode.
13229 @end table
13230
13231 @cindex load shared library
13232 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
13233 command:
13234
13235 @table @code
13236 @kindex info sharedlibrary
13237 @kindex info share
13238 @item info share
13239 @itemx info sharedlibrary
13240 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
13241
13242 @kindex sharedlibrary
13243 @kindex share
13244 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
13245 @itemx share @var{regex}
13246 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
13247 Unix regular expression.
13248 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
13249 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
13250 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
13251 loaded.
13252
13253 @item nosharedlibrary
13254 @kindex nosharedlibrary
13255 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
13256 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
13257 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
13258 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
13259 discarded.
13260 @end table
13261
13262 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
13263 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
13264 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
13265
13266 @table @code
13267 @item set stop-on-solib-events
13268 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
13269 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
13270 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
13271 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
13272 shared library.
13273
13274 @item show stop-on-solib-events
13275 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
13276 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
13277 library events happen.
13278 @end table
13279
13280 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
13281 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
13282 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
13283 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
13284 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
13285 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
13286 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
13287 not.
13288
13289 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
13290 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
13291 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
13292 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
13293 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
13294
13295 @table @code
13296 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
13297 @cindex system root, alternate
13298 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
13299 @kindex set sysroot
13300 @item set sysroot @var{path}
13301 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
13302 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
13303 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
13304 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
13305 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
13306 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
13307 under @var{path}.
13308
13309 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
13310 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
13311 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
13312 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
13313 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
13314 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
13315 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
13316 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
13317 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
13318
13319 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
13320 sysroot}.
13321
13322 @cindex default system root
13323 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
13324 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
13325 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
13326 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
13327 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
13328 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
13329 location.
13330
13331 @kindex show sysroot
13332 @item show sysroot
13333 Display the current shared library prefix.
13334
13335 @kindex set solib-search-path
13336 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
13337 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
13338 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
13339 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
13340 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
13341 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
13342 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
13343 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
13344 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
13345 of shared library symbols.
13346
13347 @kindex show solib-search-path
13348 @item show solib-search-path
13349 Display the current shared library search path.
13350 @end table
13351
13352
13353 @node Separate Debug Files
13354 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
13355 @cindex separate debugging information files
13356 @cindex debugging information in separate files
13357 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
13358 @cindex debugging information directory, global
13359 @cindex global debugging information directory
13360 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
13361 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
13362
13363 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
13364 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
13365 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
13366 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
13367 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
13368 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
13369 install only when they need to debug a problem.
13370
13371 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
13372 file:
13373
13374 @itemize @bullet
13375 @item
13376 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
13377 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
13378 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
13379 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
13380 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
13381 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
13382 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
13383 came from the same build.
13384
13385 @item
13386 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
13387 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
13388 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
13389 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
13390 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
13391 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
13392 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
13393 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
13394 below.
13395 @end itemize
13396
13397 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
13398 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
13399
13400 @itemize @bullet
13401 @item
13402 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
13403 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
13404 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
13405 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
13406 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
13407
13408 @item
13409 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
13410 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
13411 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
13412 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
13413 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
13414 hex characters, not 10.)
13415 @end itemize
13416
13417 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
13418 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
13419 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
13420 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
13421 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
13422 debug information files, in the indicated order:
13423
13424 @itemize @minus
13425 @item
13426 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
13427 @item
13428 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
13429 @item
13430 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
13431 @item
13432 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
13433 @end itemize
13434
13435 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
13436 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
13437
13438 @table @code
13439
13440 @kindex set debug-file-directory
13441 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
13442 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
13443 information files to @var{directory}.
13444
13445 @kindex show debug-file-directory
13446 @item show debug-file-directory
13447 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
13448 information files.
13449
13450 @end table
13451
13452 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
13453 @cindex debug link sections
13454 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
13455 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
13456
13457 @itemize
13458 @item
13459 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
13460 a zero byte,
13461 @item
13462 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
13463 boundary within the section, and
13464 @item
13465 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
13466 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
13467 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
13468 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
13469 @end itemize
13470
13471 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
13472 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
13473 described above.
13474
13475 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
13476 @cindex build ID sections
13477 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
13478 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
13479 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
13480 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
13481 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
13482 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
13483 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
13484 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
13485 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
13486
13487 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
13488 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
13489 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
13490 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
13491 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
13492 in an ordinary executable.
13493
13494 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
13495 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
13496 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
13497 following commands:
13498
13499 @smallexample
13500 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
13501 @kbd{strip -g foo}
13502 @end smallexample
13503
13504 @noindent
13505 These commands remove the debugging
13506 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
13507 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
13508 two files:
13509
13510 @itemize @bullet
13511 @item
13512 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
13513 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
13514
13515 @smallexample
13516 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
13517 @end smallexample
13518
13519 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
13520 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
13521 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
13522 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
13523
13524 @item
13525 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
13526 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
13527 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
13528 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
13529 @end itemize
13530
13531 @noindent
13532
13533 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
13534 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
13535 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
13536 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
13537
13538 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
13539 @smallexample
13540 unsigned long
13541 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
13542 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
13543 @{
13544 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
13545 @{
13546 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
13547 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
13548 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
13549 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
13550 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
13551 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
13552 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
13553 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
13554 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
13555 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
13556 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
13557 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
13558 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
13559 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
13560 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
13561 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
13562 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
13563 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
13564 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
13565 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
13566 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
13567 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
13568 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
13569 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
13570 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
13571 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
13572 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
13573 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
13574 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
13575 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
13576 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
13577 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
13578 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
13579 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
13580 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
13581 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
13582 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
13583 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
13584 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
13585 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
13586 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
13587 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
13588 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
13589 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
13590 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
13591 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
13592 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
13593 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
13594 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
13595 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
13596 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
13597 0x2d02ef8d
13598 @};
13599 unsigned char *end;
13600
13601 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
13602 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
13603 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
13604 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
13605 @}
13606 @end smallexample
13607
13608 @noindent
13609 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
13610
13611
13612 @node Symbol Errors
13613 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
13614
13615 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
13616 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
13617 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
13618 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
13619 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
13620 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
13621 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
13622 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
13623 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
13624 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13625 Messages}).
13626
13627 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
13628
13629 @table @code
13630 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
13631
13632 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
13633 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
13634 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
13635 in its outer scope blocks.
13636
13637 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
13638 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
13639 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
13640 function.
13641
13642 @item block at @var{address} out of order
13643
13644 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
13645 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
13646 do so.
13647
13648 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
13649 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
13650 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
13651 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13652 Messages}.)
13653
13654 @item bad block start address patched
13655
13656 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
13657 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
13658 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
13659
13660 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
13661 starting on the previous source line.
13662
13663 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
13664
13665 @cindex foo
13666 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
13667 larger than the size of the string table.
13668
13669 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
13670 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
13671 with this name.
13672
13673 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
13674
13675 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
13676 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
13677 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
13678
13679 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
13680 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
13681 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
13682 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
13683 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
13684 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
13685
13686 @item stub type has NULL name
13687
13688 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
13689
13690 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
13691 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
13692 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
13693 it.
13694
13695 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
13696
13697 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
13698
13699 @end table
13700
13701 @node Data Files
13702 @section GDB Data Files
13703
13704 @cindex prefix for data files
13705 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
13706 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
13707
13708 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
13709 is currently using.
13710
13711 @table @code
13712 @kindex set data-directory
13713 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
13714 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
13715 to @var{directory}.
13716
13717 @kindex show data-directory
13718 @item show data-directory
13719 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
13720 @end table
13721
13722 @cindex default data directory
13723 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
13724 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
13725 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
13726 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
13727 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
13728 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
13729 location.
13730
13731 @node Targets
13732 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
13733
13734 @cindex debugging target
13735 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
13736
13737 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
13738 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
13739 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
13740 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
13741 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
13742 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
13743 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
13744 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
13745
13746 @cindex target architecture
13747 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
13748 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
13749 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
13750 command.
13751
13752 @table @code
13753 @kindex set architecture
13754 @kindex show architecture
13755 @item set architecture @var{arch}
13756 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
13757 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
13758 supported architectures.
13759
13760 @item show architecture
13761 Show the current target architecture.
13762
13763 @item set processor
13764 @itemx processor
13765 @kindex set processor
13766 @kindex show processor
13767 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
13768 and @code{show architecture}.
13769 @end table
13770
13771 @menu
13772 * Active Targets:: Active targets
13773 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
13774 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
13775 @end menu
13776
13777 @node Active Targets
13778 @section Active Targets
13779
13780 @cindex stacking targets
13781 @cindex active targets
13782 @cindex multiple targets
13783
13784 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
13785 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
13786 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
13787 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
13788 a core file.
13789
13790 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
13791 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
13792 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
13793 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
13794 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
13795 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
13796 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
13797 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
13798 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
13799
13800 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
13801 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
13802 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
13803 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
13804 process target is active.
13805
13806 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
13807 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
13808 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
13809 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
13810 Process}).
13811
13812 @node Target Commands
13813 @section Commands for Managing Targets
13814
13815 @table @code
13816 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
13817 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
13818 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
13819 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
13820 protocol of the target machine.
13821
13822 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
13823 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
13824 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
13825
13826 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
13827 after executing the command.
13828
13829 @kindex help target
13830 @item help target
13831 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
13832 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
13833 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13834
13835 @item help target @var{name}
13836 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
13837 select it.
13838
13839 @kindex set gnutarget
13840 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
13841 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
13842 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
13843 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
13844 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
13845 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
13846
13847 @quotation
13848 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
13849 you must know the actual BFD name.
13850 @end quotation
13851
13852 @noindent
13853 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
13854
13855 @kindex show gnutarget
13856 @item show gnutarget
13857 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
13858 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
13859 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
13860 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
13861 @end table
13862
13863 @cindex common targets
13864 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
13865 configuration):
13866
13867 @table @code
13868 @kindex target
13869 @item target exec @var{program}
13870 @cindex executable file target
13871 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
13872 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
13873
13874 @item target core @var{filename}
13875 @cindex core dump file target
13876 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
13877 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
13878
13879 @item target remote @var{medium}
13880 @cindex remote target
13881 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
13882 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
13883 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
13884
13885 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
13886 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
13887
13888 @smallexample
13889 target remote /dev/ttya
13890 @end smallexample
13891
13892 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
13893 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
13894 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
13895 clobbered by the download.
13896
13897 @item target sim
13898 @cindex built-in simulator target
13899 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
13900 In general,
13901 @smallexample
13902 target sim
13903 load
13904 run
13905 @end smallexample
13906 @noindent
13907 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
13908 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
13909 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
13910 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
13911 Processors}.
13912
13913 @end table
13914
13915 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
13916
13917 @table @code
13918
13919 @item target nrom @var{dev}
13920 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
13921 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
13922
13923 @end table
13924
13925 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
13926 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
13927
13928 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
13929 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
13930 various aspects of this process.
13931
13932 @table @code
13933
13934 @item set hash
13935 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13936 @cindex hash mark while downloading
13937 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
13938 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
13939 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
13940 monitor.
13941
13942 @item show hash
13943 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13944 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
13945
13946 @item set debug monitor
13947 @kindex set debug monitor
13948 @cindex display remote monitor communications
13949 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
13950 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13951
13952 @item show debug monitor
13953 @kindex show debug monitor
13954 Show the current status of displaying communications between
13955 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13956 @end table
13957
13958 @table @code
13959
13960 @kindex load @var{filename}
13961 @item load @var{filename}
13962 @anchor{load}
13963 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
13964 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
13965 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
13966 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
13967 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
13968 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
13969
13970 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
13971 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
13972 target is @dots{}}''
13973
13974 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
13975 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
13976 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
13977 specifies a fixed address.
13978 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
13979
13980 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
13981 load programs into flash memory.
13982
13983 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
13984 @end table
13985
13986 @node Byte Order
13987 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
13988
13989 @cindex choosing target byte order
13990 @cindex target byte order
13991
13992 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
13993 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
13994 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
13995 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
13996 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
13997 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
13998
13999 @table @code
14000 @kindex set endian
14001 @item set endian big
14002 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
14003
14004 @item set endian little
14005 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
14006
14007 @item set endian auto
14008 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
14009 executable.
14010
14011 @item show endian
14012 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
14013
14014 @end table
14015
14016 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
14017 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
14018 target system.
14019
14020
14021 @node Remote Debugging
14022 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
14023 @cindex remote debugging
14024
14025 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
14026 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
14027 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
14028 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
14029 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
14030
14031 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
14032 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
14033 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
14034 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
14035 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
14036 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
14037
14038 Other remote targets may be available in your
14039 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
14040
14041 @menu
14042 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
14043 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
14044 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
14045 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
14046 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
14047 @end menu
14048
14049 @node Connecting
14050 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
14051
14052 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
14053 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
14054 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
14055 program as the first argument.
14056
14057 @cindex @code{target remote}
14058 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
14059 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
14060 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
14061 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
14062 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
14063 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
14064
14065 @table @code
14066
14067 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
14068 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
14069 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
14070 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
14071
14072 @smallexample
14073 target remote /dev/ttyb
14074 @end smallexample
14075
14076 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
14077 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
14078 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
14079 @code{target} command.
14080
14081 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
14082 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
14083 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
14084 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
14085 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
14086 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
14087 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
14088 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
14089 target.
14090
14091 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
14092 @code{manyfarms}:
14093
14094 @smallexample
14095 target remote manyfarms:2828
14096 @end smallexample
14097
14098 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
14099 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
14100 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
14101 port 1234 on your local machine:
14102
14103 @smallexample
14104 target remote :1234
14105 @end smallexample
14106 @noindent
14107
14108 Note that the colon is still required here.
14109
14110 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
14111 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
14112 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
14113 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
14114
14115 @smallexample
14116 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
14117 @end smallexample
14118
14119 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
14120 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
14121 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
14122 cause havoc with your debugging session.
14123
14124 @item target remote | @var{command}
14125 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
14126 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
14127 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
14128 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
14129 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
14130 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
14131 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
14132 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
14133
14134 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
14135 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
14136 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
14137
14138 @end table
14139
14140 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
14141 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
14142 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
14143 need to use @kbd{run}.
14144
14145 @cindex interrupting remote programs
14146 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
14147 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
14148 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
14149 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
14150 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
14151 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
14152
14153 @smallexample
14154 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
14155 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
14156 @end smallexample
14157
14158 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
14159 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
14160 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
14161 goes back to waiting.
14162
14163 @table @code
14164 @kindex detach (remote)
14165 @item detach
14166 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
14167 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
14168 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
14169 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
14170 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
14171
14172 @kindex disconnect
14173 @item disconnect
14174 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
14175 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
14176 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
14177 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
14178 another target.
14179
14180 @cindex send command to remote monitor
14181 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
14182 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
14183 @kindex monitor
14184 @item monitor @var{cmd}
14185 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
14186 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
14187 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
14188 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
14189 and implement.
14190 @end table
14191
14192 @node File Transfer
14193 @section Sending files to a remote system
14194 @cindex remote target, file transfer
14195 @cindex file transfer
14196 @cindex sending files to remote systems
14197
14198 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
14199 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
14200 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
14201 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
14202 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
14203 the only way to upload or download files.
14204
14205 Not all remote targets support these commands.
14206
14207 @table @code
14208 @kindex remote put
14209 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
14210 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
14211 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
14212
14213 @kindex remote get
14214 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
14215 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
14216 on the host system.
14217
14218 @kindex remote delete
14219 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
14220 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
14221
14222 @end table
14223
14224 @node Server
14225 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
14226
14227 @kindex gdbserver
14228 @cindex remote connection without stubs
14229 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
14230 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
14231 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
14232
14233 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
14234 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
14235 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
14236 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
14237 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
14238 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
14239 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
14240 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
14241 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
14242 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
14243 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
14244 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
14245 choice for debugging.
14246
14247 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
14248 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
14249 protocol.
14250
14251 @quotation
14252 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
14253 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
14254 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
14255 target system with the same privileges as the user running
14256 @code{gdbserver}.
14257 @end quotation
14258
14259 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
14260 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
14261
14262 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
14263 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
14264 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
14265 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
14266 system does all the symbol handling.
14267
14268 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
14269 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
14270 syntax is:
14271
14272 @smallexample
14273 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
14274 @end smallexample
14275
14276 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
14277 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
14278 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
14279 @file{/dev/com1}:
14280
14281 @smallexample
14282 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
14283 @end smallexample
14284
14285 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
14286 with it.
14287
14288 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
14289
14290 @smallexample
14291 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
14292 @end smallexample
14293
14294 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
14295 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
14296 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
14297 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
14298 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
14299 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
14300 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
14301 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
14302 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
14303 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
14304 @code{target remote} command.
14305
14306 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
14307
14308 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
14309 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
14310
14311 @smallexample
14312 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
14313 @end smallexample
14314
14315 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
14316 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
14317
14318 @pindex pidof
14319 @cindex attach to a program by name
14320 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
14321 @code{pidof} utility:
14322
14323 @smallexample
14324 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
14325 @end smallexample
14326
14327 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
14328 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
14329 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
14330
14331 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
14332 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
14333 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
14334
14335 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
14336 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
14337 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
14338 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
14339
14340 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
14341 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
14342 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
14343 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
14344 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
14345 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
14346 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
14347 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
14348 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
14349
14350 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
14351 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
14352 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
14353 the program you want to debug.
14354
14355 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
14356 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
14357 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
14358
14359 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
14360
14361 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
14362 status information about the debugging process. The
14363 @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
14364 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
14365 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
14366
14367 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
14368 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
14369 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
14370 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
14371
14372 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
14373 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
14374 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
14375 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
14376
14377 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
14378 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
14379 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
14380 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
14381
14382 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
14383 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
14384 environment:
14385
14386 @smallexample
14387 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
14388 @end smallexample
14389
14390 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
14391
14392 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
14393
14394 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
14395 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
14396 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
14397 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
14398
14399 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
14400 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
14401 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
14402 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
14403 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
14404 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
14405 programs.
14406
14407 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
14408 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
14409 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
14410 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
14411 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
14412 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
14413 already on the target.
14414
14415 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
14416 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
14417 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
14418
14419 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
14420 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
14421 Here are the available commands.
14422
14423 @table @code
14424 @item monitor help
14425 List the available monitor commands.
14426
14427 @item monitor set debug 0
14428 @itemx monitor set debug 1
14429 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
14430
14431 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
14432 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
14433 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
14434 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
14435
14436 @item monitor exit
14437 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
14438 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
14439 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
14440 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
14441 of a multi-process mode debug session.
14442
14443 @end table
14444
14445 @node Remote Configuration
14446 @section Remote Configuration
14447
14448 @kindex set remote
14449 @kindex show remote
14450 This section documents the configuration options available when
14451 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
14452 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
14453 system-call-allowed}.
14454
14455 @table @code
14456 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
14457 @cindex address size for remote targets
14458 @cindex bits in remote address
14459 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
14460 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
14461 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
14462 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
14463
14464 @item show remoteaddresssize
14465 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
14466
14467 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
14468 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
14469 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
14470 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
14471 remote targets.
14472
14473 @item show remotebaud
14474 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
14475
14476 @item set remotebreak
14477 @cindex interrupt remote programs
14478 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
14479 @anchor{set remotebreak}
14480 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
14481 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
14482 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
14483 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
14484 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
14485
14486 @item show remotebreak
14487 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
14488 interrupt the remote program.
14489
14490 @item set remoteflow on
14491 @itemx set remoteflow off
14492 @kindex set remoteflow
14493 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
14494 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
14495
14496 @item show remoteflow
14497 @kindex show remoteflow
14498 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
14499
14500 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
14501 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
14502 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
14503 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
14504 @code{ascii}.
14505
14506 @item show remotelogbase
14507 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
14508 protocol.
14509
14510 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
14511 @cindex record serial communications on file
14512 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
14513 default is not to record at all.
14514
14515 @item show remotelogfile.
14516 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
14517 serial communications.
14518
14519 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
14520 @cindex timeout for serial communications
14521 @cindex remote timeout
14522 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
14523 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
14524
14525 @item show remotetimeout
14526 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
14527 responses.
14528
14529 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
14530 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
14531 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
14532 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
14533 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
14534 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
14535 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
14536 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
14537
14538 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
14539 @itemx show remote exec-file
14540 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
14541 @cindex executable file, for remote target
14542 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
14543 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
14544 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
14545 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
14546
14547 @kindex set tcp
14548 @kindex show tcp
14549 @item set tcp auto-retry on
14550 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
14551 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
14552 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
14553 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
14554 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
14555 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
14556 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
14557 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
14558
14559 @item set tcp auto-retry off
14560 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
14561
14562 @item show tcp auto-retry
14563 Show the current auto-retry setting.
14564
14565 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
14566 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
14567 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
14568 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
14569 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
14570 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
14571 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
14572 value.
14573
14574 @item show tcp connect-timeout
14575 Show the current connection timeout setting.
14576 @end table
14577
14578 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
14579 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
14580 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
14581 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
14582 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
14583 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
14584 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
14585 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
14586 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
14587
14588 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
14589 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
14590 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
14591 @value{GDBN} developers.
14592
14593 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
14594 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
14595 are:
14596
14597 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
14598 @item Command Name
14599 @tab Remote Packet
14600 @tab Related Features
14601
14602 @item @code{fetch-register}
14603 @tab @code{p}
14604 @tab @code{info registers}
14605
14606 @item @code{set-register}
14607 @tab @code{P}
14608 @tab @code{set}
14609
14610 @item @code{binary-download}
14611 @tab @code{X}
14612 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
14613
14614 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
14615 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
14616 @tab @code{info auxv}
14617
14618 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
14619 @tab @code{qSymbol}
14620 @tab Detecting multiple threads
14621
14622 @item @code{attach}
14623 @tab @code{vAttach}
14624 @tab @code{attach}
14625
14626 @item @code{verbose-resume}
14627 @tab @code{vCont}
14628 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
14629
14630 @item @code{run}
14631 @tab @code{vRun}
14632 @tab @code{run}
14633
14634 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
14635 @tab @code{Z0}
14636 @tab @code{break}
14637
14638 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
14639 @tab @code{Z1}
14640 @tab @code{hbreak}
14641
14642 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
14643 @tab @code{Z2}
14644 @tab @code{watch}
14645
14646 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
14647 @tab @code{Z3}
14648 @tab @code{rwatch}
14649
14650 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
14651 @tab @code{Z4}
14652 @tab @code{awatch}
14653
14654 @item @code{target-features}
14655 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
14656 @tab @code{set architecture}
14657
14658 @item @code{library-info}
14659 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
14660 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
14661
14662 @item @code{memory-map}
14663 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
14664 @tab @code{info mem}
14665
14666 @item @code{read-spu-object}
14667 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
14668 @tab @code{info spu}
14669
14670 @item @code{write-spu-object}
14671 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
14672 @tab @code{info spu}
14673
14674 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
14675 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
14676 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
14677
14678 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
14679 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
14680 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
14681
14682 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
14683 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
14684 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
14685
14686 @item @code{search-memory}
14687 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
14688 @tab @code{find}
14689
14690 @item @code{supported-packets}
14691 @tab @code{qSupported}
14692 @tab Remote communications parameters
14693
14694 @item @code{pass-signals}
14695 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
14696 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
14697
14698 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
14699 @tab @code{vFile:close}
14700 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14701
14702 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
14703 @tab @code{vFile:open}
14704 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14705
14706 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
14707 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
14708 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14709
14710 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
14711 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
14712 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14713
14714 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
14715 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
14716 @tab @code{remote delete}
14717
14718 @item @code{noack-packet}
14719 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
14720 @tab Packet acknowledgment
14721
14722 @item @code{osdata}
14723 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
14724 @tab @code{info os}
14725
14726 @item @code{query-attached}
14727 @tab @code{qAttached}
14728 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
14729 @end multitable
14730
14731 @node Remote Stub
14732 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
14733
14734 @cindex debugging stub, example
14735 @cindex remote stub, example
14736 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
14737 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
14738 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
14739 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
14740 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
14741 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
14742 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
14743 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
14744
14745 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
14746 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
14747 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
14748 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
14749 program, you need:
14750
14751 @enumerate
14752 @item
14753 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
14754 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
14755 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
14756
14757 @item
14758 A C subroutine library to support your program's
14759 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
14760
14761 @item
14762 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
14763 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
14764 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
14765 documentation.
14766 @end enumerate
14767
14768 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
14769 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
14770 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
14771
14772 @table @emph
14773 @item On the host,
14774 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
14775 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
14776 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
14777
14778 @item On the target,
14779 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
14780 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
14781 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
14782
14783 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
14784 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
14785 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
14786 @end table
14787
14788 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
14789 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
14790 @sc{sparc} boards.
14791
14792 @cindex remote serial stub list
14793 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
14794
14795 @table @code
14796
14797 @item i386-stub.c
14798 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
14799 @cindex Intel
14800 @cindex i386
14801 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
14802
14803 @item m68k-stub.c
14804 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
14805 @cindex Motorola 680x0
14806 @cindex m680x0
14807 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
14808
14809 @item sh-stub.c
14810 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
14811 @cindex Renesas
14812 @cindex SH
14813 For Renesas SH architectures.
14814
14815 @item sparc-stub.c
14816 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
14817 @cindex Sparc
14818 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
14819
14820 @item sparcl-stub.c
14821 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
14822 @cindex Fujitsu
14823 @cindex SparcLite
14824 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
14825
14826 @end table
14827
14828 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
14829 recently added stubs.
14830
14831 @menu
14832 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
14833 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
14834 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
14835 @end menu
14836
14837 @node Stub Contents
14838 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
14839
14840 @cindex remote serial stub
14841 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
14842 subroutines:
14843
14844 @table @code
14845 @item set_debug_traps
14846 @findex set_debug_traps
14847 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
14848 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
14849 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
14850 beginning of your program.
14851
14852 @item handle_exception
14853 @findex handle_exception
14854 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
14855 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
14856 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
14857 run when a trap is triggered.
14858
14859 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
14860 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
14861 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
14862 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
14863 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
14864 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
14865 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
14866 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
14867 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
14868 machine.
14869
14870 @item breakpoint
14871 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
14872 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
14873 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
14874 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
14875 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
14876 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
14877 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
14878 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
14879 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
14880 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
14881 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
14882
14883 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
14884 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
14885 start of your debugging session.
14886 @end table
14887
14888 @node Bootstrapping
14889 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
14890
14891 @cindex remote stub, support routines
14892 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
14893 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
14894 debugging target machine.
14895
14896 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
14897 serial port.
14898
14899 @table @code
14900 @item int getDebugChar()
14901 @findex getDebugChar
14902 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
14903 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
14904 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14905
14906 @item void putDebugChar(int)
14907 @findex putDebugChar
14908 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
14909 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
14910 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14911 @end table
14912
14913 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
14914 @cindex interrupting remote targets
14915 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
14916 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
14917 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
14918 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
14919 remote system to stop.
14920
14921 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
14922 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
14923 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
14924 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
14925
14926 Other routines you need to supply are:
14927
14928 @table @code
14929 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
14930 @findex exceptionHandler
14931 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
14932 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
14933 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
14934 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
14935 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
14936 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
14937 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
14938 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
14939 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
14940 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
14941 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
14942 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
14943 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
14944
14945 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
14946 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
14947 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
14948 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
14949 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
14950
14951 @item void flush_i_cache()
14952 @findex flush_i_cache
14953 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
14954 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
14955 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
14956
14957 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
14958 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
14959 @end table
14960
14961 @noindent
14962 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
14963
14964 @table @code
14965 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
14966 @findex memset
14967 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
14968 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
14969 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
14970 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
14971 @end table
14972
14973 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
14974 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
14975 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
14976 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
14977
14978
14979 @node Debug Session
14980 @subsection Putting it All Together
14981
14982 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
14983 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
14984 steps.
14985
14986 @enumerate
14987 @item
14988 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
14989 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
14990 @display
14991 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
14992 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
14993 @end display
14994
14995 @item
14996 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
14997
14998 @smallexample
14999 set_debug_traps();
15000 breakpoint();
15001 @end smallexample
15002
15003 @item
15004 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
15005 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
15006
15007 @smallexample
15008 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
15009 @end smallexample
15010
15011 @noindent
15012 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
15013 function in your program, that function is called when
15014 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
15015 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
15016 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
15017
15018 @item
15019 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
15020 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
15021
15022 @item
15023 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
15024 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
15025
15026 @item
15027 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
15028 @c document that. FIXME.
15029 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
15030 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
15031
15032 @item
15033 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
15034 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
15035
15036 @end enumerate
15037
15038 @node Configurations
15039 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
15040
15041 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
15042 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
15043 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
15044
15045 There are three major categories of configurations: native
15046 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
15047 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
15048 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
15049 are quite different from each other.
15050
15051 @menu
15052 * Native::
15053 * Embedded OS::
15054 * Embedded Processors::
15055 * Architectures::
15056 @end menu
15057
15058 @node Native
15059 @section Native
15060
15061 This section describes details specific to particular native
15062 configurations.
15063
15064 @menu
15065 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
15066 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
15067 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
15068 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
15069 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
15070 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
15071 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
15072 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
15073 @end menu
15074
15075 @node HP-UX
15076 @subsection HP-UX
15077
15078 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
15079 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
15080 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
15081
15082
15083 @node BSD libkvm Interface
15084 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
15085
15086 @cindex libkvm
15087 @cindex kernel memory image
15088 @cindex kernel crash dump
15089
15090 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
15091 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
15092 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
15093 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
15094 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
15095 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
15096 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
15097 @code{kvm} target:
15098
15099 @smallexample
15100 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
15101 @end smallexample
15102
15103 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
15104 argument:
15105
15106 @smallexample
15107 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
15108 @end smallexample
15109
15110 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
15111 available:
15112
15113 @table @code
15114 @kindex kvm
15115 @item kvm pcb
15116 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
15117
15118 @item kvm proc
15119 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
15120 modern FreeBSD systems.
15121 @end table
15122
15123 @node SVR4 Process Information
15124 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
15125 @cindex /proc
15126 @cindex examine process image
15127 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
15128
15129 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
15130 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
15131 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
15132 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
15133 proc} is available to report information about the process running
15134 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
15135 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
15136 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
15137 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
15138
15139 @table @code
15140 @kindex info proc
15141 @cindex process ID
15142 @item info proc
15143 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
15144 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
15145 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
15146 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
15147 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
15148 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
15149 executable file's absolute file name.
15150
15151 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
15152 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
15153 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
15154 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
15155 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
15156 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
15157
15158 @item info proc mappings
15159 @cindex memory address space mappings
15160 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
15161 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
15162 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
15163 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
15164 memory access rights to that range.
15165
15166 @item info proc stat
15167 @itemx info proc status
15168 @cindex process detailed status information
15169 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
15170 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
15171 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
15172 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
15173 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
15174 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
15175 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
15176
15177 @item info proc all
15178 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
15179 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
15180
15181 @ignore
15182 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
15183 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
15184 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
15185 @kindex info proc times
15186 @item info proc times
15187 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
15188 its children.
15189
15190 @kindex info proc id
15191 @item info proc id
15192 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
15193 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
15194 @end ignore
15195
15196 @item set procfs-trace
15197 @kindex set procfs-trace
15198 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
15199 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
15200
15201 @item show procfs-trace
15202 @kindex show procfs-trace
15203 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
15204
15205 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
15206 @kindex set procfs-file
15207 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
15208 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
15209 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
15210 standard output.
15211
15212 @item show procfs-file
15213 @kindex show procfs-file
15214 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
15215
15216 @item proc-trace-entry
15217 @itemx proc-trace-exit
15218 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
15219 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
15220 @kindex proc-trace-entry
15221 @kindex proc-trace-exit
15222 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
15223 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
15224 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
15225 from the @code{syscall} interface.
15226
15227 @item info pidlist
15228 @kindex info pidlist
15229 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
15230 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
15231 processes and all the threads within each process.
15232
15233 @item info meminfo
15234 @kindex info meminfo
15235 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
15236 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
15237 @end table
15238
15239 @node DJGPP Native
15240 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
15241 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
15242 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
15243 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
15244
15245 @cindex DPMI
15246 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
15247 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
15248 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
15249 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
15250
15251 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
15252 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
15253 subsection describes those commands.
15254
15255 @table @code
15256 @kindex info dos
15257 @item info dos
15258 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
15259 information about the target system and important OS structures.
15260
15261 @kindex sysinfo
15262 @cindex MS-DOS system info
15263 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
15264 @item info dos sysinfo
15265 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
15266 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
15267 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
15268
15269 @cindex GDT
15270 @cindex LDT
15271 @cindex IDT
15272 @cindex segment descriptor tables
15273 @cindex descriptor tables display
15274 @item info dos gdt
15275 @itemx info dos ldt
15276 @itemx info dos idt
15277 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
15278 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
15279 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
15280 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
15281 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
15282 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
15283 rights.
15284
15285 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
15286 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
15287 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
15288 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
15289 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
15290
15291 @cindex garbled pointers
15292 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
15293 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
15294 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
15295 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
15296 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
15297 debugged program's data segment:
15298
15299 @smallexample
15300 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
15301 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
15302 @end smallexample
15303
15304 @noindent
15305 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
15306 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
15307
15308 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
15309 @item info dos pde
15310 @itemx info dos pte
15311 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
15312 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
15313 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
15314 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
15315 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
15316 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
15317 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
15318 that is currently in use.
15319
15320 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
15321 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
15322 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
15323 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
15324 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
15325 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
15326 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
15327
15328 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
15329 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
15330 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
15331 controller.
15332
15333 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
15334
15335 @cindex physical address from linear address
15336 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
15337 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
15338 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
15339 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
15340 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
15341 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
15342 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
15343
15344 @smallexample
15345 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
15346 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
15347 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
15348 @end smallexample
15349
15350 @noindent
15351 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
15352 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
15353 attributes of that page.
15354
15355 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
15356 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
15357 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
15358 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
15359 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
15360 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
15361
15362 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
15363 transfer buffer:
15364
15365 @smallexample
15366 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
15367 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
15368 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
15369 @end smallexample
15370
15371 @noindent
15372 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
15373 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
15374 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
15375 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
15376 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
15377
15378 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
15379 @end table
15380
15381 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
15382 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
15383 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
15384 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
15385
15386 @table @code
15387 @kindex set com1base
15388 @kindex set com1irq
15389 @kindex set com2base
15390 @kindex set com2irq
15391 @kindex set com3base
15392 @kindex set com3irq
15393 @kindex set com4base
15394 @kindex set com4irq
15395 @item set com1base @var{addr}
15396 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
15397 port.
15398
15399 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
15400 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
15401 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
15402
15403 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
15404 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
15405 other 3 COM ports.
15406
15407 @kindex show com1base
15408 @kindex show com1irq
15409 @kindex show com2base
15410 @kindex show com2irq
15411 @kindex show com3base
15412 @kindex show com3irq
15413 @kindex show com4base
15414 @kindex show com4irq
15415 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
15416 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
15417 lines used by the COM ports.
15418
15419 @item info serial
15420 @kindex info serial
15421 @cindex DOS serial port status
15422 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
15423 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
15424 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
15425 counts of various errors encountered so far.
15426 @end table
15427
15428
15429 @node Cygwin Native
15430 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
15431 @cindex MS Windows debugging
15432 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
15433 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
15434
15435 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
15436 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
15437 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
15438 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
15439 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
15440
15441 @table @code
15442 @kindex info w32
15443 @item info w32
15444 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
15445 information about the target system and important OS structures.
15446
15447 @item info w32 selector
15448 This command displays information returned by
15449 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
15450 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
15451 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
15452 Without argument, this command displays information
15453 about the six segment registers.
15454
15455 @kindex info dll
15456 @item info dll
15457 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
15458
15459 @kindex dll-symbols
15460 @item dll-symbols
15461 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
15462 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
15463
15464 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
15465 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
15466 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
15467 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
15468 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
15469 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
15470 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
15471 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
15472 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
15473 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
15474 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
15475
15476 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
15477 @item show cygwin-exceptions
15478 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
15479 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
15480
15481 @kindex set new-console
15482 @item set new-console @var{mode}
15483 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
15484 be started in a new console on next start.
15485 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
15486 be started in the same console as the debugger.
15487
15488 @kindex show new-console
15489 @item show new-console
15490 Displays whether a new console is used
15491 when the debuggee is started.
15492
15493 @kindex set new-group
15494 @item set new-group @var{mode}
15495 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
15496 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
15497 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
15498 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
15499
15500 @kindex show new-group
15501 @item show new-group
15502 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
15503
15504 @kindex set debugevents
15505 @item set debugevents
15506 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
15507 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
15508 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
15509 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
15510 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
15511
15512 @kindex set debugexec
15513 @item set debugexec
15514 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
15515 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
15516
15517 @kindex set debugexceptions
15518 @item set debugexceptions
15519 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
15520 debuggee seen by the debugger.
15521
15522 @kindex set debugmemory
15523 @item set debugmemory
15524 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
15525 and writes by the debugger.
15526
15527 @kindex set shell
15528 @item set shell
15529 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
15530 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
15531
15532 @kindex show shell
15533 @item show shell
15534 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
15535
15536 @end table
15537
15538 @menu
15539 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
15540 @end menu
15541
15542 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
15543 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
15544 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
15545 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
15546
15547 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
15548 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
15549 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
15550 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
15551 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
15552 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
15553 ``minimal symbols''.
15554
15555 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
15556 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
15557 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
15558 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
15559 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
15560 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
15561 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
15562 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
15563 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
15564 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
15565
15566 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
15567
15568 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
15569 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
15570 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
15571 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
15572 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
15573 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
15574 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
15575 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
15576 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
15577
15578 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
15579 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
15580 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
15581 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
15582 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
15583 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
15584
15585 @smallexample
15586 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
15587 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
15588
15589 Non-debugging symbols:
15590 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
15591 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
15592 @end smallexample
15593
15594 @smallexample
15595 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
15596 All functions matching regular expression "!":
15597
15598 Non-debugging symbols:
15599 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
15600 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
15601 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
15602 [etc...]
15603 @end smallexample
15604
15605 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
15606
15607 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
15608 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
15609 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
15610 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
15611 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
15612 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
15613 a function within a DLL without a running program.
15614
15615 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
15616 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
15617 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
15618 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
15619 problem:
15620
15621 @smallexample
15622 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
15623 $1 = 268572168
15624 @end smallexample
15625
15626 @smallexample
15627 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
15628 0x10021610: "\230y\""
15629 @end smallexample
15630
15631 And two possible solutions:
15632
15633 @smallexample
15634 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
15635 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
15636 @end smallexample
15637
15638 @smallexample
15639 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
15640 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
15641 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
15642 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
15643 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
15644 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
15645 @end smallexample
15646
15647 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
15648 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
15649 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
15650 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
15651 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
15652
15653 @smallexample
15654 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
15655 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
15656 @end smallexample
15657
15658 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
15659 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
15660 safe.
15661
15662 @node Hurd Native
15663 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
15664 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
15665
15666 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
15667 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
15668
15669 @table @code
15670 @item set signals
15671 @itemx set sigs
15672 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
15673 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
15674 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
15675 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
15676 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
15677 @code{signals}.
15678
15679 @item show signals
15680 @itemx show sigs
15681 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
15682 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
15683 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
15684
15685 @item set signal-thread
15686 @itemx set sigthread
15687 @kindex set signal-thread
15688 @kindex set sigthread
15689 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
15690 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
15691 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
15692 signal-thread}.
15693
15694 @item show signal-thread
15695 @itemx show sigthread
15696 @kindex show signal-thread
15697 @kindex show sigthread
15698 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
15699 delivered a signal.
15700
15701 @item set stopped
15702 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
15703 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
15704 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
15705 continued by delivering a signal to it.
15706
15707 @item show stopped
15708 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
15709 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
15710 stopped.
15711
15712 @item set exceptions
15713 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
15714 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
15715 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
15716 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
15717 trapping on.
15718
15719 @item show exceptions
15720 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
15721 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
15722
15723 @item set task pause
15724 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
15725 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15726 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15727 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
15728 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
15729 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
15730 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
15731 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
15732 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
15733
15734 @item show task pause
15735 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
15736 Show the current state of task suspension.
15737
15738 @item set task detach-suspend-count
15739 @cindex task suspend count
15740 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15741 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
15742 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
15743
15744 @item show task detach-suspend-count
15745 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
15746
15747 @item set task exception-port
15748 @itemx set task excp
15749 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15750 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
15751 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
15752 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
15753
15754 @item set noninvasive
15755 @cindex noninvasive task options
15756 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
15757 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
15758 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
15759 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
15760
15761 @item info send-rights
15762 @itemx info receive-rights
15763 @itemx info port-rights
15764 @itemx info port-sets
15765 @itemx info dead-names
15766 @itemx info ports
15767 @itemx info psets
15768 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15769 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15770 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15771 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15772 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15773 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
15774 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
15775 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
15776 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
15777
15778 @item set thread pause
15779 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
15780 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15781 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15782 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
15783 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
15784 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
15785 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
15786 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
15787 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
15788 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
15789 only the current thread.
15790
15791 @item show thread pause
15792 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
15793 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
15794
15795 @item set thread run
15796 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15797
15798 @item show thread run
15799 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15800
15801 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
15802 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15803 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15804 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
15805 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
15806 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
15807 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
15808
15809 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
15810 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
15811 detaching.
15812
15813 @item set thread exception-port
15814 @itemx set thread excp
15815 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
15816 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
15817 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
15818
15819 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
15820 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
15821 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
15822 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
15823
15824 @item set thread default
15825 @itemx show thread default
15826 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15827 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
15828 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
15829 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
15830 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
15831 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
15832 the non-default commands.
15833 @end table
15834
15835
15836 @node Neutrino
15837 @subsection QNX Neutrino
15838 @cindex QNX Neutrino
15839
15840 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
15841 Neutrino target:
15842
15843 @table @code
15844 @item set debug nto-debug
15845 @kindex set debug nto-debug
15846 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
15847 Neutrino support.
15848
15849 @item show debug nto-debug
15850 @kindex show debug nto-debug
15851 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
15852 @end table
15853
15854 @node Darwin
15855 @subsection Darwin
15856 @cindex Darwin
15857
15858 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
15859
15860 @table @code
15861 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
15862 @kindex set debug darwin
15863 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
15864 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
15865
15866 @item show debug darwin
15867 @kindex show debug darwin
15868 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
15869
15870 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
15871 @kindex set debug mach-o
15872 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
15873 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
15874 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
15875 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
15876 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
15877 usage.
15878
15879 @item show debug mach-o
15880 @kindex show debug mach-o
15881 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
15882
15883 @item set mach-exceptions on
15884 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
15885 @kindex set mach-exceptions
15886 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
15887 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
15888 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
15889 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
15890
15891 @item show mach-exceptions
15892 @kindex show mach-exceptions
15893 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
15894 @end table
15895
15896
15897 @node Embedded OS
15898 @section Embedded Operating Systems
15899
15900 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
15901 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
15902 architectures.
15903
15904 @menu
15905 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15906 @end menu
15907
15908 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
15909 various real-time operating systems.
15910
15911 @node VxWorks
15912 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15913
15914 @cindex VxWorks
15915
15916 @table @code
15917
15918 @kindex target vxworks
15919 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
15920 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
15921 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
15922
15923 @end table
15924
15925 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
15926 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
15927
15928 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
15929 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
15930 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15931 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
15932 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
15933 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
15934 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
15935
15936 @table @code
15937 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
15938 @kindex vxworks-timeout
15939 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
15940 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15941 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
15942 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
15943 of a thin network line.
15944 @end table
15945
15946 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
15947 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
15948 procedures.
15949
15950 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
15951 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
15952 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
15953 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
15954 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
15955 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
15956 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
15957 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
15958 manual.
15959 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
15960
15961 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
15962 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15963 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
15964 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
15965
15966 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15967
15968 @smallexample
15969 (vxgdb)
15970 @end smallexample
15971
15972 @menu
15973 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
15974 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
15975 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
15976 @end menu
15977
15978 @node VxWorks Connection
15979 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
15980
15981 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
15982 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
15983
15984 @smallexample
15985 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
15986 @end smallexample
15987
15988 @need 750
15989 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15990
15991 @smallexample
15992 Attaching remote machine across net...
15993 Connected to tt.
15994 @end smallexample
15995
15996 @need 1000
15997 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
15998 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
15999 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
16000 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
16001 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
16002
16003 @smallexample
16004 prog.o: No such file or directory.
16005 @end smallexample
16006
16007 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
16008 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
16009 command again.
16010
16011 @node VxWorks Download
16012 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
16013
16014 @cindex download to VxWorks
16015 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
16016 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
16017 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
16018 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
16019 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
16020 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
16021 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
16022 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
16023 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
16024 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
16025 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
16026 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
16027 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
16028 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
16029 program, type this on VxWorks:
16030
16031 @smallexample
16032 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
16033 @end smallexample
16034
16035 @noindent
16036 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
16037
16038 @smallexample
16039 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
16040 (vxgdb) load prog.o
16041 @end smallexample
16042
16043 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
16044
16045 @smallexample
16046 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
16047 @end smallexample
16048
16049 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
16050 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
16051 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
16052 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
16053 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
16054 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
16055 table.)
16056
16057 @node VxWorks Attach
16058 @subsubsection Running Tasks
16059
16060 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
16061 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
16062 follows:
16063
16064 @smallexample
16065 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
16066 @end smallexample
16067
16068 @noindent
16069 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
16070 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
16071 the time of attachment.
16072
16073 @node Embedded Processors
16074 @section Embedded Processors
16075
16076 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
16077 configurations.
16078
16079 @cindex send command to simulator
16080 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
16081 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
16082
16083 @table @code
16084 @item sim @var{command}
16085 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
16086 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
16087 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
16088 acceptable commands.
16089 @end table
16090
16091
16092 @menu
16093 * ARM:: ARM RDI
16094 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
16095 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
16096 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
16097 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
16098 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
16099 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
16100 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
16101 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
16102 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
16103 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
16104 * CRIS:: CRIS
16105 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
16106 @end menu
16107
16108 @node ARM
16109 @subsection ARM
16110 @cindex ARM RDI
16111
16112 @table @code
16113 @kindex target rdi
16114 @item target rdi @var{dev}
16115 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
16116 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
16117 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
16118
16119 @kindex target rdp
16120 @item target rdp @var{dev}
16121 ARM Demon monitor.
16122
16123 @end table
16124
16125 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
16126
16127 @table @code
16128 @item set arm disassembler
16129 @kindex set arm
16130 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
16131 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
16132
16133 @item show arm disassembler
16134 @kindex show arm
16135 Show the current disassembly style.
16136
16137 @item set arm apcs32
16138 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
16139 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
16140
16141 @item show arm apcs32
16142 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
16143
16144 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
16145 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
16146 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
16147
16148 @table @code
16149 @item auto
16150 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
16151 @item softfpa
16152 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
16153 processors.
16154 @item fpa
16155 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
16156 @item softvfp
16157 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
16158 @item vfp
16159 VFP co-processor.
16160 @end table
16161
16162 @item show arm fpu
16163 Show the current type of the FPU.
16164
16165 @item set arm abi
16166 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
16167
16168 @item show arm abi
16169 Show the currently used ABI.
16170
16171 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
16172 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
16173 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
16174 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
16175 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
16176 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
16177 register).
16178
16179 @item show arm fallback-mode
16180 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
16181
16182 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
16183 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
16184 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
16185 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
16186 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
16187
16188 @item show arm force-mode
16189 Show the current forced instruction mode.
16190
16191 @item set debug arm
16192 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
16193 target support subsystem.
16194
16195 @item show debug arm
16196 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
16197 @end table
16198
16199 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
16200 using the RDI interface:
16201
16202 @table @code
16203 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
16204 @kindex rdilogfile
16205 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
16206 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
16207 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
16208 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
16209 @file{rdi.log}.
16210
16211 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
16212 @kindex rdilogenable
16213 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
16214 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
16215 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
16216 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
16217 are logged to a file.
16218
16219 @item set rdiromatzero
16220 @kindex set rdiromatzero
16221 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
16222 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
16223 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
16224 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
16225 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
16226
16227 @item show rdiromatzero
16228 @kindex show rdiromatzero
16229 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
16230
16231 @item set rdiheartbeat
16232 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
16233 @cindex RDI heartbeat
16234 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
16235 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
16236 well as the Angel monitor.
16237
16238 @item show rdiheartbeat
16239 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
16240 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
16241 @end table
16242
16243
16244 @node M32R/D
16245 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
16246
16247 @table @code
16248 @kindex target m32r
16249 @item target m32r @var{dev}
16250 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
16251
16252 @kindex target m32rsdi
16253 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
16254 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
16255 @end table
16256
16257 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
16258
16259 @table @code
16260 @item set download-path @var{path}
16261 @kindex set download-path
16262 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
16263 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
16264
16265 @item show download-path
16266 @kindex show download-path
16267 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
16268
16269 @item set board-address @var{addr}
16270 @kindex set board-address
16271 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
16272 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
16273
16274 @item show board-address
16275 @kindex show board-address
16276 Show the current IP address of the target board.
16277
16278 @item set server-address @var{addr}
16279 @kindex set server-address
16280 @cindex download server address (M32R)
16281 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
16282 host machine.
16283
16284 @item show server-address
16285 @kindex show server-address
16286 Display the IP address of the download server.
16287
16288 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
16289 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
16290 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
16291 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
16292 executable file is uploaded.
16293
16294 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
16295 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
16296 Test the @code{upload} command.
16297 @end table
16298
16299 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
16300
16301 @table @code
16302 @item sdireset
16303 @kindex sdireset
16304 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
16305 This command resets the SDI connection.
16306
16307 @item sdistatus
16308 @kindex sdistatus
16309 This command shows the SDI connection status.
16310
16311 @item debug_chaos
16312 @kindex debug_chaos
16313 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
16314 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
16315
16316 @item use_debug_dma
16317 @kindex use_debug_dma
16318 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
16319
16320 @item use_mon_code
16321 @kindex use_mon_code
16322 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
16323
16324 @item use_ib_break
16325 @kindex use_ib_break
16326 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
16327
16328 @item use_dbt_break
16329 @kindex use_dbt_break
16330 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
16331 @end table
16332
16333 @node M68K
16334 @subsection M68k
16335
16336 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
16337 target command for the following ROM monitor.
16338
16339 @table @code
16340
16341 @kindex target dbug
16342 @item target dbug @var{dev}
16343 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
16344
16345 @end table
16346
16347 @node MIPS Embedded
16348 @subsection MIPS Embedded
16349
16350 @cindex MIPS boards
16351 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
16352 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
16353 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
16354
16355 @need 1000
16356 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
16357
16358 @table @code
16359 @item target mips @var{port}
16360 @kindex target mips @var{port}
16361 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
16362 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
16363 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
16364 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
16365 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
16366 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
16367
16368 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
16369 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
16370 debugger:
16371
16372 @smallexample
16373 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
16374 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
16375 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
16376 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
16377 (@value{GDBP}) run
16378 @end smallexample
16379
16380 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
16381 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
16382 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
16383 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
16384 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
16385
16386 @item target pmon @var{port}
16387 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
16388 PMON ROM monitor.
16389
16390 @item target ddb @var{port}
16391 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
16392 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
16393
16394 @item target lsi @var{port}
16395 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
16396 LSI variant of PMON.
16397
16398 @kindex target r3900
16399 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
16400 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
16401
16402 @kindex target array
16403 @item target array @var{dev}
16404 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
16405
16406 @end table
16407
16408
16409 @noindent
16410 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
16411
16412 @table @code
16413 @item set mipsfpu double
16414 @itemx set mipsfpu single
16415 @itemx set mipsfpu none
16416 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
16417 @itemx show mipsfpu
16418 @kindex set mipsfpu
16419 @kindex show mipsfpu
16420 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
16421 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
16422 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
16423 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
16424 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
16425 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
16426 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
16427 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
16428 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
16429 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
16430 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
16431 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
16432 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
16433
16434 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
16435 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
16436 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
16437
16438 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
16439 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
16440
16441 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
16442 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
16443 @itemx show timeout
16444 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
16445 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
16446 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
16447 @kindex set timeout
16448 @kindex show timeout
16449 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
16450 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
16451 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
16452 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
16453 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
16454 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
16455 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
16456 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
16457 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
16458 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
16459
16460 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
16461 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
16462 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
16463 to run before stopping.
16464
16465 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
16466 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
16467 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
16468 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
16469 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
16470 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
16471
16472 @item show syn-garbage-limit
16473 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
16474 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
16475 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
16476
16477 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
16478 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
16479 @cindex remote monitor prompt
16480 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
16481 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
16482 @table @asis
16483 @item pmon target
16484 @samp{PMON}
16485 @item ddb target
16486 @samp{NEC010}
16487 @item lsi target
16488 @samp{PMON>}
16489 @end table
16490
16491 @item show monitor-prompt
16492 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
16493 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
16494 remote monitor.
16495
16496 @item set monitor-warnings
16497 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
16498 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
16499 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
16500 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
16501 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
16502
16503 @item show monitor-warnings
16504 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
16505 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
16506
16507 @item pmon @var{command}
16508 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
16509 @cindex send PMON command
16510 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
16511 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
16512 @end table
16513
16514 @node OpenRISC 1000
16515 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
16516 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
16517
16518 @cindex or1k boards
16519 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
16520 about platform and commands.
16521
16522 @table @code
16523
16524 @kindex target jtag
16525 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
16526
16527 Connects to remote JTAG server.
16528 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
16529 connected via parallel port to the board.
16530
16531 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
16532
16533 @kindex or1ksim
16534 @item or1ksim @var{command}
16535 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
16536 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
16537
16538 @kindex info or1k spr
16539 @item info or1k spr
16540 Displays spr groups.
16541
16542 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
16543 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
16544 Displays register names in selected group.
16545
16546 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
16547 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
16548 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
16549 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
16550 Shows information about specified spr register.
16551
16552 @kindex spr
16553 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
16554 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
16555 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
16556 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
16557 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
16558 @end table
16559
16560 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
16561 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
16562 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
16563 triggers can be set using:
16564 @table @code
16565 @item $LEA/$LDATA
16566 Load effective address/data
16567 @item $SEA/$SDATA
16568 Store effective address/data
16569 @item $AEA/$ADATA
16570 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
16571 @item $FETCH
16572 Fetch data
16573 @end table
16574
16575 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
16576 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
16577
16578 @code{htrace} commands:
16579 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
16580 @table @code
16581 @kindex hwatch
16582 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
16583 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
16584 or Data. For example:
16585
16586 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
16587
16588 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
16589
16590 @kindex htrace
16591 @item htrace info
16592 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
16593
16594 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
16595 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
16596
16597 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
16598 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
16599
16600 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
16601 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
16602
16603 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
16604 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
16605 triggered.
16606
16607 @item htrace enable
16608 @itemx htrace disable
16609 Enables/disables the HW trace.
16610
16611 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
16612 Clears currently recorded trace data.
16613
16614 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
16615 will be written there.
16616
16617 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
16618 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
16619
16620 @item htrace mode continuous
16621 Set continuous trace mode.
16622
16623 @item htrace mode suspend
16624 Set suspend trace mode.
16625
16626 @end table
16627
16628 @node PowerPC Embedded
16629 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
16630
16631 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
16632
16633 @table @code
16634 @kindex set powerpc
16635 @item set powerpc soft-float
16636 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
16637 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
16638 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
16639 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
16640
16641 @item set powerpc vector-abi
16642 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
16643 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
16644 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
16645 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
16646 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
16647 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
16648 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
16649
16650 @kindex target dink32
16651 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
16652 DINK32 ROM monitor.
16653
16654 @kindex target ppcbug
16655 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
16656 @kindex target ppcbug1
16657 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
16658 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
16659
16660 @kindex target sds
16661 @item target sds @var{dev}
16662 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
16663 @end table
16664
16665 @cindex SDS protocol
16666 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
16667 by @value{GDBN}:
16668
16669 @table @code
16670 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
16671 @kindex set sdstimeout
16672 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
16673 default is 2 seconds.
16674
16675 @item show sdstimeout
16676 @kindex show sdstimeout
16677 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
16678
16679 @item sds @var{command}
16680 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
16681 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
16682 @end table
16683
16684
16685 @node PA
16686 @subsection HP PA Embedded
16687
16688 @table @code
16689
16690 @kindex target op50n
16691 @item target op50n @var{dev}
16692 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
16693
16694 @kindex target w89k
16695 @item target w89k @var{dev}
16696 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
16697
16698 @end table
16699
16700 @node Sparclet
16701 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
16702
16703 @cindex Sparclet
16704
16705 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
16706 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
16707 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
16708 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
16709 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
16710
16711 @table @code
16712 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
16713 @kindex remotetimeout
16714 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
16715 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
16716 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
16717 @end table
16718
16719 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
16720 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
16721 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
16722 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
16723 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
16724
16725 @smallexample
16726 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
16727 @end smallexample
16728
16729 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
16730
16731 @smallexample
16732 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
16733 @end smallexample
16734
16735 @cindex running, on Sparclet
16736 Once you have set
16737 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
16738 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
16739 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
16740
16741 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
16742
16743 @smallexample
16744 (gdbslet)
16745 @end smallexample
16746
16747 @menu
16748 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
16749 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
16750 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
16751 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
16752 @end menu
16753
16754 @node Sparclet File
16755 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
16756
16757 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
16758
16759 @smallexample
16760 (gdbslet) file prog
16761 @end smallexample
16762
16763 @need 1000
16764 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
16765 @value{GDBN} locates
16766 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
16767 path.
16768 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
16769 files will be searched as well.
16770 @value{GDBN} locates
16771 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
16772 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
16773 If it fails
16774 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
16775
16776 @smallexample
16777 prog: No such file or directory.
16778 @end smallexample
16779
16780 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
16781 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
16782 @code{target} command again.
16783
16784 @node Sparclet Connection
16785 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
16786
16787 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
16788 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
16789
16790 @smallexample
16791 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
16792 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
16793 main () at ../prog.c:3
16794 @end smallexample
16795
16796 @need 750
16797 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
16798
16799 @smallexample
16800 Connected to ttya.
16801 @end smallexample
16802
16803 @node Sparclet Download
16804 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
16805
16806 @cindex download to Sparclet
16807 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
16808 you can use the @value{GDBN}
16809 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
16810 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
16811 command.
16812 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
16813 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
16814 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
16815 of each of the file's sections.
16816 For instance, if the program
16817 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
16818 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
16819
16820 @smallexample
16821 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
16822 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
16823 @end smallexample
16824
16825 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
16826 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
16827 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
16828
16829 @node Sparclet Execution
16830 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
16831
16832 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
16833 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
16834 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
16835 manual for the list of commands.
16836
16837 @smallexample
16838 (gdbslet) b main
16839 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
16840 (gdbslet) run
16841 Starting program: prog
16842 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
16843 3 char *symarg = 0;
16844 (gdbslet) step
16845 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
16846 (gdbslet)
16847 @end smallexample
16848
16849 @node Sparclite
16850 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
16851
16852 @table @code
16853
16854 @kindex target sparclite
16855 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
16856 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
16857 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
16858 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
16859 remote protocol.
16860
16861 @end table
16862
16863 @node Z8000
16864 @subsection Zilog Z8000
16865
16866 @cindex Z8000
16867 @cindex simulator, Z8000
16868 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
16869
16870 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
16871 a Z8000 simulator.
16872
16873 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
16874 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
16875 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
16876 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
16877
16878 @table @code
16879 @item target sim @var{args}
16880 @kindex sim
16881 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
16882 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
16883 options, specify them via @var{args}.
16884 @end table
16885
16886 @noindent
16887 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
16888 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
16889 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
16890 to run your program, and so on.
16891
16892 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
16893 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
16894 additional items of information as specially named registers:
16895
16896 @table @code
16897
16898 @item cycles
16899 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
16900
16901 @item insts
16902 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
16903
16904 @item time
16905 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
16906
16907 @end table
16908
16909 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
16910 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
16911 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
16912 simulated clock ticks.
16913
16914 @node AVR
16915 @subsection Atmel AVR
16916 @cindex AVR
16917
16918 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
16919 following AVR-specific commands:
16920
16921 @table @code
16922 @item info io_registers
16923 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
16924 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
16925 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
16926 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
16927 @end table
16928
16929 @node CRIS
16930 @subsection CRIS
16931 @cindex CRIS
16932
16933 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
16934 following CRIS-specific commands:
16935
16936 @table @code
16937 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
16938 @cindex CRIS version
16939 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
16940 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
16941 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
16942
16943 @item show cris-version
16944 Show the current CRIS version.
16945
16946 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
16947 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
16948 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
16949 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
16950 @code{R59}.
16951
16952 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
16953 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
16954
16955 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
16956 @cindex CRIS mode
16957 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
16958 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
16959 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
16960
16961 @item show cris-mode
16962 Show the current CRIS mode.
16963 @end table
16964
16965 @node Super-H
16966 @subsection Renesas Super-H
16967 @cindex Super-H
16968
16969 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
16970 commands:
16971
16972 @table @code
16973 @item regs
16974 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
16975 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
16976
16977 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
16978 @kindex set sh calling-convention
16979 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
16980 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
16981 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
16982 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
16983 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
16984 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
16985 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
16986 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
16987 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
16988 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
16989
16990 @item show sh calling-convention
16991 @kindex show sh calling-convention
16992 Show the current calling convention setting.
16993
16994 @end table
16995
16996
16997 @node Architectures
16998 @section Architectures
16999
17000 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
17001 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
17002
17003 @menu
17004 * i386::
17005 * A29K::
17006 * Alpha::
17007 * MIPS::
17008 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
17009 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
17010 * PowerPC::
17011 @end menu
17012
17013 @node i386
17014 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
17015
17016 @table @code
17017 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
17018 @kindex set struct-convention
17019 @cindex struct return convention
17020 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
17021 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
17022 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
17023 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
17024 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
17025 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
17026 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
17027 be returned in a register.
17028
17029 @item show struct-convention
17030 @kindex show struct-convention
17031 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
17032 from functions.
17033 @end table
17034
17035 @node A29K
17036 @subsection A29K
17037
17038 @table @code
17039
17040 @kindex set rstack_high_address
17041 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
17042 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
17043 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
17044 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
17045 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
17046 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
17047 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
17048 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
17049 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
17050 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
17051 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
17052 hexadecimal.
17053
17054 @kindex show rstack_high_address
17055 @item show rstack_high_address
17056 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
17057 processors.
17058
17059 @end table
17060
17061 @node Alpha
17062 @subsection Alpha
17063
17064 See the following section.
17065
17066 @node MIPS
17067 @subsection MIPS
17068
17069 @cindex stack on Alpha
17070 @cindex stack on MIPS
17071 @cindex Alpha stack
17072 @cindex MIPS stack
17073 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
17074 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
17075 find the beginning of a function.
17076
17077 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
17078 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
17079 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
17080 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
17081 commands:
17082
17083 @table @code
17084 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
17085 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
17086 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
17087 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
17088 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
17089 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
17090 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
17091 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
17092
17093 @item show heuristic-fence-post
17094 Display the current limit.
17095 @end table
17096
17097 @noindent
17098 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
17099 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
17100
17101 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
17102 programs:
17103
17104 @table @code
17105 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
17106 @kindex set mips abi
17107 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
17108 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
17109 values of @var{arg} are:
17110
17111 @table @samp
17112 @item auto
17113 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
17114 default).
17115 @item o32
17116 @item o64
17117 @item n32
17118 @item n64
17119 @item eabi32
17120 @item eabi64
17121 @item auto
17122 @end table
17123
17124 @item show mips abi
17125 @kindex show mips abi
17126 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
17127
17128 @item set mipsfpu
17129 @itemx show mipsfpu
17130 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
17131
17132 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
17133 @kindex set mips mask-address
17134 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
17135 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
17136 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
17137 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
17138 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
17139
17140 @item show mips mask-address
17141 @kindex show mips mask-address
17142 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
17143 not.
17144
17145 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17146 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17147 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
17148 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
17149 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
17150 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
17151
17152 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17153 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
17154 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
17155
17156 @item set debug mips
17157 @kindex set debug mips
17158 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
17159 target code in @value{GDBN}.
17160
17161 @item show debug mips
17162 @kindex show debug mips
17163 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
17164 @end table
17165
17166
17167 @node HPPA
17168 @subsection HPPA
17169 @cindex HPPA support
17170
17171 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
17172 following special commands:
17173
17174 @table @code
17175 @item set debug hppa
17176 @kindex set debug hppa
17177 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
17178 messages are to be displayed.
17179
17180 @item show debug hppa
17181 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
17182
17183 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
17184 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
17185 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
17186 given @var{address}.
17187
17188 @end table
17189
17190
17191 @node SPU
17192 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
17193 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
17194 @cindex SPU
17195
17196 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
17197 it provides the following special commands:
17198
17199 @table @code
17200 @item info spu event
17201 @kindex info spu
17202 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
17203 and pending event status.
17204
17205 @item info spu signal
17206 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
17207 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
17208 notification channels.
17209
17210 @item info spu mailbox
17211 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
17212 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
17213 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
17214
17215 @item info spu dma
17216 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
17217 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
17218 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
17219
17220 @item info spu proxydma
17221 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
17222 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
17223 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
17224
17225 @end table
17226
17227 @node PowerPC
17228 @subsection PowerPC
17229 @cindex PowerPC architecture
17230
17231 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
17232 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
17233 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
17234 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
17235 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
17236
17237 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
17238 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
17239 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
17240
17241 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
17242 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
17243
17244
17245 @node Controlling GDB
17246 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
17247
17248 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
17249 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
17250 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
17251 described here.
17252
17253 @menu
17254 * Prompt:: Prompt
17255 * Editing:: Command editing
17256 * Command History:: Command history
17257 * Screen Size:: Screen size
17258 * Numbers:: Numbers
17259 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
17260 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
17261 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
17262 @end menu
17263
17264 @node Prompt
17265 @section Prompt
17266
17267 @cindex prompt
17268
17269 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
17270 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
17271 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
17272 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
17273 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
17274 which one you are talking to.
17275
17276 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
17277 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
17278 or a prompt that does not.
17279
17280 @table @code
17281 @kindex set prompt
17282 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
17283 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
17284
17285 @kindex show prompt
17286 @item show prompt
17287 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
17288 @end table
17289
17290 @node Editing
17291 @section Command Editing
17292 @cindex readline
17293 @cindex command line editing
17294
17295 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
17296 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
17297 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
17298 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
17299 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
17300 debugging sessions.
17301
17302 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
17303 command @code{set}.
17304
17305 @table @code
17306 @kindex set editing
17307 @cindex editing
17308 @item set editing
17309 @itemx set editing on
17310 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
17311
17312 @item set editing off
17313 Disable command line editing.
17314
17315 @kindex show editing
17316 @item show editing
17317 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
17318 @end table
17319
17320 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
17321 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
17322 encouraged to read that chapter.
17323
17324 @node Command History
17325 @section Command History
17326 @cindex command history
17327
17328 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
17329 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
17330 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
17331 history facility.
17332
17333 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
17334 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
17335 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
17336
17337 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
17338 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
17339 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
17340 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
17341 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
17342 pressed on a line by itself.
17343
17344 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
17345 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
17346 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
17347 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
17348
17349 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
17350 history.
17351
17352 @table @code
17353 @cindex history substitution
17354 @cindex history file
17355 @kindex set history filename
17356 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
17357 @item set history filename @var{fname}
17358 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
17359 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
17360 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
17361 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
17362 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
17363 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
17364 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
17365 is not set.
17366
17367 @cindex save command history
17368 @kindex set history save
17369 @item set history save
17370 @itemx set history save on
17371 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
17372 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
17373
17374 @item set history save off
17375 Stop recording command history in a file.
17376
17377 @cindex history size
17378 @kindex set history size
17379 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
17380 @item set history size @var{size}
17381 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
17382 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
17383 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
17384 @end table
17385
17386 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
17387 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
17388
17389 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
17390 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
17391 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
17392 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
17393 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
17394 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
17395 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
17396 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
17397
17398 The commands to control history expansion are:
17399
17400 @table @code
17401 @item set history expansion on
17402 @itemx set history expansion
17403 @kindex set history expansion
17404 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
17405
17406 @item set history expansion off
17407 Disable history expansion.
17408
17409 @c @group
17410 @kindex show history
17411 @item show history
17412 @itemx show history filename
17413 @itemx show history save
17414 @itemx show history size
17415 @itemx show history expansion
17416 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
17417 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
17418 @c @end group
17419 @end table
17420
17421 @table @code
17422 @kindex show commands
17423 @cindex show last commands
17424 @cindex display command history
17425 @item show commands
17426 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
17427
17428 @item show commands @var{n}
17429 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
17430
17431 @item show commands +
17432 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
17433 @end table
17434
17435 @node Screen Size
17436 @section Screen Size
17437 @cindex size of screen
17438 @cindex pauses in output
17439
17440 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
17441 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
17442 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
17443 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
17444 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
17445 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
17446 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
17447 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
17448
17449 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
17450 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
17451 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
17452 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
17453 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
17454 width} commands:
17455
17456 @table @code
17457 @kindex set height
17458 @kindex set width
17459 @kindex show width
17460 @kindex show height
17461 @item set height @var{lpp}
17462 @itemx show height
17463 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
17464 @itemx show width
17465 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
17466 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
17467 commands display the current settings.
17468
17469 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
17470 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
17471 file or to an editor buffer.
17472
17473 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
17474 from wrapping its output.
17475
17476 @item set pagination on
17477 @itemx set pagination off
17478 @kindex set pagination
17479 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
17480 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
17481
17482 @item show pagination
17483 @kindex show pagination
17484 Show the current pagination mode.
17485 @end table
17486
17487 @node Numbers
17488 @section Numbers
17489 @cindex number representation
17490 @cindex entering numbers
17491
17492 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
17493 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
17494 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
17495 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
17496 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
17497 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
17498 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
17499 both input and output with the commands described below.
17500
17501 @table @code
17502 @kindex set input-radix
17503 @item set input-radix @var{base}
17504 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
17505 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
17506 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
17507 example, any of
17508
17509 @smallexample
17510 set input-radix 012
17511 set input-radix 10.
17512 set input-radix 0xa
17513 @end smallexample
17514
17515 @noindent
17516 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
17517 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
17518 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
17519 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
17520 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
17521 change the radix.
17522
17523 @kindex set output-radix
17524 @item set output-radix @var{base}
17525 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
17526 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
17527 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
17528
17529 @kindex show input-radix
17530 @item show input-radix
17531 Display the current default base for numeric input.
17532
17533 @kindex show output-radix
17534 @item show output-radix
17535 Display the current default base for numeric display.
17536
17537 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
17538 @itemx show radix
17539 @kindex set radix
17540 @kindex show radix
17541 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
17542 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
17543 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
17544 default value of 10.
17545
17546 @end table
17547
17548 @node ABI
17549 @section Configuring the Current ABI
17550
17551 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
17552 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
17553 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
17554 current ABI.
17555
17556 @cindex OS ABI
17557 @kindex set osabi
17558 @kindex show osabi
17559
17560 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
17561 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
17562 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
17563 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
17564 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
17565 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
17566 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
17567 platform provides.
17568
17569 @table @code
17570 @item show osabi
17571 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
17572
17573 @item set osabi
17574 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
17575
17576 @item set osabi @var{abi}
17577 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
17578 @end table
17579
17580 @cindex float promotion
17581
17582 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
17583 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
17584 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
17585 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
17586 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
17587 @code{double} and then passed.
17588
17589 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
17590 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
17591 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
17592
17593 @table @code
17594 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
17595 @item set coerce-float-to-double
17596 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
17597 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
17598 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
17599
17600 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
17601 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
17602 functions.
17603
17604 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
17605 @item show coerce-float-to-double
17606 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
17607 @end table
17608
17609 @kindex set cp-abi
17610 @kindex show cp-abi
17611 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
17612 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
17613 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
17614 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
17615 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
17616 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
17617 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
17618 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
17619 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
17620 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
17621 ``auto''.
17622
17623 @table @code
17624 @item show cp-abi
17625 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
17626
17627 @item set cp-abi
17628 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
17629
17630 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
17631 @itemx set cp-abi auto
17632 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
17633 @end table
17634
17635 @node Messages/Warnings
17636 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
17637
17638 @cindex verbose operation
17639 @cindex optional warnings
17640 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
17641 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
17642 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
17643 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
17644
17645 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
17646 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
17647 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17648
17649 @table @code
17650 @kindex set verbose
17651 @item set verbose on
17652 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
17653
17654 @item set verbose off
17655 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
17656
17657 @kindex show verbose
17658 @item show verbose
17659 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
17660 @end table
17661
17662 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
17663 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
17664 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
17665 Symbol Files}).
17666
17667 @table @code
17668
17669 @kindex set complaints
17670 @item set complaints @var{limit}
17671 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
17672 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
17673 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
17674 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
17675
17676 @kindex show complaints
17677 @item show complaints
17678 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
17679
17680 @end table
17681
17682 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
17683 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
17684 you try to run a program which is already running:
17685
17686 @smallexample
17687 (@value{GDBP}) run
17688 The program being debugged has been started already.
17689 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
17690 @end smallexample
17691
17692 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
17693 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
17694
17695 @table @code
17696
17697 @kindex set confirm
17698 @cindex flinching
17699 @cindex confirmation
17700 @cindex stupid questions
17701 @item set confirm off
17702 Disables confirmation requests.
17703
17704 @item set confirm on
17705 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
17706
17707 @kindex show confirm
17708 @item show confirm
17709 Displays state of confirmation requests.
17710
17711 @end table
17712
17713 @cindex command tracing
17714 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
17715 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
17716 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
17717 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
17718
17719 @table @code
17720 @kindex set trace-commands
17721 @cindex command scripts, debugging
17722 @item set trace-commands on
17723 Enable command tracing.
17724 @item set trace-commands off
17725 Disable command tracing.
17726 @item show trace-commands
17727 Display the current state of command tracing.
17728 @end table
17729
17730 @node Debugging Output
17731 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
17732 @cindex optional debugging messages
17733
17734 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
17735 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
17736 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
17737 section documents those commands.
17738
17739 @table @code
17740 @kindex set exec-done-display
17741 @item set exec-done-display
17742 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
17743 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
17744 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
17745 @kindex show exec-done-display
17746 @item show exec-done-display
17747 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
17748 notification.
17749 @kindex set debug
17750 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
17751 @cindex architecture debugging info
17752 @item set debug arch
17753 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
17754 @kindex show debug
17755 @item show debug arch
17756 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
17757 @item set debug aix-thread
17758 @cindex AIX threads
17759 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
17760 module.
17761 @item show debug aix-thread
17762 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
17763 @item set debug dwarf2-die
17764 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
17765 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
17766 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
17767 A value of zero turns off the display.
17768 @item show debug dwarf2-die
17769 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
17770 @item set debug displaced
17771 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
17772 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
17773 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
17774 @item show debug displaced
17775 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
17776 related to displaced stepping.
17777 @item set debug event
17778 @cindex event debugging info
17779 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
17780 default is off.
17781 @item show debug event
17782 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
17783 info.
17784 @item set debug expression
17785 @cindex expression debugging info
17786 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
17787 expression parsing. The default is off.
17788 @item show debug expression
17789 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
17790 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
17791 @item set debug frame
17792 @cindex frame debugging info
17793 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
17794 default is off.
17795 @item show debug frame
17796 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
17797 info.
17798 @item set debug infrun
17799 @cindex inferior debugging info
17800 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
17801 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
17802 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
17803 @item show debug infrun
17804 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
17805 @item set debug lin-lwp
17806 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
17807 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
17808 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
17809 @item show debug lin-lwp
17810 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
17811 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
17812 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
17813 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
17814 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
17815 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
17816 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
17817 @item set debug observer
17818 @cindex observer debugging info
17819 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
17820 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
17821 @item show debug observer
17822 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
17823 @item set debug overload
17824 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
17825 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
17826 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
17827 is off.
17828 @item show debug overload
17829 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
17830 debugging info.
17831 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
17832 @cindex serial connections, debugging
17833 @cindex debug remote protocol
17834 @cindex remote protocol debugging
17835 @cindex display remote packets
17836 @item set debug remote
17837 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
17838 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
17839 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
17840 @item show debug remote
17841 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
17842 @item set debug serial
17843 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
17844 default is off.
17845 @item show debug serial
17846 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
17847 info.
17848 @item set debug solib-frv
17849 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
17850 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
17851 @item show debug solib-frv
17852 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
17853 messages.
17854 @item set debug target
17855 @cindex target debugging info
17856 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
17857 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
17858 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
17859 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
17860 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
17861 @item show debug target
17862 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
17863 info.
17864 @item set debug timestamp
17865 @cindex timestampping debugging info
17866 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
17867 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
17868 message.
17869 @item show debug timestamp
17870 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
17871 debugging info.
17872 @item set debugvarobj
17873 @cindex variable object debugging info
17874 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
17875 info. The default is off.
17876 @item show debugvarobj
17877 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
17878 debugging info.
17879 @item set debug xml
17880 @cindex XML parser debugging
17881 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
17882 @item show debug xml
17883 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
17884 @end table
17885
17886 @node Extending GDB
17887 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
17888 @cindex extending GDB
17889
17890 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
17891 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
17892 Python scripting language.
17893
17894 @menu
17895 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
17896 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
17897 @end menu
17898
17899 @node Sequences
17900 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
17901
17902 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
17903 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
17904 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
17905 files.
17906
17907 @menu
17908 * Define:: How to define your own commands
17909 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
17910 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
17911 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
17912 @end menu
17913
17914 @node Define
17915 @subsection User-defined Commands
17916
17917 @cindex user-defined command
17918 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
17919 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
17920 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
17921 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
17922 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
17923 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
17924
17925 @smallexample
17926 define adder
17927 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17928 end
17929 @end smallexample
17930
17931 @noindent
17932 To execute the command use:
17933
17934 @smallexample
17935 adder 1 2 3
17936 @end smallexample
17937
17938 @noindent
17939 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
17940 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
17941 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
17942 functions calls.
17943
17944 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
17945 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
17946 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
17947 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
17948
17949 @smallexample
17950 define adder
17951 if $argc == 2
17952 print $arg0 + $arg1
17953 end
17954 if $argc == 3
17955 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17956 end
17957 end
17958 @end smallexample
17959
17960 @table @code
17961
17962 @kindex define
17963 @item define @var{commandname}
17964 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
17965 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
17966 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
17967 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
17968 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
17969 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
17970
17971 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
17972 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
17973 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17974
17975 @kindex document
17976 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
17977 @item document @var{commandname}
17978 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
17979 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
17980 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
17981 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
17982 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
17983 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
17984
17985 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
17986 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
17987 does not change the documentation.
17988
17989 @kindex dont-repeat
17990 @cindex don't repeat command
17991 @item dont-repeat
17992 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
17993 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
17994 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
17995
17996 @kindex help user-defined
17997 @item help user-defined
17998 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
17999 (if any) for each.
18000
18001 @kindex show user
18002 @item show user
18003 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
18004 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
18005 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
18006 definitions for all user-defined commands.
18007
18008 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
18009 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
18010 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
18011 @item show max-user-call-depth
18012 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
18013 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
18014 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
18015 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
18016 @end table
18017
18018 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
18019 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
18020
18021 When user-defined commands are executed, the
18022 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
18023 stops execution of the user-defined command.
18024
18025 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
18026 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
18027 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
18028 messages when used in a user-defined command.
18029
18030 @node Hooks
18031 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
18032 @cindex command hooks
18033 @cindex hooks, for commands
18034 @cindex hooks, pre-command
18035
18036 @kindex hook
18037 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
18038 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
18039 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
18040 before that command.
18041
18042 @cindex hooks, post-command
18043 @kindex hookpost
18044 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
18045 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
18046 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
18047 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
18048 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
18049
18050 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
18051 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
18052
18053 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
18054 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
18055
18056 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
18057 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
18058 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
18059 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
18060 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
18061
18062 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
18063 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
18064 you could define:
18065
18066 @smallexample
18067 define hook-stop
18068 handle SIGALRM nopass
18069 end
18070
18071 define hook-run
18072 handle SIGALRM pass
18073 end
18074
18075 define hook-continue
18076 handle SIGALRM pass
18077 end
18078 @end smallexample
18079
18080 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
18081 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
18082 you could define:
18083
18084 @smallexample
18085 define hook-echo
18086 echo <<<---
18087 end
18088
18089 define hookpost-echo
18090 echo --->>>\n
18091 end
18092
18093 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
18094 <<<---Hello World--->>>
18095 (@value{GDBP})
18096
18097 @end smallexample
18098
18099 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
18100 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
18101 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
18102 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
18103 @c or not?
18104 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
18105 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
18106 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
18107
18108 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
18109 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
18110 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
18111
18112 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
18113 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
18114
18115 @node Command Files
18116 @subsection Command Files
18117
18118 @cindex command files
18119 @cindex scripting commands
18120 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
18121 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
18122 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
18123 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
18124 terminal.
18125
18126 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
18127 command:
18128
18129 @table @code
18130 @kindex source
18131 @cindex execute commands from a file
18132 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
18133 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
18134 @end table
18135
18136 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
18137 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
18138 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
18139 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
18140 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
18141
18142 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
18143 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
18144
18145 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
18146 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
18147 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
18148
18149 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
18150 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
18151 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
18152 when called from command files.
18153
18154 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
18155 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
18156 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
18157 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
18158 the next command.
18159
18160 @smallexample
18161 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
18162 @end smallexample
18163
18164 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
18165 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
18166 would be directed to @file{log}.
18167
18168 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
18169 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
18170 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
18171 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
18172 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
18173 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
18174 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
18175 conditionally, etc.
18176
18177 @table @code
18178 @kindex if
18179 @kindex else
18180 @item if
18181 @itemx else
18182 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
18183 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
18184 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
18185 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
18186 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
18187 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
18188 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
18189
18190 @kindex while
18191 @item while
18192 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
18193 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
18194 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
18195 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
18196 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
18197 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
18198
18199 @kindex loop_break
18200 @item loop_break
18201 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
18202 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
18203 line.
18204
18205 @kindex loop_continue
18206 @item loop_continue
18207 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
18208 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
18209 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
18210 the controlling expression.
18211
18212 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
18213 @item end
18214 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
18215 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
18216 @end table
18217
18218
18219 @node Output
18220 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
18221
18222 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
18223 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
18224 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
18225 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
18226 want.
18227
18228 @table @code
18229 @kindex echo
18230 @item echo @var{text}
18231 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
18232 @c because it is not in ANSI.
18233 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
18234 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
18235 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
18236 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
18237 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
18238 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
18239 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
18240 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
18241 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
18242
18243 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
18244 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
18245
18246 @smallexample
18247 echo This is some text\n\
18248 which is continued\n\
18249 onto several lines.\n
18250 @end smallexample
18251
18252 produces the same output as
18253
18254 @smallexample
18255 echo This is some text\n
18256 echo which is continued\n
18257 echo onto several lines.\n
18258 @end smallexample
18259
18260 @kindex output
18261 @item output @var{expression}
18262 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
18263 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
18264 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
18265 on expressions.
18266
18267 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
18268 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
18269 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
18270 Formats}, for more information.
18271
18272 @kindex printf
18273 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
18274 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
18275 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
18276 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
18277 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
18278 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
18279 executing the code below:
18280
18281 @smallexample
18282 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
18283 @end smallexample
18284
18285 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
18286 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
18287 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
18288 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
18289 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
18290 printed.
18291
18292 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
18293
18294 @smallexample
18295 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
18296 @end smallexample
18297
18298 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
18299 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
18300 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
18301
18302 @itemize @bullet
18303 @item
18304 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
18305
18306 @item
18307 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
18308 width.
18309
18310 @item
18311 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
18312 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
18313
18314 @item
18315 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
18316 supported.
18317
18318 @item
18319 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
18320
18321 @item
18322 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
18323 @end itemize
18324
18325 @noindent
18326 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
18327 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
18328 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
18329 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
18330
18331 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
18332 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
18333 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
18334 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
18335 supported.
18336
18337 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
18338 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
18339 together with a floating point specifier.
18340 letters:
18341
18342 @itemize @bullet
18343 @item
18344 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
18345
18346 @item
18347 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
18348
18349 @item
18350 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
18351 @end itemize
18352
18353 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
18354 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
18355 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
18356
18357 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
18358 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
18359
18360 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
18361 @smallexample
18362 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
18363 @end smallexample
18364
18365 @end table
18366
18367 @node Python
18368 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
18369 @cindex python scripting
18370 @cindex scripting with python
18371
18372 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
18373 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
18374 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
18375
18376 @menu
18377 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
18378 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
18379 @end menu
18380
18381 @node Python Commands
18382 @subsection Python Commands
18383 @cindex python commands
18384 @cindex commands to access python
18385
18386 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
18387 and one related setting:
18388
18389 @table @code
18390 @kindex python
18391 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
18392 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
18393
18394 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
18395 argument as a Python command. For example:
18396
18397 @smallexample
18398 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
18399 23
18400 @end smallexample
18401
18402 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
18403 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
18404 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
18405 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
18406 containing @code{end}. For example:
18407
18408 @smallexample
18409 (@value{GDBP}) python
18410 Type python script
18411 End with a line saying just "end".
18412 >print 23
18413 >end
18414 23
18415 @end smallexample
18416
18417 @kindex maint set python print-stack
18418 @item maint set python print-stack
18419 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
18420 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
18421 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
18422 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
18423 disabled.
18424 @end table
18425
18426 @node Python API
18427 @subsection Python API
18428 @cindex python api
18429 @cindex programming in python
18430
18431 @cindex python stdout
18432 @cindex python pagination
18433 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
18434 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
18435 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
18436 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
18437 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
18438
18439 @menu
18440 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
18441 * Exception Handling::
18442 * Values From Inferior::
18443 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
18444 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
18445 * Frames In Python:: Acessing inferior stack frames from Python.
18446 @end menu
18447
18448 @node Basic Python
18449 @subsubsection Basic Python
18450
18451 @cindex python functions
18452 @cindex python module
18453 @cindex gdb module
18454 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
18455 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
18456 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
18457 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
18458
18459 @findex gdb.execute
18460 @defun execute command [from_tty]
18461 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
18462 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
18463 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
18464 If no exceptions occur, this function returns @code{None}.
18465
18466 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
18467 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
18468 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
18469 @end defun
18470
18471 @findex gdb.get_parameter
18472 @defun get_parameter parameter
18473 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
18474 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
18475 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
18476 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
18477
18478 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
18479 @code{RuntimeError}. Otherwise, the parameter's value is converted to
18480 a Python value of the appropriate type, and returned.
18481 @end defun
18482
18483 @findex gdb.history
18484 @defun history number
18485 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
18486 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
18487 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
18488 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
18489 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
18490 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
18491 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{RuntimeError} exception will be
18492 raised.
18493
18494 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
18495 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
18496 @end defun
18497
18498 @findex gdb.write
18499 @defun write string
18500 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
18501 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
18502 call this function.
18503 @end defun
18504
18505 @findex gdb.flush
18506 @defun flush
18507 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
18508 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
18509 function.
18510 @end defun
18511
18512 @node Exception Handling
18513 @subsubsection Exception Handling
18514 @cindex python exceptions
18515 @cindex exceptions, python
18516
18517 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
18518 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
18519 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
18520 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
18521 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
18522 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
18523 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
18524
18525 @smallexample
18526 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
18527 Traceback (most recent call last):
18528 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
18529 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
18530 @end smallexample
18531
18532 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by Python
18533 code are converted to Python @code{RuntimeError} exceptions. User
18534 interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
18535 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt}
18536 exception. If you catch these exceptions in your Python code, your
18537 exception handler will see @code{RuntimeError} or
18538 @code{KeyboardInterrupt} as the exception type, the @value{GDBN} error
18539 message as its value, and the Python call stack backtrace at the
18540 Python statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
18541 traceback.
18542
18543 @node Values From Inferior
18544 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
18545 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
18546 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
18547
18548 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
18549 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
18550 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
18551 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
18552 fetching values when necessary.
18553
18554 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
18555 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
18556 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
18557
18558 @smallexample
18559 bar = some_val + 2
18560 @end smallexample
18561
18562 @noindent
18563 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
18564 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
18565
18566 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
18567 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
18568 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
18569 can access its @code{foo} element with:
18570
18571 @smallexample
18572 bar = some_val['foo']
18573 @end smallexample
18574
18575 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
18576
18577 The following attributes are provided:
18578
18579 @table @code
18580 @defmethod Value address
18581 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
18582 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
18583 this attribute holds @code{None}.
18584 @end defmethod
18585
18586 @cindex optimized out value in Python
18587 @defmethod Value is_optimized_out
18588 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
18589 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
18590 @end defmethod
18591 @end table
18592
18593 The following methods are provided:
18594
18595 @table @code
18596 @defmethod Value dereference
18597 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
18598 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
18599 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
18600
18601 @smallexample
18602 int *foo;
18603 @end smallexample
18604
18605 @noindent
18606 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
18607 @code{foo} points to like this:
18608
18609 @smallexample
18610 bar = foo.dereference ()
18611 @end smallexample
18612
18613 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
18614 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
18615 @end defmethod
18616
18617 @defmethod Value string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}errors@r{]}
18618 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
18619 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
18620 throw an exception.
18621
18622 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
18623 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
18624 language.
18625
18626 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
18627 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
18628 by a zero of the appropriate width.
18629
18630 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
18631 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
18632 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
18633 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
18634 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
18635 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
18636 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
18637 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
18638 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
18639
18640 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
18641 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
18642 @end defmethod
18643 @end table
18644
18645 @node Commands In Python
18646 @subsubsection Commands In Python
18647
18648 @cindex commands in python
18649 @cindex python commands
18650 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
18651 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
18652 class, most commonly using a subclass.
18653
18654 @defmethod Command __init__ name @var{command_class} @r{[}@var{completer_class}@r{]} @r{[}@var{prefix}@r{]}
18655 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
18656 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
18657 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
18658
18659 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
18660 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
18661 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
18662 an exception is raised.
18663
18664 There is no support for multi-line commands.
18665
18666 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
18667 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
18668 new command in the help system.
18669
18670 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
18671 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
18672 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
18673 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
18674 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
18675 error will occur when completion is attempted.
18676
18677 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
18678 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
18679 registered.
18680
18681 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
18682 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
18683 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
18684 not documented.'' is used.
18685 @end defmethod
18686
18687 @cindex don't repeat Python command
18688 @defmethod Command dont_repeat
18689 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
18690 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
18691 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
18692 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
18693 @end defmethod
18694
18695 @defmethod Command invoke argument from_tty
18696 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
18697
18698 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
18699 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
18700
18701 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
18702 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
18703 that the command came from elsewhere.
18704
18705 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
18706 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
18707 @end defmethod
18708
18709 @cindex completion of Python commands
18710 @defmethod Command complete text word
18711 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
18712 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
18713 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
18714 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
18715 complete}).
18716
18717 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
18718 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
18719 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
18720 using a word-breaking heuristic.
18721
18722 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
18723 @itemize @bullet
18724 @item
18725 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
18726 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
18727 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
18728 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
18729 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
18730 sequence are ignored.
18731
18732 @item
18733 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
18734 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
18735 function is invoked, and its result is used.
18736
18737 @item
18738 All other results are treated as though there were no available
18739 completions.
18740 @end itemize
18741 @end defmethod
18742
18743 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
18744 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
18745 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
18746 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
18747 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
18748 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
18749
18750 @table @code
18751 @findex COMMAND_NONE
18752 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
18753 @item COMMAND_NONE
18754 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
18755 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
18756
18757 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
18758 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
18759 @item COMMAND_RUNNING
18760 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
18761 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
18762 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18763 commands in this category.
18764
18765 @findex COMMAND_DATA
18766 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
18767 @item COMMAND_DATA
18768 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
18769 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
18770 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
18771 in this category.
18772
18773 @findex COMMAND_STACK
18774 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
18775 @item COMMAND_STACK
18776 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
18777 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
18778 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
18779 list of commands in this category.
18780
18781 @findex COMMAND_FILES
18782 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
18783 @item COMMAND_FILES
18784 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
18785 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
18786 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18787 commands in this category.
18788
18789 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
18790 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
18791 @item COMMAND_SUPPORT
18792 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
18793 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
18794 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
18795 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
18796 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18797 commands in this category.
18798
18799 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
18800 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
18801 @item COMMAND_STATUS
18802 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
18803 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
18804 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
18805 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
18806
18807 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
18808 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
18809 @item COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
18810 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
18811 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
18812 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
18813 this category.
18814
18815 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
18816 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
18817 @item COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
18818 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
18819 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
18820 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18821 commands in this category.
18822
18823 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
18824 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
18825 @item COMMAND_OBSCURE
18826 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
18827 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
18828 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
18829 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
18830 category.
18831
18832 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
18833 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
18834 @item COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
18835 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
18836 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
18837 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18838 commands in this category.
18839 @end table
18840
18841 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
18842 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
18843 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
18844 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
18845
18846 @table @code
18847 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
18848 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
18849 @item COMPLETE_NONE
18850 This constant means that no completion should be done.
18851
18852 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
18853 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
18854 @item COMPLETE_FILENAME
18855 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
18856
18857 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
18858 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
18859 @item COMPLETE_LOCATION
18860 This constant means that location completion should be done.
18861 @xref{Specify Location}.
18862
18863 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
18864 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
18865 @item COMPLETE_COMMAND
18866 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
18867 command names.
18868
18869 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
18870 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
18871 @item COMPLETE_SYMBOL
18872 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
18873 as the source.
18874 @end table
18875
18876 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
18877 implemented in Python:
18878
18879 @smallexample
18880 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
18881 """Greet the whole world."""
18882
18883 def __init__ (self):
18884 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
18885
18886 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
18887 print "Hello, World!"
18888
18889 HelloWorld ()
18890 @end smallexample
18891
18892 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
18893 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
18894 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
18895 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
18896
18897 @node Functions In Python
18898 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
18899
18900 @cindex writing convenience functions
18901 @cindex convenience functions in python
18902 @cindex python convenience functions
18903 @tindex gdb.Function
18904 @tindex Function
18905 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
18906 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
18907 class @code{gdb.Function}.
18908
18909 @defmethod Function __init__ name
18910 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
18911 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
18912 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
18913 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
18914 the given @var{name}.
18915
18916 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
18917 string for the new class.
18918 @end defmethod
18919
18920 @defmethod Function invoke @var{*args}
18921 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
18922 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
18923 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
18924 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
18925 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
18926 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
18927 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
18928
18929 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
18930 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
18931 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
18932 @end defmethod
18933
18934 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
18935 be implemented in Python:
18936
18937 @smallexample
18938 class Greet (gdb.Function):
18939 """Return string to greet someone.
18940 Takes a name as argument."""
18941
18942 def __init__ (self):
18943 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
18944
18945 def invoke (self, name):
18946 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
18947
18948 Greet ()
18949 @end smallexample
18950
18951 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
18952 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
18953 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
18954 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
18955
18956 @node Frames In Python
18957 @subsubsection Acessing inferior stack frames from Python.
18958
18959 @cindex frames in python
18960 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
18961 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
18962 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
18963 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
18964 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{RuntimeError}
18965 exception.
18966
18967 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
18968 operator, like:
18969
18970 @smallexample
18971 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
18972 True
18973 @end smallexample
18974
18975 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
18976
18977 @findex gdb.selected_frame
18978 @defun selected_frame
18979 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
18980 @end defun
18981
18982 @defun frame_stop_reason_string reason
18983 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
18984 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
18985 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
18986 @end defun
18987
18988 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
18989
18990 @table @code
18991 @defmethod Frame is_valid
18992 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
18993 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
18994 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
18995 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
18996 @end defmethod
18997
18998 @defmethod Frame name
18999 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
19000 obtained.
19001 @end defmethod
19002
19003 @defmethod Frame type
19004 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of
19005 @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, @code{gdb.DUMMY_FRAME}, @code{gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME}
19006 or @code{gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME}.
19007 @end defmethod
19008
19009 @defmethod Frame unwind_stop_reason
19010 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
19011 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
19012 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
19013 function to a string.
19014 @end defmethod
19015
19016 @defmethod Frame pc
19017 Returns the frame's resume address.
19018 @end defmethod
19019
19020 @defmethod Frame older
19021 Return the frame that called this frame.
19022 @end defmethod
19023
19024 @defmethod Frame newer
19025 Return the frame called by this frame.
19026 @end defmethod
19027
19028 @defmethod Frame read_var variable
19029 Return the value of the given variable in this frame. @var{variable} must
19030 be a string.
19031 @end defmethod
19032 @end table
19033
19034 @node Interpreters
19035 @chapter Command Interpreters
19036 @cindex command interpreters
19037
19038 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
19039 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
19040 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
19041
19042 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
19043 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
19044 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
19045 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
19046
19047 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
19048 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
19049 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
19050 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
19051
19052 @table @code
19053 @item console
19054 @cindex console interpreter
19055 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
19056 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
19057 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
19058
19059 @item mi
19060 @cindex mi interpreter
19061 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
19062 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
19063 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
19064 Interface}.
19065
19066 @item mi2
19067 @cindex mi2 interpreter
19068 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
19069
19070 @item mi1
19071 @cindex mi1 interpreter
19072 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
19073
19074 @end table
19075
19076 @cindex invoke another interpreter
19077 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
19078 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
19079 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
19080 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
19081 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
19082 the IDE inoperable!
19083
19084 @kindex interpreter-exec
19085 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
19086 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
19087 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
19088 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
19089
19090 @smallexample
19091 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
19092 @end smallexample
19093
19094 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
19095 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
19096
19097 @node TUI
19098 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
19099 @cindex TUI
19100 @cindex Text User Interface
19101
19102 @menu
19103 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
19104 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
19105 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
19106 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
19107 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
19108 @end menu
19109
19110 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
19111 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
19112 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
19113 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
19114 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
19115 is available.
19116
19117 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
19118 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
19119 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
19120 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
19121 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
19122 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
19123
19124 @node TUI Overview
19125 @section TUI Overview
19126
19127 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
19128
19129 @table @emph
19130 @item command
19131 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
19132 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
19133 managed using readline.
19134
19135 @item source
19136 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
19137 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
19138
19139 @item assembly
19140 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
19141
19142 @item register
19143 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
19144 when their values change.
19145 @end table
19146
19147 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
19148 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
19149 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
19150 indicates the breakpoint type:
19151
19152 @table @code
19153 @item B
19154 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
19155
19156 @item b
19157 Breakpoint which was never hit.
19158
19159 @item H
19160 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
19161
19162 @item h
19163 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
19164 @end table
19165
19166 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
19167
19168 @table @code
19169 @item +
19170 Breakpoint is enabled.
19171
19172 @item -
19173 Breakpoint is disabled.
19174 @end table
19175
19176 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
19177 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
19178 changes.
19179
19180 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
19181 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
19182 layouts:
19183
19184 @itemize @bullet
19185 @item
19186 source only,
19187
19188 @item
19189 assembly only,
19190
19191 @item
19192 source and assembly,
19193
19194 @item
19195 source and registers, or
19196
19197 @item
19198 assembly and registers.
19199 @end itemize
19200
19201 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
19202
19203 @table @emph
19204 @item target
19205 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
19206 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19207
19208 @item process
19209 Gives the current process or thread number.
19210 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
19211
19212 @item function
19213 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
19214 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
19215 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
19216 the string @code{??} is displayed.
19217
19218 @item line
19219 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
19220 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
19221
19222 @item pc
19223 Indicates the current program counter address.
19224 @end table
19225
19226 @node TUI Keys
19227 @section TUI Key Bindings
19228 @cindex TUI key bindings
19229
19230 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
19231 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
19232 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
19233
19234 @table @kbd
19235 @kindex C-x C-a
19236 @item C-x C-a
19237 @kindex C-x a
19238 @itemx C-x a
19239 @kindex C-x A
19240 @itemx C-x A
19241 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
19242 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
19243 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
19244 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
19245 The screen is then refreshed.
19246
19247 @kindex C-x 1
19248 @item C-x 1
19249 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
19250 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
19251 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
19252
19253 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
19254
19255 @kindex C-x 2
19256 @item C-x 2
19257 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
19258 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
19259 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
19260 previous layout and the new one.
19261
19262 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
19263
19264 @kindex C-x o
19265 @item C-x o
19266 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
19267 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
19268 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
19269
19270 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
19271
19272 @kindex C-x s
19273 @item C-x s
19274 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
19275 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
19276 @end table
19277
19278 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
19279
19280 @table @asis
19281 @kindex PgUp
19282 @item @key{PgUp}
19283 Scroll the active window one page up.
19284
19285 @kindex PgDn
19286 @item @key{PgDn}
19287 Scroll the active window one page down.
19288
19289 @kindex Up
19290 @item @key{Up}
19291 Scroll the active window one line up.
19292
19293 @kindex Down
19294 @item @key{Down}
19295 Scroll the active window one line down.
19296
19297 @kindex Left
19298 @item @key{Left}
19299 Scroll the active window one column left.
19300
19301 @kindex Right
19302 @item @key{Right}
19303 Scroll the active window one column right.
19304
19305 @kindex C-L
19306 @item @kbd{C-L}
19307 Refresh the screen.
19308 @end table
19309
19310 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
19311 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
19312 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
19313 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
19314 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
19315
19316 @node TUI Single Key Mode
19317 @section TUI Single Key Mode
19318 @cindex TUI single key mode
19319
19320 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
19321 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
19322 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
19323
19324 @table @kbd
19325 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19326 @item c
19327 continue
19328
19329 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19330 @item d
19331 down
19332
19333 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19334 @item f
19335 finish
19336
19337 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19338 @item n
19339 next
19340
19341 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19342 @item q
19343 exit the SingleKey mode.
19344
19345 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19346 @item r
19347 run
19348
19349 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19350 @item s
19351 step
19352
19353 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19354 @item u
19355 up
19356
19357 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19358 @item v
19359 info locals
19360
19361 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
19362 @item w
19363 where
19364 @end table
19365
19366 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
19367 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
19368 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
19369 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
19370 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
19371 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
19372
19373
19374 @node TUI Commands
19375 @section TUI-specific Commands
19376 @cindex TUI commands
19377
19378 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
19379 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
19380 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
19381 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
19382
19383 @table @code
19384 @item info win
19385 @kindex info win
19386 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
19387
19388 @item layout next
19389 @kindex layout
19390 Display the next layout.
19391
19392 @item layout prev
19393 Display the previous layout.
19394
19395 @item layout src
19396 Display the source window only.
19397
19398 @item layout asm
19399 Display the assembly window only.
19400
19401 @item layout split
19402 Display the source and assembly window.
19403
19404 @item layout regs
19405 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
19406
19407 @item focus next
19408 @kindex focus
19409 Make the next window active for scrolling.
19410
19411 @item focus prev
19412 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
19413
19414 @item focus src
19415 Make the source window active for scrolling.
19416
19417 @item focus asm
19418 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
19419
19420 @item focus regs
19421 Make the register window active for scrolling.
19422
19423 @item focus cmd
19424 Make the command window active for scrolling.
19425
19426 @item refresh
19427 @kindex refresh
19428 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
19429
19430 @item tui reg float
19431 @kindex tui reg
19432 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
19433
19434 @item tui reg general
19435 Show the general registers in the register window.
19436
19437 @item tui reg next
19438 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
19439 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
19440 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
19441 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
19442
19443 @item tui reg system
19444 Show the system registers in the register window.
19445
19446 @item update
19447 @kindex update
19448 Update the source window and the current execution point.
19449
19450 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
19451 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
19452 @kindex winheight
19453 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
19454 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
19455 decrease it.
19456
19457 @item tabset @var{nchars}
19458 @kindex tabset
19459 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
19460 @end table
19461
19462 @node TUI Configuration
19463 @section TUI Configuration Variables
19464 @cindex TUI configuration variables
19465
19466 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
19467
19468 @table @code
19469 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
19470 @kindex set tui border-kind
19471 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
19472 The possible values are the following:
19473 @table @code
19474 @item space
19475 Use a space character to draw the border.
19476
19477 @item ascii
19478 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
19479
19480 @item acs
19481 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
19482 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
19483 @end table
19484
19485 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
19486 @kindex set tui border-mode
19487 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
19488 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
19489 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
19490 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
19491 @table @code
19492 @item normal
19493 Use normal attributes to display the border.
19494
19495 @item standout
19496 Use standout mode.
19497
19498 @item reverse
19499 Use reverse video mode.
19500
19501 @item half
19502 Use half bright mode.
19503
19504 @item half-standout
19505 Use half bright and standout mode.
19506
19507 @item bold
19508 Use extra bright or bold mode.
19509
19510 @item bold-standout
19511 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
19512 @end table
19513 @end table
19514
19515 @node Emacs
19516 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
19517
19518 @cindex Emacs
19519 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
19520 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
19521 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
19522 @value{GDBN}.
19523
19524 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
19525 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
19526 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
19527 created Emacs buffer.
19528 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
19529
19530 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
19531 things:
19532
19533 @itemize @bullet
19534 @item
19535 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
19536 the GUD buffer.
19537
19538 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
19539 and output done by the program you are debugging.
19540
19541 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
19542 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
19543 in this way.
19544
19545 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
19546 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
19547 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
19548 stop.
19549
19550 @item
19551 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
19552
19553 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
19554 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
19555 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
19556 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
19557 and the source.
19558
19559 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
19560 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
19561 @end itemize
19562
19563 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
19564 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
19565 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
19566 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
19567
19568 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
19569 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
19570 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
19571 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
19572 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
19573 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
19574 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
19575 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
19576 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
19577
19578 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
19579 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
19580 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
19581 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
19582
19583 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
19584 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
19585 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
19586 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
19587 one you want.
19588
19589 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
19590 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
19591
19592 @table @kbd
19593 @item C-h m
19594 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
19595
19596 @item C-c C-s
19597 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
19598 update the display window to show the current file and location.
19599
19600 @item C-c C-n
19601 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
19602 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
19603 to show the current file and location.
19604
19605 @item C-c C-i
19606 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
19607 display window accordingly.
19608
19609 @item C-c C-f
19610 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
19611 @code{finish} command.
19612
19613 @item C-c C-r
19614 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
19615 command.
19616
19617 @item C-c <
19618 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
19619 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
19620 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
19621
19622 @item C-c >
19623 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
19624 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
19625 @end table
19626
19627 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
19628 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
19629
19630 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
19631 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
19632 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
19633 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
19634 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
19635 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
19636 speedbar displays watch expressions.
19637
19638 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
19639 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
19640 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
19641 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
19642 frame.
19643
19644 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
19645 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
19646 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
19647 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
19648 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
19649 to correspond properly with the code.
19650
19651 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
19652 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
19653 Emacs Manual}).
19654
19655 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
19656 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
19657 @ignore
19658 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
19659 @kindex Epoch
19660 @kindex inspect
19661
19662 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
19663 called the @code{epoch}
19664 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
19665 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
19666 each value is printed in its own window.
19667 @end ignore
19668
19669
19670 @node GDB/MI
19671 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
19672
19673 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
19674
19675 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
19676 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
19677 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
19678 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
19679 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
19680 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
19681
19682 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
19683 in the form of a reference manual.
19684
19685 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
19686 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
19687 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
19688
19689 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
19690
19691 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
19692 This chapter uses the following notation:
19693
19694 @itemize @bullet
19695 @item
19696 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
19697
19698 @item
19699 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
19700 it may or may not be given.
19701
19702 @item
19703 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
19704 may repeat zero or more times.
19705
19706 @item
19707 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
19708 may repeat one or more times.
19709
19710 @item
19711 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
19712 @end itemize
19713
19714 @ignore
19715 @heading Dependencies
19716 @end ignore
19717
19718 @menu
19719 * GDB/MI General Design::
19720 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
19721 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
19722 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
19723 * GDB/MI Output Records::
19724 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
19725 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
19726 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
19727 * GDB/MI Program Context::
19728 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
19729 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
19730 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
19731 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
19732 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
19733 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
19734 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
19735 * GDB/MI File Commands::
19736 @ignore
19737 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
19738 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
19739 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
19740 @end ignore
19741 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
19742 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
19743 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
19744 @end menu
19745
19746 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19747 @node GDB/MI General Design
19748 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
19749 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
19750
19751 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
19752 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
19753 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
19754 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
19755 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
19756 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
19757 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
19758 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
19759 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
19760 a command and reported as part of that command response.
19761
19762 The important examples of notifications are:
19763 @itemize @bullet
19764
19765 @item
19766 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
19767 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
19768 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
19769 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
19770 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
19771 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
19772 command itself was successfully executed.
19773
19774 @item
19775 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
19776 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
19777 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
19778 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
19779 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
19780 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
19781
19782 @item
19783 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
19784 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
19785 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
19786 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
19787 orthogonal frontend design.
19788
19789 @end itemize
19790
19791 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
19792 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
19793 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
19794 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
19795 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
19796 the user interface.
19797
19798 @subsection Context management
19799
19800 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
19801 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
19802 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
19803 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
19804 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
19805 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
19806 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
19807 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
19808 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
19809
19810 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
19811 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
19812 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
19813 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
19814 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
19815 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
19816 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
19817 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
19818 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
19819 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
19820 for thread and frame to operate on.
19821
19822 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
19823 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
19824 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
19825 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
19826 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
19827 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
19828 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
19829 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
19830 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
19831 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
19832
19833 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
19834 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
19835 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
19836 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
19837 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
19838 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
19839 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
19840 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
19841 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
19842 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
19843 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
19844 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
19845 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
19846 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
19847 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
19848 @samp{--frame} options.
19849
19850 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
19851
19852 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
19853 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
19854 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
19855 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
19856 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
19857 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
19858 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
19859 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
19860 @code{-list-target-features} command.
19861
19862 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
19863 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
19864 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
19865 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
19866 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
19867 are running.
19868
19869 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
19870 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
19871 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
19872 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
19873 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
19874 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
19875 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
19876 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
19877 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
19878 @samp{--thread} option).
19879
19880 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
19881 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
19882 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
19883 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
19884
19885 @subsection Thread groups
19886 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
19887 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
19888 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
19889 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
19890 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
19891
19892 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
19893 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
19894 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
19895 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
19896 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
19897 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
19898 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
19899 into processes.
19900
19901 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
19902 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
19903 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
19904 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
19905 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
19906 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
19907 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
19908 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
19909 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
19910 the members of specific thread group.
19911
19912 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
19913 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
19914 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
19915 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
19916 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
19917 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
19918 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
19919 after attaching to that thread group.
19920
19921 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19922 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
19923 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
19924
19925 @menu
19926 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
19927 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
19928 @end menu
19929
19930 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
19931 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
19932
19933 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
19934 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
19935 @table @code
19936 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
19937 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
19938
19939 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
19940 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
19941 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
19942
19943 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
19944 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
19945 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
19946
19947 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
19948 "any sequence of digits"
19949
19950 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
19951 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
19952
19953 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
19954 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
19955
19956 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
19957 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
19958
19959 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
19960 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
19961 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
19962
19963 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
19964 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
19965
19966 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
19967 @code{CR | CR-LF}
19968 @end table
19969
19970 @noindent
19971 Notes:
19972
19973 @itemize @bullet
19974 @item
19975 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
19976 output is described below.
19977
19978 @item
19979 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
19980 finishes.
19981
19982 @item
19983 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
19984 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
19985 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
19986 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
19987 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
19988 @end itemize
19989
19990 Pragmatics:
19991
19992 @itemize @bullet
19993 @item
19994 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
19995
19996 @item
19997 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
19998 @end itemize
19999
20000 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
20001 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
20002
20003 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
20004 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
20005 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
20006 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
20007 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
20008 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
20009
20010 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
20011 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
20012 @var{token}.
20013
20014 @table @code
20015 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
20016 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
20017
20018 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
20019 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
20020
20021 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
20022 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
20023
20024 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
20025 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
20026
20027 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
20028 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
20029
20030 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
20031 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
20032
20033 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
20034 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
20035
20036 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
20037 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
20038
20039 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
20040 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
20041
20042 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
20043 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
20044 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
20045
20046 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
20047 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
20048
20049 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
20050 @code{ @var{string} }
20051
20052 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
20053 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
20054
20055 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
20056 @code{@var{c-string}}
20057
20058 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
20059 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
20060
20061 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
20062 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
20063 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
20064
20065 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
20066 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
20067
20068 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
20069 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
20070
20071 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
20072 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
20073
20074 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
20075 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
20076
20077 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
20078 @code{CR | CR-LF}
20079
20080 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
20081 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
20082 @end table
20083
20084 @noindent
20085 Notes:
20086
20087 @itemize @bullet
20088 @item
20089 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
20090
20091 @item
20092 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
20093 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
20094 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
20095 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
20096 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
20097 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
20098 prior command.
20099
20100 @item
20101 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
20102 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
20103 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
20104 prefixed by @samp{+}.
20105
20106 @item
20107 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
20108 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
20109 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
20110 @samp{*}.
20111
20112 @item
20113 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
20114 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
20115 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
20116 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
20117
20118 @item
20119 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
20120 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
20121 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
20122 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
20123
20124 @item
20125 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
20126 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
20127 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
20128
20129 @item
20130 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
20131 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
20132 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
20133 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
20134
20135 @item
20136 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
20137 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
20138 @var{values}.
20139
20140
20141 @end itemize
20142
20143 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
20144 details about the various output records.
20145
20146 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20147 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
20148 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
20149
20150 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
20151 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
20152
20153 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
20154 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
20155 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
20156 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
20157 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
20158 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
20159
20160 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
20161 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
20162 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
20163
20164 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20165 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
20166 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
20167 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
20168
20169 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
20170 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
20171
20172 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
20173 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
20174 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
20175 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
20176 might change.
20177
20178 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
20179 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
20180 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
20181 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
20182
20183 @itemize @bullet
20184 @item
20185 New MI commands may be added.
20186
20187 @item
20188 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
20189
20190 @item
20191 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
20192 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
20193
20194 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
20195 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
20196
20197 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
20198 @c resolve inconsistencies.
20199 @end itemize
20200
20201 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
20202 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
20203 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
20204 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
20205 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
20206
20207 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
20208 @c version?
20209
20210 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
20211 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
20212 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
20213 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
20214 @cindex mailing lists
20215
20216 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20217 @node GDB/MI Output Records
20218 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
20219
20220 @menu
20221 * GDB/MI Result Records::
20222 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
20223 * GDB/MI Async Records::
20224 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
20225 @end menu
20226
20227 @node GDB/MI Result Records
20228 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
20229
20230 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
20231 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
20232 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
20233 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
20234
20235 @table @code
20236 @findex ^done
20237 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
20238 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
20239 values.
20240
20241 @item "^running"
20242 @findex ^running
20243 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
20244 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
20245 running.
20246
20247 @item "^connected"
20248 @findex ^connected
20249 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
20250
20251 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
20252 @findex ^error
20253 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
20254 error message.
20255
20256 @item "^exit"
20257 @findex ^exit
20258 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
20259
20260 @end table
20261
20262 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
20263 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
20264
20265 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
20266 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
20267 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
20268 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
20269 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
20270
20271 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
20272 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
20273 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
20274 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
20275 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
20276
20277 @table @code
20278 @item "~" @var{string-output}
20279 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
20280 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
20281
20282 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
20283 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
20284 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
20285 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
20286
20287 @item "&" @var{string-output}
20288 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
20289 internals.
20290 @end table
20291
20292 @node GDB/MI Async Records
20293 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
20294
20295 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
20296 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
20297 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
20298 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
20299 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
20300 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
20301
20302 The following is the list of possible async records:
20303
20304 @table @code
20305
20306 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
20307 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
20308 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
20309 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
20310 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
20311 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
20312 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
20313 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
20314 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
20315 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
20316
20317 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}"
20318 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
20319 following values:
20320
20321 @table @code
20322 @item breakpoint-hit
20323 A breakpoint was reached.
20324 @item watchpoint-trigger
20325 A watchpoint was triggered.
20326 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
20327 A read watchpoint was triggered.
20328 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
20329 An access watchpoint was triggered.
20330 @item function-finished
20331 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
20332 @item location-reached
20333 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
20334 @item watchpoint-scope
20335 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
20336 @item end-stepping-range
20337 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
20338 similar CLI command was accomplished.
20339 @item exited-signalled
20340 The inferior exited because of a signal.
20341 @item exited
20342 The inferior exited.
20343 @item exited-normally
20344 The inferior exited normally.
20345 @item signal-received
20346 A signal was received by the inferior.
20347 @end table
20348
20349 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
20350 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
20351 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
20352 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
20353 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
20354 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
20355 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
20356 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
20357 several threads in the list.
20358
20359 @item =thread-group-created,id="@var{id}"
20360 @itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
20361 A thread thread group either was attached to, or has exited/detached
20362 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
20363 thread group.
20364
20365 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
20366 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
20367 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
20368 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
20369 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
20370
20371 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
20372 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
20373 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
20374 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
20375 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
20376 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
20377 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
20378
20379 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
20380 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
20381 that thread.
20382
20383 @item =library-loaded,...
20384 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
20385 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
20386 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
20387 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
20388 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
20389 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
20390 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
20391 @var{symbols-loaded} field reports if the debug symbols for this
20392 library are loaded.
20393
20394 @item =library-unloaded,...
20395 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
20396 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
20397 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification
20398
20399 @end table
20400
20401 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
20402 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
20403
20404 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
20405 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
20406 fields:
20407
20408 @table @code
20409 @item level
20410 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
20411 zero. This field is always present.
20412
20413 @item func
20414 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
20415 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
20416
20417 @item addr
20418 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
20419
20420 @item file
20421 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
20422 address. This field may be absent.
20423
20424 @item line
20425 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
20426 may be absent.
20427
20428 @item from
20429 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
20430 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
20431
20432 @end table
20433
20434
20435 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20436 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
20437 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
20438 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
20439
20440 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
20441 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
20442 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
20443 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
20444
20445 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
20446 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
20447
20448 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
20449
20450 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
20451 information of the breakpoint.
20452
20453 @smallexample
20454 -> -break-insert main
20455 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
20456 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
20457 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
20458 <- (gdb)
20459 @end smallexample
20460
20461 @subheading Program Execution
20462
20463 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
20464 reason that execution stopped.
20465
20466 @smallexample
20467 -> -exec-run
20468 <- ^running
20469 <- (gdb)
20470 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
20471 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
20472 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
20473 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
20474 <- (gdb)
20475 -> -exec-continue
20476 <- ^running
20477 <- (gdb)
20478 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
20479 <- (gdb)
20480 @end smallexample
20481
20482 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
20483
20484 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
20485
20486 @smallexample
20487 -> (gdb)
20488 <- -gdb-exit
20489 <- ^exit
20490 @end smallexample
20491
20492 @subheading A Bad Command
20493
20494 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
20495
20496 @smallexample
20497 -> -rubbish
20498 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
20499 <- (gdb)
20500 @end smallexample
20501
20502
20503 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20504 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
20505 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
20506
20507 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
20508 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
20509
20510 @subheading Motivation
20511
20512 The motivation for this collection of commands.
20513
20514 @subheading Introduction
20515
20516 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
20517
20518 @subheading Commands
20519
20520 For each command in the block, the following is described:
20521
20522 @subsubheading Synopsis
20523
20524 @smallexample
20525 -command @var{args}@dots{}
20526 @end smallexample
20527
20528 @subsubheading Result
20529
20530 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20531
20532 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
20533
20534 @subsubheading Example
20535
20536 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
20537 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
20538
20539
20540 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20541 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
20542 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
20543
20544 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
20545 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
20546 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
20547 breakpoints.
20548
20549 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
20550 @findex -break-after
20551
20552 @subsubheading Synopsis
20553
20554 @smallexample
20555 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
20556 @end smallexample
20557
20558 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
20559 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
20560 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
20561 @samp{-break-list} command below.
20562
20563 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20564
20565 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
20566
20567 @subsubheading Example
20568
20569 @smallexample
20570 (gdb)
20571 -break-insert main
20572 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
20573 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
20574 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
20575 (gdb)
20576 -break-after 1 3
20577 ~
20578 ^done
20579 (gdb)
20580 -break-list
20581 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20582 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20583 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20584 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20585 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20586 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20587 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20588 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20589 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20590 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
20591 (gdb)
20592 @end smallexample
20593
20594 @ignore
20595 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
20596 @findex -break-catch
20597
20598 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
20599 @findex -break-commands
20600 @end ignore
20601
20602
20603 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
20604 @findex -break-condition
20605
20606 @subsubheading Synopsis
20607
20608 @smallexample
20609 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
20610 @end smallexample
20611
20612 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
20613 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
20614 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
20615 command below).
20616
20617 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20618
20619 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
20620
20621 @subsubheading Example
20622
20623 @smallexample
20624 (gdb)
20625 -break-condition 1 1
20626 ^done
20627 (gdb)
20628 -break-list
20629 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20630 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20631 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20632 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20633 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20634 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20635 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20636 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20637 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20638 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
20639 (gdb)
20640 @end smallexample
20641
20642 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
20643 @findex -break-delete
20644
20645 @subsubheading Synopsis
20646
20647 @smallexample
20648 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
20649 @end smallexample
20650
20651 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
20652 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
20653
20654 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20655
20656 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
20657
20658 @subsubheading Example
20659
20660 @smallexample
20661 (gdb)
20662 -break-delete 1
20663 ^done
20664 (gdb)
20665 -break-list
20666 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
20667 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20668 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20669 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20670 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20671 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20672 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20673 body=[]@}
20674 (gdb)
20675 @end smallexample
20676
20677 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
20678 @findex -break-disable
20679
20680 @subsubheading Synopsis
20681
20682 @smallexample
20683 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
20684 @end smallexample
20685
20686 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
20687 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
20688
20689 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20690
20691 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
20692
20693 @subsubheading Example
20694
20695 @smallexample
20696 (gdb)
20697 -break-disable 2
20698 ^done
20699 (gdb)
20700 -break-list
20701 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20702 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20703 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20704 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20705 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20706 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20707 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20708 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
20709 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20710 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
20711 (gdb)
20712 @end smallexample
20713
20714 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
20715 @findex -break-enable
20716
20717 @subsubheading Synopsis
20718
20719 @smallexample
20720 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
20721 @end smallexample
20722
20723 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
20724
20725 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20726
20727 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
20728
20729 @subsubheading Example
20730
20731 @smallexample
20732 (gdb)
20733 -break-enable 2
20734 ^done
20735 (gdb)
20736 -break-list
20737 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20738 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20739 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20740 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20741 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20742 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20743 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20744 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20745 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20746 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
20747 (gdb)
20748 @end smallexample
20749
20750 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
20751 @findex -break-info
20752
20753 @subsubheading Synopsis
20754
20755 @smallexample
20756 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
20757 @end smallexample
20758
20759 @c REDUNDANT???
20760 Get information about a single breakpoint.
20761
20762 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20763
20764 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
20765
20766 @subsubheading Example
20767 N.A.
20768
20769 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
20770 @findex -break-insert
20771
20772 @subsubheading Synopsis
20773
20774 @smallexample
20775 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
20776 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
20777 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
20778 @end smallexample
20779
20780 @noindent
20781 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
20782
20783 @itemize @bullet
20784 @item function
20785 @c @item +offset
20786 @c @item -offset
20787 @c @item linenum
20788 @item filename:linenum
20789 @item filename:function
20790 @item *address
20791 @end itemize
20792
20793 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
20794
20795 @table @samp
20796 @item -t
20797 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
20798 @item -h
20799 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
20800 @item -c @var{condition}
20801 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
20802 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
20803 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
20804 @item -f
20805 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
20806 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
20807 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
20808 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
20809 cannot be parsed.
20810 @item -d
20811 Create a disabled breakpoint.
20812 @end table
20813
20814 @subsubheading Result
20815
20816 The result is in the form:
20817
20818 @smallexample
20819 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
20820 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
20821 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
20822 times="@var{times}"@}
20823 @end smallexample
20824
20825 @noindent
20826 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
20827 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
20828 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
20829 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
20830 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
20831 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
20832 which use the same output).
20833
20834 Note: this format is open to change.
20835 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
20836
20837 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20838
20839 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
20840 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
20841
20842 @subsubheading Example
20843
20844 @smallexample
20845 (gdb)
20846 -break-insert main
20847 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
20848 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
20849 (gdb)
20850 -break-insert -t foo
20851 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
20852 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
20853 (gdb)
20854 -break-list
20855 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20856 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20857 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20858 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20859 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20860 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20861 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20862 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20863 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
20864 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
20865 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
20866 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
20867 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
20868 (gdb)
20869 -break-insert -r foo.*
20870 ~int foo(int, int);
20871 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
20872 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
20873 (gdb)
20874 @end smallexample
20875
20876 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
20877 @findex -break-list
20878
20879 @subsubheading Synopsis
20880
20881 @smallexample
20882 -break-list
20883 @end smallexample
20884
20885 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
20886
20887 @table @samp
20888 @item Number
20889 number of the breakpoint
20890 @item Type
20891 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
20892 @item Disposition
20893 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
20894 or @samp{nokeep}
20895 @item Enabled
20896 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
20897 @item Address
20898 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
20899 @item What
20900 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
20901 name, line number
20902 @item Times
20903 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
20904 @end table
20905
20906 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
20907 @code{body} field is an empty list.
20908
20909 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20910
20911 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
20912
20913 @subsubheading Example
20914
20915 @smallexample
20916 (gdb)
20917 -break-list
20918 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20919 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20920 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20921 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20922 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20923 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20924 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20925 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20926 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
20927 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20928 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20929 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
20930 (gdb)
20931 @end smallexample
20932
20933 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
20934
20935 @smallexample
20936 (gdb)
20937 -break-list
20938 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
20939 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20940 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20941 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20942 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20943 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20944 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20945 body=[]@}
20946 (gdb)
20947 @end smallexample
20948
20949 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
20950 @findex -break-watch
20951
20952 @subsubheading Synopsis
20953
20954 @smallexample
20955 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
20956 @end smallexample
20957
20958 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
20959 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
20960 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
20961 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
20962 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
20963 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
20964 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
20965 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
20966
20967 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
20968 breakpoints inserted.
20969
20970 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20971
20972 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
20973 @samp{rwatch}.
20974
20975 @subsubheading Example
20976
20977 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
20978
20979 @smallexample
20980 (gdb)
20981 -break-watch x
20982 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
20983 (gdb)
20984 -exec-continue
20985 ^running
20986 (gdb)
20987 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
20988 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
20989 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
20990 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
20991 (gdb)
20992 @end smallexample
20993
20994 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
20995 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
20996 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
20997
20998 @smallexample
20999 (gdb)
21000 -break-watch C
21001 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
21002 (gdb)
21003 -exec-continue
21004 ^running
21005 (gdb)
21006 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
21007 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
21008 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
21009 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21010 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
21011 (gdb)
21012 -exec-continue
21013 ^running
21014 (gdb)
21015 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
21016 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
21017 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
21018 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21019 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
21020 (gdb)
21021 @end smallexample
21022
21023 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
21024 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
21025 deleted.
21026
21027 @smallexample
21028 (gdb)
21029 -break-watch C
21030 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
21031 (gdb)
21032 -break-list
21033 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
21034 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21035 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21036 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21037 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21038 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21039 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21040 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21041 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
21042 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21043 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
21044 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
21045 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
21046 (gdb)
21047 -exec-continue
21048 ^running
21049 (gdb)
21050 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
21051 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
21052 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
21053 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21054 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
21055 (gdb)
21056 -break-list
21057 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
21058 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21059 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21060 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21061 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21062 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21063 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21064 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21065 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
21066 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21067 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
21068 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
21069 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
21070 (gdb)
21071 -exec-continue
21072 ^running
21073 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
21074 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
21075 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
21076 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21077 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
21078 (gdb)
21079 -break-list
21080 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
21081 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
21082 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
21083 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
21084 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
21085 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
21086 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
21087 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21088 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
21089 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21090 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
21091 times="1"@}]@}
21092 (gdb)
21093 @end smallexample
21094
21095 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21096 @node GDB/MI Program Context
21097 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
21098
21099 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
21100 @findex -exec-arguments
21101
21102
21103 @subsubheading Synopsis
21104
21105 @smallexample
21106 -exec-arguments @var{args}
21107 @end smallexample
21108
21109 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
21110 @samp{-exec-run}.
21111
21112 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21113
21114 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
21115
21116 @subsubheading Example
21117
21118 @smallexample
21119 (gdb)
21120 -exec-arguments -v word
21121 ^done
21122 (gdb)
21123 @end smallexample
21124
21125
21126 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
21127 @findex -exec-show-arguments
21128
21129 @subsubheading Synopsis
21130
21131 @smallexample
21132 -exec-show-arguments
21133 @end smallexample
21134
21135 Print the arguments of the program.
21136
21137 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21138
21139 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
21140
21141 @subsubheading Example
21142 N.A.
21143
21144
21145 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
21146 @findex -environment-cd
21147
21148 @subsubheading Synopsis
21149
21150 @smallexample
21151 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
21152 @end smallexample
21153
21154 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
21155
21156 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21157
21158 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
21159
21160 @subsubheading Example
21161
21162 @smallexample
21163 (gdb)
21164 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
21165 ^done
21166 (gdb)
21167 @end smallexample
21168
21169
21170 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
21171 @findex -environment-directory
21172
21173 @subsubheading Synopsis
21174
21175 @smallexample
21176 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
21177 @end smallexample
21178
21179 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
21180 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
21181 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
21182 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
21183 occurs as normal.
21184 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
21185 multiple directories in a single command
21186 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
21187 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
21188 If blanks are needed as
21189 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
21190 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
21191 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
21192 character must not be used
21193 in any directory name.
21194 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
21195
21196 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21197
21198 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
21199
21200 @subsubheading Example
21201
21202 @smallexample
21203 (gdb)
21204 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
21205 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
21206 (gdb)
21207 -environment-directory ""
21208 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
21209 (gdb)
21210 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
21211 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
21212 (gdb)
21213 -environment-directory -r
21214 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
21215 (gdb)
21216 @end smallexample
21217
21218
21219 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
21220 @findex -environment-path
21221
21222 @subsubheading Synopsis
21223
21224 @smallexample
21225 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
21226 @end smallexample
21227
21228 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
21229 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
21230 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
21231 supplied in addition to the
21232 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
21233 occurs as normal.
21234 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
21235 multiple directories in a single command
21236 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
21237 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
21238 If blanks are needed as
21239 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
21240 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
21241 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
21242 character must not be used
21243 in any directory name.
21244 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
21245
21246
21247 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21248
21249 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
21250
21251 @subsubheading Example
21252
21253 @smallexample
21254 (gdb)
21255 -environment-path
21256 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
21257 (gdb)
21258 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
21259 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
21260 (gdb)
21261 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
21262 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
21263 (gdb)
21264 @end smallexample
21265
21266
21267 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
21268 @findex -environment-pwd
21269
21270 @subsubheading Synopsis
21271
21272 @smallexample
21273 -environment-pwd
21274 @end smallexample
21275
21276 Show the current working directory.
21277
21278 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21279
21280 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
21281
21282 @subsubheading Example
21283
21284 @smallexample
21285 (gdb)
21286 -environment-pwd
21287 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
21288 (gdb)
21289 @end smallexample
21290
21291 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21292 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
21293 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
21294
21295
21296 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
21297 @findex -thread-info
21298
21299 @subsubheading Synopsis
21300
21301 @smallexample
21302 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
21303 @end smallexample
21304
21305 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
21306 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
21307 threads. When printing information about all threads,
21308 also reports the current thread.
21309
21310 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21311
21312 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
21313 about all threads.
21314
21315 @subsubheading Example
21316
21317 @smallexample
21318 -thread-info
21319 ^done,threads=[
21320 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
21321 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
21322 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
21323 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
21324 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}],
21325 current-thread-id="1"
21326 (gdb)
21327 @end smallexample
21328
21329 The @samp{state} field may have the following values:
21330
21331 @table @code
21332 @item stopped
21333 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
21334 threads.
21335
21336 @item running
21337 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
21338 threads.
21339
21340 @end table
21341
21342 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
21343 @findex -thread-list-ids
21344
21345 @subsubheading Synopsis
21346
21347 @smallexample
21348 -thread-list-ids
21349 @end smallexample
21350
21351 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
21352 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
21353
21354 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
21355 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
21356
21357 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21358
21359 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
21360
21361 @subsubheading Example
21362
21363 @smallexample
21364 (gdb)
21365 -thread-list-ids
21366 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
21367 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
21368 (gdb)
21369 @end smallexample
21370
21371
21372 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
21373 @findex -thread-select
21374
21375 @subsubheading Synopsis
21376
21377 @smallexample
21378 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
21379 @end smallexample
21380
21381 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
21382 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
21383
21384 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
21385 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
21386
21387 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21388
21389 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
21390
21391 @subsubheading Example
21392
21393 @smallexample
21394 (gdb)
21395 -exec-next
21396 ^running
21397 (gdb)
21398 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
21399 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
21400 (gdb)
21401 -thread-list-ids
21402 ^done,
21403 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
21404 number-of-threads="3"
21405 (gdb)
21406 -thread-select 3
21407 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
21408 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
21409 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
21410 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
21411 (gdb)
21412 @end smallexample
21413
21414 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21415 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
21416 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
21417
21418 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
21419 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
21420 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
21421 other cases.
21422
21423 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
21424 @findex -exec-continue
21425
21426 @subsubheading Synopsis
21427
21428 @smallexample
21429 -exec-continue [--all|--thread-group N]
21430 @end smallexample
21431
21432 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
21433 encountered, or until the inferior exits. In all-stop mode
21434 (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads,
21435 depending on the value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. In
21436 non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), if the @samp{--all} is not
21437 specified, only the thread specified with the @samp{--thread} option
21438 (or current thread, if no @samp{--thread} is provided) is resumed. If
21439 @samp{--all} is specified, all threads will be resumed. The
21440 @samp{--all} option is ignored in all-stop mode. If the
21441 @samp{--thread-group} options is specified, then all threads in that
21442 thread group are resumed.
21443
21444 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21445
21446 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
21447
21448 @subsubheading Example
21449
21450 @smallexample
21451 -exec-continue
21452 ^running
21453 (gdb)
21454 @@Hello world
21455 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
21456 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
21457 line="13"@}
21458 (gdb)
21459 @end smallexample
21460
21461
21462 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
21463 @findex -exec-finish
21464
21465 @subsubheading Synopsis
21466
21467 @smallexample
21468 -exec-finish
21469 @end smallexample
21470
21471 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
21472 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
21473
21474 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21475
21476 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
21477
21478 @subsubheading Example
21479
21480 Function returning @code{void}.
21481
21482 @smallexample
21483 -exec-finish
21484 ^running
21485 (gdb)
21486 @@hello from foo
21487 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
21488 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
21489 (gdb)
21490 @end smallexample
21491
21492 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
21493 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
21494 value itself.
21495
21496 @smallexample
21497 -exec-finish
21498 ^running
21499 (gdb)
21500 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
21501 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
21502 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21503 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
21504 (gdb)
21505 @end smallexample
21506
21507
21508 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
21509 @findex -exec-interrupt
21510
21511 @subsubheading Synopsis
21512
21513 @smallexample
21514 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
21515 @end smallexample
21516
21517 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
21518 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
21519 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
21520 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
21521 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
21522
21523 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
21524 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
21525 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
21526 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
21527
21528 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
21529 All threads will be interrupted if the @samp{--all} option is
21530 specified. If the @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, all
21531 threads in that group will be interrupted.
21532
21533 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21534
21535 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
21536
21537 @subsubheading Example
21538
21539 @smallexample
21540 (gdb)
21541 111-exec-continue
21542 111^running
21543
21544 (gdb)
21545 222-exec-interrupt
21546 222^done
21547 (gdb)
21548 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
21549 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
21550 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
21551 (gdb)
21552
21553 (gdb)
21554 -exec-interrupt
21555 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
21556 (gdb)
21557 @end smallexample
21558
21559 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
21560 @findex -exec-jump
21561
21562 @subsubheading Synopsis
21563
21564 @smallexample
21565 -exec-jump @var{location}
21566 @end smallexample
21567
21568 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
21569 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
21570 different forms of @var{location}.
21571
21572 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21573
21574 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
21575
21576 @subsubheading Example
21577
21578 @smallexample
21579 -exec-jump foo.c:10
21580 *running,thread-id="all"
21581 ^running
21582 @end smallexample
21583
21584
21585 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
21586 @findex -exec-next
21587
21588 @subsubheading Synopsis
21589
21590 @smallexample
21591 -exec-next
21592 @end smallexample
21593
21594 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
21595 of the next source line is reached.
21596
21597 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21598
21599 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
21600
21601 @subsubheading Example
21602
21603 @smallexample
21604 -exec-next
21605 ^running
21606 (gdb)
21607 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
21608 (gdb)
21609 @end smallexample
21610
21611
21612 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
21613 @findex -exec-next-instruction
21614
21615 @subsubheading Synopsis
21616
21617 @smallexample
21618 -exec-next-instruction
21619 @end smallexample
21620
21621 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
21622 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
21623 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
21624 printed as well.
21625
21626 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21627
21628 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
21629
21630 @subsubheading Example
21631
21632 @smallexample
21633 (gdb)
21634 -exec-next-instruction
21635 ^running
21636
21637 (gdb)
21638 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
21639 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
21640 (gdb)
21641 @end smallexample
21642
21643
21644 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
21645 @findex -exec-return
21646
21647 @subsubheading Synopsis
21648
21649 @smallexample
21650 -exec-return
21651 @end smallexample
21652
21653 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
21654 Displays the new current frame.
21655
21656 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21657
21658 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
21659
21660 @subsubheading Example
21661
21662 @smallexample
21663 (gdb)
21664 200-break-insert callee4
21665 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
21666 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
21667 (gdb)
21668 000-exec-run
21669 000^running
21670 (gdb)
21671 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
21672 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
21673 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21674 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
21675 (gdb)
21676 205-break-delete
21677 205^done
21678 (gdb)
21679 111-exec-return
21680 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
21681 args=[@{name="strarg",
21682 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
21683 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21684 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
21685 (gdb)
21686 @end smallexample
21687
21688
21689 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
21690 @findex -exec-run
21691
21692 @subsubheading Synopsis
21693
21694 @smallexample
21695 -exec-run
21696 @end smallexample
21697
21698 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
21699 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
21700 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
21701 the program has exited exceptionally.
21702
21703 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21704
21705 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
21706
21707 @subsubheading Examples
21708
21709 @smallexample
21710 (gdb)
21711 -break-insert main
21712 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
21713 (gdb)
21714 -exec-run
21715 ^running
21716 (gdb)
21717 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
21718 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
21719 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
21720 (gdb)
21721 @end smallexample
21722
21723 @noindent
21724 Program exited normally:
21725
21726 @smallexample
21727 (gdb)
21728 -exec-run
21729 ^running
21730 (gdb)
21731 x = 55
21732 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
21733 (gdb)
21734 @end smallexample
21735
21736 @noindent
21737 Program exited exceptionally:
21738
21739 @smallexample
21740 (gdb)
21741 -exec-run
21742 ^running
21743 (gdb)
21744 x = 55
21745 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
21746 (gdb)
21747 @end smallexample
21748
21749 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
21750 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
21751
21752 @smallexample
21753 (gdb)
21754 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
21755 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
21756 @end smallexample
21757
21758
21759 @c @subheading -exec-signal
21760
21761
21762 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
21763 @findex -exec-step
21764
21765 @subsubheading Synopsis
21766
21767 @smallexample
21768 -exec-step
21769 @end smallexample
21770
21771 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
21772 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
21773 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
21774 function.
21775
21776 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21777
21778 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
21779
21780 @subsubheading Example
21781
21782 Stepping into a function:
21783
21784 @smallexample
21785 -exec-step
21786 ^running
21787 (gdb)
21788 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
21789 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
21790 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
21791 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
21792 (gdb)
21793 @end smallexample
21794
21795 Regular stepping:
21796
21797 @smallexample
21798 -exec-step
21799 ^running
21800 (gdb)
21801 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
21802 (gdb)
21803 @end smallexample
21804
21805
21806 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
21807 @findex -exec-step-instruction
21808
21809 @subsubheading Synopsis
21810
21811 @smallexample
21812 -exec-step-instruction
21813 @end smallexample
21814
21815 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
21816 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
21817 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
21818 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
21819 well.
21820
21821 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21822
21823 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
21824
21825 @subsubheading Example
21826
21827 @smallexample
21828 (gdb)
21829 -exec-step-instruction
21830 ^running
21831
21832 (gdb)
21833 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
21834 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
21835 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
21836 (gdb)
21837 -exec-step-instruction
21838 ^running
21839
21840 (gdb)
21841 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
21842 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
21843 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
21844 (gdb)
21845 @end smallexample
21846
21847
21848 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
21849 @findex -exec-until
21850
21851 @subsubheading Synopsis
21852
21853 @smallexample
21854 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
21855 @end smallexample
21856
21857 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
21858 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
21859 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
21860 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
21861
21862 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21863
21864 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
21865
21866 @subsubheading Example
21867
21868 @smallexample
21869 (gdb)
21870 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
21871 ^running
21872 (gdb)
21873 x = 55
21874 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
21875 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
21876 (gdb)
21877 @end smallexample
21878
21879 @ignore
21880 @subheading -file-clear
21881 Is this going away????
21882 @end ignore
21883
21884 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21885 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
21886 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
21887
21888
21889 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
21890 @findex -stack-info-frame
21891
21892 @subsubheading Synopsis
21893
21894 @smallexample
21895 -stack-info-frame
21896 @end smallexample
21897
21898 Get info on the selected frame.
21899
21900 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21901
21902 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
21903 (without arguments).
21904
21905 @subsubheading Example
21906
21907 @smallexample
21908 (gdb)
21909 -stack-info-frame
21910 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
21911 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21912 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
21913 (gdb)
21914 @end smallexample
21915
21916 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
21917 @findex -stack-info-depth
21918
21919 @subsubheading Synopsis
21920
21921 @smallexample
21922 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
21923 @end smallexample
21924
21925 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
21926 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
21927
21928 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21929
21930 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21931
21932 @subsubheading Example
21933
21934 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
21935
21936 @smallexample
21937 (gdb)
21938 -stack-info-depth
21939 ^done,depth="12"
21940 (gdb)
21941 -stack-info-depth 4
21942 ^done,depth="4"
21943 (gdb)
21944 -stack-info-depth 12
21945 ^done,depth="12"
21946 (gdb)
21947 -stack-info-depth 11
21948 ^done,depth="11"
21949 (gdb)
21950 -stack-info-depth 13
21951 ^done,depth="12"
21952 (gdb)
21953 @end smallexample
21954
21955 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
21956 @findex -stack-list-arguments
21957
21958 @subsubheading Synopsis
21959
21960 @smallexample
21961 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
21962 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
21963 @end smallexample
21964
21965 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
21966 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
21967 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
21968 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
21969 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
21970 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
21971 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
21972 which case only existing frames will be returned.
21973
21974 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
21975 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
21976 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
21977
21978 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21979
21980 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
21981 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
21982 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
21983
21984 @subsubheading Example
21985
21986 @smallexample
21987 (gdb)
21988 -stack-list-frames
21989 ^done,
21990 stack=[
21991 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
21992 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21993 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
21994 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
21995 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21996 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
21997 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
21998 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21999 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
22000 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
22001 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22002 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
22003 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
22004 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
22005 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
22006 (gdb)
22007 -stack-list-arguments 0
22008 ^done,
22009 stack-args=[
22010 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
22011 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
22012 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
22013 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
22014 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
22015 (gdb)
22016 -stack-list-arguments 1
22017 ^done,
22018 stack-args=[
22019 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
22020 frame=@{level="1",
22021 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
22022 frame=@{level="2",args=[
22023 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
22024 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
22025 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
22026 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
22027 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
22028 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
22029 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
22030 (gdb)
22031 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
22032 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
22033 (gdb)
22034 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
22035 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
22036 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
22037 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
22038 (gdb)
22039 @end smallexample
22040
22041 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
22042
22043
22044 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
22045 @findex -stack-list-frames
22046
22047 @subsubheading Synopsis
22048
22049 @smallexample
22050 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
22051 @end smallexample
22052
22053 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
22054 following info:
22055
22056 @table @samp
22057 @item @var{level}
22058 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
22059 @item @var{addr}
22060 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
22061 @item @var{func}
22062 Function name.
22063 @item @var{file}
22064 File name of the source file where the function lives.
22065 @item @var{line}
22066 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
22067 @end table
22068
22069 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
22070 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
22071 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
22072 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
22073 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
22074 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
22075 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
22076
22077 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22078
22079 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
22080
22081 @subsubheading Example
22082
22083 Full stack backtrace:
22084
22085 @smallexample
22086 (gdb)
22087 -stack-list-frames
22088 ^done,stack=
22089 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
22090 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
22091 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22092 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22093 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22094 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22095 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22096 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22097 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22098 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22099 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22100 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22101 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22102 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22103 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22104 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22105 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22106 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22107 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22108 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22109 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22110 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22111 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
22112 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
22113 (gdb)
22114 @end smallexample
22115
22116 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
22117
22118 @smallexample
22119 (gdb)
22120 -stack-list-frames 3 5
22121 ^done,stack=
22122 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22123 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22124 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22125 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
22126 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22127 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
22128 (gdb)
22129 @end smallexample
22130
22131 Show a single frame:
22132
22133 @smallexample
22134 (gdb)
22135 -stack-list-frames 3 3
22136 ^done,stack=
22137 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
22138 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
22139 (gdb)
22140 @end smallexample
22141
22142
22143 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
22144 @findex -stack-list-locals
22145
22146 @subsubheading Synopsis
22147
22148 @smallexample
22149 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
22150 @end smallexample
22151
22152 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
22153 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
22154 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
22155 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
22156 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
22157 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
22158 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
22159 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
22160 more detail.
22161
22162 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22163
22164 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
22165
22166 @subsubheading Example
22167
22168 @smallexample
22169 (gdb)
22170 -stack-list-locals 0
22171 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
22172 (gdb)
22173 -stack-list-locals --all-values
22174 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
22175 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
22176 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
22177 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
22178 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
22179 (gdb)
22180 @end smallexample
22181
22182
22183 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
22184 @findex -stack-select-frame
22185
22186 @subsubheading Synopsis
22187
22188 @smallexample
22189 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
22190 @end smallexample
22191
22192 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
22193 the stack.
22194
22195 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
22196 option to every command.
22197
22198 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22199
22200 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
22201 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
22202
22203 @subsubheading Example
22204
22205 @smallexample
22206 (gdb)
22207 -stack-select-frame 2
22208 ^done
22209 (gdb)
22210 @end smallexample
22211
22212 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22213 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
22214 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
22215
22216 @ignore
22217
22218 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
22219
22220 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
22221 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
22222 used by @code{Insight}.
22223
22224 The two main reasons for that are:
22225
22226 @enumerate 1
22227 @item
22228 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
22229
22230 @item
22231 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
22232 now).
22233 @end enumerate
22234
22235 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
22236 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
22237 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
22238 hints about their use.
22239
22240 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
22241 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
22242 least, the following operations:
22243
22244 @itemize @bullet
22245 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
22246 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
22247 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
22248 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
22249 @end itemize
22250
22251 @end ignore
22252
22253 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
22254
22255 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
22256
22257 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
22258 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
22259 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
22260 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
22261 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
22262 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
22263 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
22264 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
22265 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
22266 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
22267 object, or to change display format.
22268
22269 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
22270 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
22271 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
22272 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
22273 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
22274 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
22275 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
22276 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
22277 child will be created.
22278
22279 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
22280 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
22281 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
22282 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
22283 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
22284
22285 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
22286 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
22287 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
22288 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
22289 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
22290 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
22291 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
22292 variables that frontend has created.
22293
22294 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
22295 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
22296 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
22297 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
22298 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
22299 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
22300 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
22301 implicitly updated.
22302
22303 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
22304 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
22305 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
22306 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
22307 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
22308 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
22309 frame. Consider this example:
22310
22311 @smallexample
22312 void do_work(...)
22313 @{
22314 struct work_state state;
22315
22316 if (...)
22317 do_work(...);
22318 @}
22319 @end smallexample
22320
22321 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
22322 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable
22323 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
22324 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
22325 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
22326
22327 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
22328 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
22329 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
22330 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
22331 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
22332 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
22333
22334 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
22335 access this functionality:
22336
22337 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
22338 @item @strong{Operation}
22339 @tab @strong{Description}
22340
22341 @item @code{-var-create}
22342 @tab create a variable object
22343 @item @code{-var-delete}
22344 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
22345 @item @code{-var-set-format}
22346 @tab set the display format of this variable
22347 @item @code{-var-show-format}
22348 @tab show the display format of this variable
22349 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
22350 @tab tells how many children this object has
22351 @item @code{-var-list-children}
22352 @tab return a list of the object's children
22353 @item @code{-var-info-type}
22354 @tab show the type of this variable object
22355 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
22356 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
22357 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
22358 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
22359 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
22360 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
22361 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
22362 @tab get the value of this variable
22363 @item @code{-var-assign}
22364 @tab set the value of this variable
22365 @item @code{-var-update}
22366 @tab update the variable and its children
22367 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
22368 @tab set frozeness attribute
22369 @end multitable
22370
22371 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
22372 how it can be used.
22373
22374 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
22375
22376 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
22377 @findex -var-create
22378
22379 @subsubheading Synopsis
22380
22381 @smallexample
22382 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
22383 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
22384 @end smallexample
22385
22386 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
22387 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
22388 register.
22389
22390 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
22391 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
22392 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
22393 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
22394 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
22395
22396 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
22397 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
22398 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
22399 object must be created.
22400
22401 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
22402 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
22403
22404 @itemize @bullet
22405 @item
22406 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
22407
22408 @item
22409 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
22410
22411 @item
22412 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
22413 @end itemize
22414
22415 @subsubheading Result
22416
22417 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
22418 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
22419 the @value{GDBN} CLI. If a fixed variable object is bound to a
22420 specific thread, the thread is is also printed:
22421
22422 @smallexample
22423 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}"
22424 @end smallexample
22425
22426
22427 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
22428 @findex -var-delete
22429
22430 @subsubheading Synopsis
22431
22432 @smallexample
22433 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
22434 @end smallexample
22435
22436 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
22437 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
22438
22439 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
22440
22441
22442 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
22443 @findex -var-set-format
22444
22445 @subsubheading Synopsis
22446
22447 @smallexample
22448 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
22449 @end smallexample
22450
22451 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
22452 @var{format-spec}.
22453
22454 @anchor{-var-set-format}
22455 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
22456
22457 @smallexample
22458 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
22459 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
22460 @end smallexample
22461
22462 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
22463 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
22464 for pointers, etc.).
22465
22466 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
22467 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
22468
22469 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
22470 @findex -var-show-format
22471
22472 @subsubheading Synopsis
22473
22474 @smallexample
22475 -var-show-format @var{name}
22476 @end smallexample
22477
22478 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
22479
22480 @smallexample
22481 @var{format} @expansion{}
22482 @var{format-spec}
22483 @end smallexample
22484
22485
22486 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
22487 @findex -var-info-num-children
22488
22489 @subsubheading Synopsis
22490
22491 @smallexample
22492 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
22493 @end smallexample
22494
22495 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
22496
22497 @smallexample
22498 numchild=@var{n}
22499 @end smallexample
22500
22501
22502 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
22503 @findex -var-list-children
22504
22505 @subsubheading Synopsis
22506
22507 @smallexample
22508 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
22509 @end smallexample
22510 @anchor{-var-list-children}
22511
22512 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
22513 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
22514 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
22515 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
22516 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
22517 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
22518 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
22519 and unions.
22520
22521 @subsubheading Example
22522
22523 @smallexample
22524 (gdb)
22525 -var-list-children n
22526 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
22527 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
22528 (gdb)
22529 -var-list-children --all-values n
22530 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
22531 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
22532 @end smallexample
22533
22534
22535 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
22536 @findex -var-info-type
22537
22538 @subsubheading Synopsis
22539
22540 @smallexample
22541 -var-info-type @var{name}
22542 @end smallexample
22543
22544 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
22545 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
22546 @value{GDBN} CLI:
22547
22548 @smallexample
22549 type=@var{typename}
22550 @end smallexample
22551
22552
22553 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
22554 @findex -var-info-expression
22555
22556 @subsubheading Synopsis
22557
22558 @smallexample
22559 -var-info-expression @var{name}
22560 @end smallexample
22561
22562 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
22563 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
22564 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
22565
22566 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
22567 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
22568
22569 @smallexample
22570 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
22571 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
22572 @end smallexample
22573
22574 @noindent
22575 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
22576
22577 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
22578 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
22579 is of limited use.
22580
22581 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
22582 @findex -var-info-path-expression
22583
22584 @subsubheading Synopsis
22585
22586 @smallexample
22587 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
22588 @end smallexample
22589
22590 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
22591 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
22592 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
22593 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
22594 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
22595 watchpoint from a variable object.
22596
22597 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
22598 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
22599 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
22600 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
22601 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
22602 @smallexample
22603 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
22604 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
22605 @end smallexample
22606
22607 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
22608 @findex -var-show-attributes
22609
22610 @subsubheading Synopsis
22611
22612 @smallexample
22613 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
22614 @end smallexample
22615
22616 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
22617
22618 @smallexample
22619 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
22620 @end smallexample
22621
22622 @noindent
22623 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
22624
22625 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
22626 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
22627
22628 @subsubheading Synopsis
22629
22630 @smallexample
22631 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
22632 @end smallexample
22633
22634 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
22635 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
22636 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
22637 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
22638 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
22639 the current display format will be used. The current display format
22640 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
22641
22642 @smallexample
22643 value=@var{value}
22644 @end smallexample
22645
22646 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
22647 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
22648
22649 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
22650 @findex -var-assign
22651
22652 @subsubheading Synopsis
22653
22654 @smallexample
22655 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
22656 @end smallexample
22657
22658 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
22659 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
22660 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
22661 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
22662
22663 @subsubheading Example
22664
22665 @smallexample
22666 (gdb)
22667 -var-assign var1 3
22668 ^done,value="3"
22669 (gdb)
22670 -var-update *
22671 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
22672 (gdb)
22673 @end smallexample
22674
22675 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
22676 @findex -var-update
22677
22678 @subsubheading Synopsis
22679
22680 @smallexample
22681 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
22682 @end smallexample
22683
22684 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
22685 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
22686 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
22687 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
22688 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
22689 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
22690 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
22691 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
22692 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
22693 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
22694 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
22695 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
22696 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
22697
22698 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
22699 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
22700 diagnostic.
22701
22702 @subsubheading Example
22703
22704 @smallexample
22705 (gdb)
22706 -var-assign var1 3
22707 ^done,value="3"
22708 (gdb)
22709 -var-update --all-values var1
22710 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
22711 type_changed="false"@}]
22712 (gdb)
22713 @end smallexample
22714
22715 @anchor{-var-update}
22716 The field in_scope may take three values:
22717
22718 @table @code
22719 @item "true"
22720 The variable object's current value is valid.
22721
22722 @item "false"
22723 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
22724 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
22725 scope.
22726
22727 @item "invalid"
22728 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
22729 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
22730 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
22731 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
22732 objects.
22733 @end table
22734
22735 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
22736 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
22737
22738 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
22739 @findex -var-set-frozen
22740 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
22741
22742 @subsubheading Synopsis
22743
22744 @smallexample
22745 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
22746 @end smallexample
22747
22748 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
22749 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
22750 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
22751 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
22752 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
22753 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
22754 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
22755 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
22756 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
22757 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
22758 @code{-var-update} does.
22759
22760 @subsubheading Example
22761
22762 @smallexample
22763 (gdb)
22764 -var-set-frozen V 1
22765 ^done
22766 (gdb)
22767 @end smallexample
22768
22769
22770 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22771 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
22772 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
22773
22774 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
22775 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
22776 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
22777 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
22778
22779 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
22780 @c @subheading -data-assign
22781 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
22782 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
22783 @c set variable
22784 @c @subsubheading Example
22785 @c N.A.
22786
22787 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
22788 @findex -data-disassemble
22789
22790 @subsubheading Synopsis
22791
22792 @smallexample
22793 -data-disassemble
22794 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
22795 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
22796 -- @var{mode}
22797 @end smallexample
22798
22799 @noindent
22800 Where:
22801
22802 @table @samp
22803 @item @var{start-addr}
22804 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
22805 @item @var{end-addr}
22806 is the end address
22807 @item @var{filename}
22808 is the name of the file to disassemble
22809 @item @var{linenum}
22810 is the line number to disassemble around
22811 @item @var{lines}
22812 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
22813 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
22814 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
22815 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
22816 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
22817 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
22818 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
22819 are displayed.
22820 @item @var{mode}
22821 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
22822 disassembly).
22823 @end table
22824
22825 @subsubheading Result
22826
22827 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
22828
22829 @itemize @bullet
22830 @item Address
22831 @item Func-name
22832 @item Offset
22833 @item Instruction
22834 @end itemize
22835
22836 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
22837 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
22838
22839 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22840
22841 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
22842
22843 @subsubheading Example
22844
22845 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
22846
22847 @smallexample
22848 (gdb)
22849 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
22850 ^done,
22851 asm_insns=[
22852 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22853 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22854 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22855 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
22856 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
22857 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
22858 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
22859 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
22860 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
22861 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
22862 (gdb)
22863 @end smallexample
22864
22865 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
22866 @code{main}.
22867
22868 @smallexample
22869 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
22870 ^done,asm_insns=[
22871 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
22872 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
22873 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22874 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22875 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22876 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
22877 [@dots{}]
22878 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
22879 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
22880 (gdb)
22881 @end smallexample
22882
22883 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
22884
22885 @smallexample
22886 (gdb)
22887 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
22888 ^done,asm_insns=[
22889 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
22890 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
22891 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22892 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22893 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22894 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
22895 (gdb)
22896 @end smallexample
22897
22898 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
22899
22900 @smallexample
22901 (gdb)
22902 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
22903 ^done,asm_insns=[
22904 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
22905 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
22906 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
22907 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
22908 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
22909 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
22910 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
22911 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
22912 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22913 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22914 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22915 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
22916 (gdb)
22917 @end smallexample
22918
22919
22920 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
22921 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
22922
22923 @subsubheading Synopsis
22924
22925 @smallexample
22926 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
22927 @end smallexample
22928
22929 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
22930 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
22931 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
22932
22933 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22934
22935 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
22936 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
22937 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
22938
22939 @subsubheading Example
22940
22941 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
22942 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
22943 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
22944 output.
22945
22946 @smallexample
22947 211-data-evaluate-expression A
22948 211^done,value="1"
22949 (gdb)
22950 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
22951 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
22952 (gdb)
22953 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
22954 411^done,value="4"
22955 (gdb)
22956 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
22957 511^done,value="4"
22958 (gdb)
22959 @end smallexample
22960
22961
22962 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
22963 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
22964
22965 @subsubheading Synopsis
22966
22967 @smallexample
22968 -data-list-changed-registers
22969 @end smallexample
22970
22971 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
22972
22973 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22974
22975 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
22976 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
22977
22978 @subsubheading Example
22979
22980 On a PPC MBX board:
22981
22982 @smallexample
22983 (gdb)
22984 -exec-continue
22985 ^running
22986
22987 (gdb)
22988 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
22989 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
22990 line="5"@}
22991 (gdb)
22992 -data-list-changed-registers
22993 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
22994 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
22995 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
22996 (gdb)
22997 @end smallexample
22998
22999
23000 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
23001 @findex -data-list-register-names
23002
23003 @subsubheading Synopsis
23004
23005 @smallexample
23006 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
23007 @end smallexample
23008
23009 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
23010 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
23011 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
23012 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
23013 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
23014 include empty register names.
23015
23016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23017
23018 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
23019 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
23020 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
23021
23022 @subsubheading Example
23023
23024 For the PPC MBX board:
23025 @smallexample
23026 (gdb)
23027 -data-list-register-names
23028 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
23029 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
23030 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
23031 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
23032 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
23033 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
23034 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
23035 (gdb)
23036 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
23037 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
23038 (gdb)
23039 @end smallexample
23040
23041 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
23042 @findex -data-list-register-values
23043
23044 @subsubheading Synopsis
23045
23046 @smallexample
23047 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
23048 @end smallexample
23049
23050 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
23051 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
23052 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
23053 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
23054
23055 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
23056
23057 @table @code
23058 @item x
23059 Hexadecimal
23060 @item o
23061 Octal
23062 @item t
23063 Binary
23064 @item d
23065 Decimal
23066 @item r
23067 Raw
23068 @item N
23069 Natural
23070 @end table
23071
23072 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23073
23074 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
23075 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
23076
23077 @subsubheading Example
23078
23079 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
23080 don't appear in the actual output):
23081
23082 @smallexample
23083 (gdb)
23084 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
23085 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
23086 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
23087 (gdb)
23088 -data-list-register-values x
23089 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
23090 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
23091 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
23092 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
23093 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
23094 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
23095 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
23096 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
23097 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
23098 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
23099 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
23100 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
23101 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
23102 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
23103 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
23104 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
23105 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
23106 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
23107 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
23108 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
23109 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
23110 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
23111 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
23112 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
23113 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
23114 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
23115 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
23116 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
23117 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
23118 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
23119 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
23120 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
23121 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
23122 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
23123 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
23124 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
23125 (gdb)
23126 @end smallexample
23127
23128
23129 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
23130 @findex -data-read-memory
23131
23132 @subsubheading Synopsis
23133
23134 @smallexample
23135 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
23136 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
23137 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
23138 @end smallexample
23139
23140 @noindent
23141 where:
23142
23143 @table @samp
23144 @item @var{address}
23145 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
23146 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
23147 quoted using the C convention.
23148
23149 @item @var{word-format}
23150 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
23151 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
23152 ,Output Formats}).
23153
23154 @item @var{word-size}
23155 The size of each memory word in bytes.
23156
23157 @item @var{nr-rows}
23158 The number of rows in the output table.
23159
23160 @item @var{nr-cols}
23161 The number of columns in the output table.
23162
23163 @item @var{aschar}
23164 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
23165 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
23166 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
23167 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
23168
23169 @item @var{byte-offset}
23170 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
23171 @end table
23172
23173 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
23174 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
23175 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
23176 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
23177 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
23178 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
23179 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
23180 @samp{addr}.
23181
23182 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
23183 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
23184 @samp{prev-page}.
23185
23186 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23187
23188 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
23189 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
23190
23191 @subsubheading Example
23192
23193 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
23194 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
23195 word. Display each word in hex.
23196
23197 @smallexample
23198 (gdb)
23199 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
23200 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
23201 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
23202 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
23203 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
23204 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
23205 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
23206 (gdb)
23207 @end smallexample
23208
23209 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
23210 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
23211
23212 @smallexample
23213 (gdb)
23214 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
23215 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
23216 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
23217 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
23218 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
23219 (gdb)
23220 @end smallexample
23221
23222 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
23223 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
23224 used as the non-printable character.
23225
23226 @smallexample
23227 (gdb)
23228 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
23229 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
23230 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
23231 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
23232 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
23233 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
23234 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
23235 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
23236 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
23237 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
23238 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
23239 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
23240 (gdb)
23241 @end smallexample
23242
23243 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23244 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
23245 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
23246
23247 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
23248
23249 @c @subheading -trace-actions
23250
23251 @c @subheading -trace-delete
23252
23253 @c @subheading -trace-disable
23254
23255 @c @subheading -trace-dump
23256
23257 @c @subheading -trace-enable
23258
23259 @c @subheading -trace-exists
23260
23261 @c @subheading -trace-find
23262
23263 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
23264
23265 @c @subheading -trace-info
23266
23267 @c @subheading -trace-insert
23268
23269 @c @subheading -trace-list
23270
23271 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
23272
23273 @c @subheading -trace-save
23274
23275 @c @subheading -trace-start
23276
23277 @c @subheading -trace-stop
23278
23279
23280 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23281 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
23282 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
23283
23284
23285 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
23286 @findex -symbol-info-address
23287
23288 @subsubheading Synopsis
23289
23290 @smallexample
23291 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
23292 @end smallexample
23293
23294 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
23295
23296 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23297
23298 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
23299
23300 @subsubheading Example
23301 N.A.
23302
23303
23304 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
23305 @findex -symbol-info-file
23306
23307 @subsubheading Synopsis
23308
23309 @smallexample
23310 -symbol-info-file
23311 @end smallexample
23312
23313 Show the file for the symbol.
23314
23315 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23316
23317 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
23318 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
23319
23320 @subsubheading Example
23321 N.A.
23322
23323
23324 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
23325 @findex -symbol-info-function
23326
23327 @subsubheading Synopsis
23328
23329 @smallexample
23330 -symbol-info-function
23331 @end smallexample
23332
23333 Show which function the symbol lives in.
23334
23335 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23336
23337 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
23338
23339 @subsubheading Example
23340 N.A.
23341
23342
23343 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
23344 @findex -symbol-info-line
23345
23346 @subsubheading Synopsis
23347
23348 @smallexample
23349 -symbol-info-line
23350 @end smallexample
23351
23352 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
23353
23354 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23355
23356 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
23357 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
23358
23359 @subsubheading Example
23360 N.A.
23361
23362
23363 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
23364 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
23365
23366 @subsubheading Synopsis
23367
23368 @smallexample
23369 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
23370 @end smallexample
23371
23372 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
23373
23374 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23375
23376 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
23377
23378 @subsubheading Example
23379 N.A.
23380
23381
23382 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
23383 @findex -symbol-list-functions
23384
23385 @subsubheading Synopsis
23386
23387 @smallexample
23388 -symbol-list-functions
23389 @end smallexample
23390
23391 List the functions in the executable.
23392
23393 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23394
23395 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
23396 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
23397
23398 @subsubheading Example
23399 N.A.
23400
23401
23402 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
23403 @findex -symbol-list-lines
23404
23405 @subsubheading Synopsis
23406
23407 @smallexample
23408 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
23409 @end smallexample
23410
23411 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
23412 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
23413 ascending PC order.
23414
23415 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23416
23417 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
23418
23419 @subsubheading Example
23420 @smallexample
23421 (gdb)
23422 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
23423 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
23424 (gdb)
23425 @end smallexample
23426
23427
23428 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
23429 @findex -symbol-list-types
23430
23431 @subsubheading Synopsis
23432
23433 @smallexample
23434 -symbol-list-types
23435 @end smallexample
23436
23437 List all the type names.
23438
23439 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23440
23441 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
23442 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
23443
23444 @subsubheading Example
23445 N.A.
23446
23447
23448 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
23449 @findex -symbol-list-variables
23450
23451 @subsubheading Synopsis
23452
23453 @smallexample
23454 -symbol-list-variables
23455 @end smallexample
23456
23457 List all the global and static variable names.
23458
23459 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23460
23461 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
23462
23463 @subsubheading Example
23464 N.A.
23465
23466
23467 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
23468 @findex -symbol-locate
23469
23470 @subsubheading Synopsis
23471
23472 @smallexample
23473 -symbol-locate
23474 @end smallexample
23475
23476 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23477
23478 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
23479
23480 @subsubheading Example
23481 N.A.
23482
23483
23484 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
23485 @findex -symbol-type
23486
23487 @subsubheading Synopsis
23488
23489 @smallexample
23490 -symbol-type @var{variable}
23491 @end smallexample
23492
23493 Show type of @var{variable}.
23494
23495 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23496
23497 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
23498 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
23499
23500 @subsubheading Example
23501 N.A.
23502
23503
23504 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23505 @node GDB/MI File Commands
23506 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
23507
23508 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
23509 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
23510
23511 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
23512 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
23513
23514 @subsubheading Synopsis
23515
23516 @smallexample
23517 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
23518 @end smallexample
23519
23520 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
23521 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
23522 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
23523 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
23524 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
23525 notification.
23526
23527 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23528
23529 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
23530
23531 @subsubheading Example
23532
23533 @smallexample
23534 (gdb)
23535 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
23536 ^done
23537 (gdb)
23538 @end smallexample
23539
23540
23541 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
23542 @findex -file-exec-file
23543
23544 @subsubheading Synopsis
23545
23546 @smallexample
23547 -file-exec-file @var{file}
23548 @end smallexample
23549
23550 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
23551 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
23552 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
23553 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
23554 notification.
23555
23556 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23557
23558 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
23559
23560 @subsubheading Example
23561
23562 @smallexample
23563 (gdb)
23564 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
23565 ^done
23566 (gdb)
23567 @end smallexample
23568
23569
23570 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
23571 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
23572
23573 @subsubheading Synopsis
23574
23575 @smallexample
23576 -file-list-exec-sections
23577 @end smallexample
23578
23579 List the sections of the current executable file.
23580
23581 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23582
23583 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
23584 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
23585 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
23586
23587 @subsubheading Example
23588 N.A.
23589
23590
23591 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
23592 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
23593
23594 @subsubheading Synopsis
23595
23596 @smallexample
23597 -file-list-exec-source-file
23598 @end smallexample
23599
23600 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
23601 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
23602 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
23603 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
23604
23605 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23606
23607 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
23608
23609 @subsubheading Example
23610
23611 @smallexample
23612 (gdb)
23613 123-file-list-exec-source-file
23614 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
23615 (gdb)
23616 @end smallexample
23617
23618
23619 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
23620 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
23621
23622 @subsubheading Synopsis
23623
23624 @smallexample
23625 -file-list-exec-source-files
23626 @end smallexample
23627
23628 List the source files for the current executable.
23629
23630 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
23631 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
23632
23633 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23634
23635 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
23636 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
23637
23638 @subsubheading Example
23639 @smallexample
23640 (gdb)
23641 -file-list-exec-source-files
23642 ^done,files=[
23643 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
23644 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
23645 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
23646 (gdb)
23647 @end smallexample
23648
23649 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
23650 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
23651
23652 @subsubheading Synopsis
23653
23654 @smallexample
23655 -file-list-shared-libraries
23656 @end smallexample
23657
23658 List the shared libraries in the program.
23659
23660 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23661
23662 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
23663
23664 @subsubheading Example
23665 N.A.
23666
23667
23668 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
23669 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
23670
23671 @subsubheading Synopsis
23672
23673 @smallexample
23674 -file-list-symbol-files
23675 @end smallexample
23676
23677 List symbol files.
23678
23679 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23680
23681 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
23682
23683 @subsubheading Example
23684 N.A.
23685
23686
23687 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
23688 @findex -file-symbol-file
23689
23690 @subsubheading Synopsis
23691
23692 @smallexample
23693 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
23694 @end smallexample
23695
23696 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
23697 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
23698 produced, except for a completion notification.
23699
23700 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23701
23702 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
23703
23704 @subsubheading Example
23705
23706 @smallexample
23707 (gdb)
23708 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
23709 ^done
23710 (gdb)
23711 @end smallexample
23712
23713 @ignore
23714 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23715 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
23716 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
23717
23718 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
23719
23720 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
23721
23722 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
23723
23724 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
23725
23726 @c @subheading -overlay-map
23727
23728 @c @subheading -overlay-off
23729
23730 @c @subheading -overlay-on
23731
23732 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
23733
23734 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23735 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
23736 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
23737
23738 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
23739
23740 @c @subheading -signal-handle
23741
23742 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
23743
23744 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
23745 @end ignore
23746
23747
23748 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23749 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
23750 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
23751
23752
23753 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
23754 @findex -target-attach
23755
23756 @subsubheading Synopsis
23757
23758 @smallexample
23759 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
23760 @end smallexample
23761
23762 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
23763 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
23764 group, the id previously returned by
23765 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
23766
23767 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23768
23769 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
23770
23771 @subsubheading Example
23772 @smallexample
23773 (gdb)
23774 -target-attach 34
23775 =thread-created,id="1"
23776 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
23777 ^done
23778 (gdb)
23779 @end smallexample
23780
23781 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
23782 @findex -target-compare-sections
23783
23784 @subsubheading Synopsis
23785
23786 @smallexample
23787 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
23788 @end smallexample
23789
23790 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
23791 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
23792
23793 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23794
23795 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
23796
23797 @subsubheading Example
23798 N.A.
23799
23800
23801 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
23802 @findex -target-detach
23803
23804 @subsubheading Synopsis
23805
23806 @smallexample
23807 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
23808 @end smallexample
23809
23810 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
23811 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
23812 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
23813
23814 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23815
23816 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
23817
23818 @subsubheading Example
23819
23820 @smallexample
23821 (gdb)
23822 -target-detach
23823 ^done
23824 (gdb)
23825 @end smallexample
23826
23827
23828 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
23829 @findex -target-disconnect
23830
23831 @subsubheading Synopsis
23832
23833 @smallexample
23834 -target-disconnect
23835 @end smallexample
23836
23837 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
23838 generally not resumed.
23839
23840 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23841
23842 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
23843
23844 @subsubheading Example
23845
23846 @smallexample
23847 (gdb)
23848 -target-disconnect
23849 ^done
23850 (gdb)
23851 @end smallexample
23852
23853
23854 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
23855 @findex -target-download
23856
23857 @subsubheading Synopsis
23858
23859 @smallexample
23860 -target-download
23861 @end smallexample
23862
23863 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
23864 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
23865
23866 @table @samp
23867 @item section
23868 The name of the section.
23869 @item section-sent
23870 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
23871 @item section-size
23872 The size of the section.
23873 @item total-sent
23874 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
23875 @item total-size
23876 The size of the overall executable to download.
23877 @end table
23878
23879 @noindent
23880 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
23881 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
23882
23883 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
23884 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
23885
23886 @table @samp
23887 @item section
23888 The name of the section.
23889 @item section-size
23890 The size of the section.
23891 @item total-size
23892 The size of the overall executable to download.
23893 @end table
23894
23895 @noindent
23896 At the end, a summary is printed.
23897
23898 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23899
23900 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
23901
23902 @subsubheading Example
23903
23904 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
23905 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
23906
23907 @smallexample
23908 (gdb)
23909 -target-download
23910 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
23911 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
23912 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
23913 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
23914 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
23915 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
23916 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
23917 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
23918 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
23919 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
23920 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
23921 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
23922 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
23923 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
23924 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
23925 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
23926 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
23927 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
23928 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
23929 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
23930 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
23931 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
23932 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
23933 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
23934 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
23935 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
23936 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
23937 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
23938 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
23939 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
23940 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
23941 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
23942 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
23943 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
23944 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
23945 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
23946 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
23947 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
23948 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
23949 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
23950 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
23951 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
23952 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
23953 write-rate="429"
23954 (gdb)
23955 @end smallexample
23956
23957
23958 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
23959 @findex -target-exec-status
23960
23961 @subsubheading Synopsis
23962
23963 @smallexample
23964 -target-exec-status
23965 @end smallexample
23966
23967 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
23968 not, for instance).
23969
23970 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23971
23972 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
23973
23974 @subsubheading Example
23975 N.A.
23976
23977
23978 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
23979 @findex -target-list-available-targets
23980
23981 @subsubheading Synopsis
23982
23983 @smallexample
23984 -target-list-available-targets
23985 @end smallexample
23986
23987 List the possible targets to connect to.
23988
23989 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23990
23991 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
23992
23993 @subsubheading Example
23994 N.A.
23995
23996
23997 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
23998 @findex -target-list-current-targets
23999
24000 @subsubheading Synopsis
24001
24002 @smallexample
24003 -target-list-current-targets
24004 @end smallexample
24005
24006 Describe the current target.
24007
24008 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24009
24010 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
24011 other things).
24012
24013 @subsubheading Example
24014 N.A.
24015
24016
24017 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
24018 @findex -target-list-parameters
24019
24020 @subsubheading Synopsis
24021
24022 @smallexample
24023 -target-list-parameters
24024 @end smallexample
24025
24026 @c ????
24027
24028 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24029
24030 No equivalent.
24031
24032 @subsubheading Example
24033 N.A.
24034
24035
24036 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
24037 @findex -target-select
24038
24039 @subsubheading Synopsis
24040
24041 @smallexample
24042 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
24043 @end smallexample
24044
24045 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
24046
24047 @table @samp
24048 @item @var{type}
24049 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
24050 @item @var{parameters}
24051 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
24052 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
24053 @end table
24054
24055 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
24056 which the target program is, in the following form:
24057
24058 @smallexample
24059 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
24060 args=[@var{arg list}]
24061 @end smallexample
24062
24063 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24064
24065 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
24066
24067 @subsubheading Example
24068
24069 @smallexample
24070 (gdb)
24071 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
24072 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
24073 (gdb)
24074 @end smallexample
24075
24076 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24077 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
24078 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
24079
24080
24081 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
24082 @findex -target-file-put
24083
24084 @subsubheading Synopsis
24085
24086 @smallexample
24087 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
24088 @end smallexample
24089
24090 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
24091 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
24092
24093 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24094
24095 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
24096
24097 @subsubheading Example
24098
24099 @smallexample
24100 (gdb)
24101 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
24102 ^done
24103 (gdb)
24104 @end smallexample
24105
24106
24107 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
24108 @findex -target-file-get
24109
24110 @subsubheading Synopsis
24111
24112 @smallexample
24113 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
24114 @end smallexample
24115
24116 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
24117 on the host system.
24118
24119 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24120
24121 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
24122
24123 @subsubheading Example
24124
24125 @smallexample
24126 (gdb)
24127 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
24128 ^done
24129 (gdb)
24130 @end smallexample
24131
24132
24133 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
24134 @findex -target-file-delete
24135
24136 @subsubheading Synopsis
24137
24138 @smallexample
24139 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
24140 @end smallexample
24141
24142 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
24143
24144 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24145
24146 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
24147
24148 @subsubheading Example
24149
24150 @smallexample
24151 (gdb)
24152 -target-file-delete remotefile
24153 ^done
24154 (gdb)
24155 @end smallexample
24156
24157
24158 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24159 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
24160 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
24161
24162 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
24163
24164 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
24165 @findex -gdb-exit
24166
24167 @subsubheading Synopsis
24168
24169 @smallexample
24170 -gdb-exit
24171 @end smallexample
24172
24173 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
24174
24175 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24176
24177 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
24178
24179 @subsubheading Example
24180
24181 @smallexample
24182 (gdb)
24183 -gdb-exit
24184 ^exit
24185 @end smallexample
24186
24187
24188 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
24189 @findex -exec-abort
24190
24191 @subsubheading Synopsis
24192
24193 @smallexample
24194 -exec-abort
24195 @end smallexample
24196
24197 Kill the inferior running program.
24198
24199 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24200
24201 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
24202
24203 @subsubheading Example
24204 N.A.
24205
24206
24207 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
24208 @findex -gdb-set
24209
24210 @subsubheading Synopsis
24211
24212 @smallexample
24213 -gdb-set
24214 @end smallexample
24215
24216 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
24217 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
24218
24219 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24220
24221 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
24222
24223 @subsubheading Example
24224
24225 @smallexample
24226 (gdb)
24227 -gdb-set $foo=3
24228 ^done
24229 (gdb)
24230 @end smallexample
24231
24232
24233 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
24234 @findex -gdb-show
24235
24236 @subsubheading Synopsis
24237
24238 @smallexample
24239 -gdb-show
24240 @end smallexample
24241
24242 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
24243
24244 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24245
24246 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
24247
24248 @subsubheading Example
24249
24250 @smallexample
24251 (gdb)
24252 -gdb-show annotate
24253 ^done,value="0"
24254 (gdb)
24255 @end smallexample
24256
24257 @c @subheading -gdb-source
24258
24259
24260 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
24261 @findex -gdb-version
24262
24263 @subsubheading Synopsis
24264
24265 @smallexample
24266 -gdb-version
24267 @end smallexample
24268
24269 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
24270
24271 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24272
24273 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
24274 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
24275
24276 @subsubheading Example
24277
24278 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
24279 @c box in TeX.
24280 @smallexample
24281 (gdb)
24282 -gdb-version
24283 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
24284 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
24285 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
24286 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
24287 ~ certain conditions.
24288 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
24289 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
24290 ~ details.
24291 ~This GDB was configured as
24292 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
24293 ^done
24294 (gdb)
24295 @end smallexample
24296
24297 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
24298 @findex -list-features
24299
24300 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
24301 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
24302 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
24303 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
24304 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
24305 startup.
24306
24307 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
24308 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
24309 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
24310 is given below.
24311
24312 Example output:
24313
24314 @smallexample
24315 (gdb) -list-features
24316 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
24317 @end smallexample
24318
24319 The current list of features is:
24320
24321 @table @samp
24322 @item frozen-varobjs
24323 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
24324 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
24325 of @code{-varobj-create}.
24326 @item pending-breakpoints
24327 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
24328 @item thread-info
24329 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
24330
24331 @end table
24332
24333 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
24334 @findex -list-target-features
24335
24336 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
24337 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
24338 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
24339 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
24340 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
24341 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
24342 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
24343 Example output:
24344
24345 @smallexample
24346 (gdb) -list-features
24347 ^done,result=["async"]
24348 @end smallexample
24349
24350 The current list of features is:
24351
24352 @table @samp
24353 @item async
24354 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
24355 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
24356 while the target is running.
24357
24358 @end table
24359
24360 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
24361 @findex -list-thread-groups
24362
24363 @subheading Synopsis
24364
24365 @smallexample
24366 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ @var{group} ]
24367 @end smallexample
24368
24369 When used without the @var{group} parameter, lists top-level thread
24370 groups that are being debugged. When used with the @var{group}
24371 parameter, the children of the specified group are listed. The
24372 children can be either threads, or other groups. At present,
24373 @value{GDBN} will not report both threads and groups as children at
24374 the same time, but it may change in future.
24375
24376 With the @samp{--available} option, instead of reporting groups that
24377 are been debugged, GDB will report all thread groups available on the
24378 target. Using the @samp{--available} option together with @var{group}
24379 is not allowed.
24380
24381 @subheading Example
24382
24383 @smallexample
24384 @value{GDBP}
24385 -list-thread-groups
24386 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
24387 -list-thread-groups 17
24388 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
24389 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
24390 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
24391 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
24392 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
24393 @end smallexample
24394
24395 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
24396 @findex -interpreter-exec
24397
24398 @subheading Synopsis
24399
24400 @smallexample
24401 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
24402 @end smallexample
24403 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
24404
24405 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
24406
24407 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
24408
24409 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
24410
24411 @subheading Example
24412
24413 @smallexample
24414 (gdb)
24415 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
24416 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
24417 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
24418 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
24419 ^done
24420 (gdb)
24421 @end smallexample
24422
24423 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
24424 @findex -inferior-tty-set
24425
24426 @subheading Synopsis
24427
24428 @smallexample
24429 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
24430 @end smallexample
24431
24432 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
24433
24434 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
24435
24436 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
24437
24438 @subheading Example
24439
24440 @smallexample
24441 (gdb)
24442 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
24443 ^done
24444 (gdb)
24445 @end smallexample
24446
24447 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
24448 @findex -inferior-tty-show
24449
24450 @subheading Synopsis
24451
24452 @smallexample
24453 -inferior-tty-show
24454 @end smallexample
24455
24456 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
24457
24458 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
24459
24460 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
24461
24462 @subheading Example
24463
24464 @smallexample
24465 (gdb)
24466 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
24467 ^done
24468 (gdb)
24469 -inferior-tty-show
24470 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
24471 (gdb)
24472 @end smallexample
24473
24474 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
24475 @findex -enable-timings
24476
24477 @subheading Synopsis
24478
24479 @smallexample
24480 -enable-timings [yes | no]
24481 @end smallexample
24482
24483 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
24484 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
24485 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
24486 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
24487
24488 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
24489
24490 No equivalent.
24491
24492 @subheading Example
24493
24494 @smallexample
24495 (gdb)
24496 -enable-timings
24497 ^done
24498 (gdb)
24499 -break-insert main
24500 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24501 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
24502 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
24503 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
24504 (gdb)
24505 -enable-timings no
24506 ^done
24507 (gdb)
24508 -exec-run
24509 ^running
24510 (gdb)
24511 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
24512 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
24513 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
24514 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
24515 (gdb)
24516 @end smallexample
24517
24518 @node Annotations
24519 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
24520
24521 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
24522 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
24523 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
24524 relatively high level.
24525
24526 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
24527 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
24528
24529 @ignore
24530 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
24531 @end ignore
24532
24533 @menu
24534 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
24535 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
24536 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
24537 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
24538 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
24539 * Annotations for Running::
24540 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
24541 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
24542 @end menu
24543
24544 @node Annotations Overview
24545 @section What is an Annotation?
24546 @cindex annotations
24547
24548 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
24549 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
24550 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
24551 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
24552 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
24553 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
24554 cannot contain newline characters.
24555
24556 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
24557 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
24558 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
24559 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
24560 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
24561 means those three characters as output.
24562
24563 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
24564 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
24565 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
24566 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
24567 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
24568 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
24569 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
24570 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
24571 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
24572
24573 @table @code
24574 @kindex set annotate
24575 @item set annotate @var{level}
24576 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
24577 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
24578
24579 @item show annotate
24580 @kindex show annotate
24581 Show the current annotation level.
24582 @end table
24583
24584 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
24585
24586 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
24587
24588 @smallexample
24589 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
24590 GNU gdb 6.0
24591 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
24592 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
24593 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
24594 under certain conditions.
24595 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
24596 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
24597 for details.
24598 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
24599
24600 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
24601 (@value{GDBP})
24602 ^Z^Zprompt
24603 @kbd{quit}
24604
24605 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
24606 $
24607 @end smallexample
24608
24609 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
24610 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
24611 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
24612 output from @value{GDBN}.
24613
24614 @node Server Prefix
24615 @section The Server Prefix
24616 @cindex server prefix
24617
24618 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
24619 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
24620 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
24621 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
24622 a transparent manner.
24623
24624 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24625 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24626 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24627
24628 @node Prompting
24629 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
24630
24631 @cindex annotations for prompts
24632 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
24633 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
24634 over, etc.
24635
24636 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
24637 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
24638 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
24639 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
24640 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
24641 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
24642 features the following annotations:
24643
24644 @smallexample
24645 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
24646 ^Z^Zprompt
24647 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
24648 @end smallexample
24649
24650 The input types are
24651
24652 @table @code
24653 @findex pre-prompt annotation
24654 @findex prompt annotation
24655 @findex post-prompt annotation
24656 @item prompt
24657 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
24658
24659 @findex pre-commands annotation
24660 @findex commands annotation
24661 @findex post-commands annotation
24662 @item commands
24663 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
24664 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
24665
24666 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
24667 @findex overload-choice annotation
24668 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
24669 @item overload-choice
24670 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
24671
24672 @findex pre-query annotation
24673 @findex query annotation
24674 @findex post-query annotation
24675 @item query
24676 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
24677
24678 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
24679 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
24680 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
24681 @item prompt-for-continue
24682 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
24683 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
24684 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
24685 presence of annotations.
24686 @end table
24687
24688 @node Errors
24689 @section Errors
24690 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
24691
24692 @findex quit annotation
24693 @smallexample
24694 ^Z^Zquit
24695 @end smallexample
24696
24697 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
24698
24699 @findex error annotation
24700 @smallexample
24701 ^Z^Zerror
24702 @end smallexample
24703
24704 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
24705
24706 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
24707 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
24708 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
24709 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
24710 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
24711 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
24712 to the top level.
24713
24714 @findex error-begin annotation
24715 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
24716
24717 @smallexample
24718 ^Z^Zerror-begin
24719 @end smallexample
24720
24721 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
24722 message.
24723
24724 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
24725 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
24726 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
24727
24728 @node Invalidation
24729 @section Invalidation Notices
24730
24731 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
24732 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
24733 changed.
24734
24735 @table @code
24736 @findex frames-invalid annotation
24737 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
24738
24739 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
24740 have changed.
24741
24742 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
24743 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
24744
24745 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
24746 deleted a breakpoint.
24747 @end table
24748
24749 @node Annotations for Running
24750 @section Running the Program
24751 @cindex annotations for running programs
24752
24753 @findex starting annotation
24754 @findex stopping annotation
24755 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
24756 @code{step} or @code{continue},
24757
24758 @smallexample
24759 ^Z^Zstarting
24760 @end smallexample
24761
24762 is output. When the program stops,
24763
24764 @smallexample
24765 ^Z^Zstopped
24766 @end smallexample
24767
24768 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
24769 annotations describe how the program stopped.
24770
24771 @table @code
24772 @findex exited annotation
24773 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
24774 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
24775 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
24776
24777 @findex signalled annotation
24778 @findex signal-name annotation
24779 @findex signal-name-end annotation
24780 @findex signal-string annotation
24781 @findex signal-string-end annotation
24782 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
24783 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
24784 annotation continues:
24785
24786 @smallexample
24787 @var{intro-text}
24788 ^Z^Zsignal-name
24789 @var{name}
24790 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
24791 @var{middle-text}
24792 ^Z^Zsignal-string
24793 @var{string}
24794 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
24795 @var{end-text}
24796 @end smallexample
24797
24798 @noindent
24799 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
24800 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
24801 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
24802 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
24803 user's benefit and have no particular format.
24804
24805 @findex signal annotation
24806 @item ^Z^Zsignal
24807 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
24808 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
24809 terminated with it.
24810
24811 @findex breakpoint annotation
24812 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
24813 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
24814
24815 @findex watchpoint annotation
24816 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
24817 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
24818 @end table
24819
24820 @node Source Annotations
24821 @section Displaying Source
24822 @cindex annotations for source display
24823
24824 @findex source annotation
24825 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
24826
24827 @smallexample
24828 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
24829 @end smallexample
24830
24831 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
24832 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
24833 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
24834 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
24835 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
24836 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
24837 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
24838 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
24839 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
24840 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
24841 depend on the language).
24842
24843 @node GDB Bugs
24844 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
24845 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
24846 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
24847
24848 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
24849
24850 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
24851 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
24852 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
24853 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
24854
24855 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
24856 information that enables us to fix the bug.
24857
24858 @menu
24859 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
24860 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
24861 @end menu
24862
24863 @node Bug Criteria
24864 @section Have You Found a Bug?
24865 @cindex bug criteria
24866
24867 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
24868
24869 @itemize @bullet
24870 @cindex fatal signal
24871 @cindex debugger crash
24872 @cindex crash of debugger
24873 @item
24874 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
24875 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
24876
24877 @cindex error on valid input
24878 @item
24879 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
24880 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
24881 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
24882
24883 @cindex invalid input
24884 @item
24885 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
24886 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
24887 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
24888 for traditional practice''.
24889
24890 @item
24891 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
24892 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
24893 @end itemize
24894
24895 @node Bug Reporting
24896 @section How to Report Bugs
24897 @cindex bug reports
24898 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
24899
24900 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
24901 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
24902 contact that organization first.
24903
24904 You can find contact information for many support companies and
24905 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
24906 distribution.
24907 @c should add a web page ref...
24908
24909 @ifset BUGURL
24910 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
24911 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
24912 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
24913 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
24914 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
24915 be used.
24916
24917 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
24918 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
24919 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
24920 @samp{bug-gdb}.
24921
24922 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
24923 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
24924 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
24925 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
24926 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
24927 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
24928 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
24929 bug reports to the mailing list.
24930 @end ifset
24931 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
24932 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
24933 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
24934 @end ifclear
24935 @end ifset
24936
24937 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
24938 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
24939 fact or leave it out, state it!
24940
24941 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
24942 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
24943 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
24944 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
24945 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
24946 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
24947 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
24948 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
24949 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
24950
24951 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
24952 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
24953 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
24954 self-contained.
24955
24956 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
24957 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
24958 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
24959 bugs properly.
24960
24961 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
24962
24963 @itemize @bullet
24964 @item
24965 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
24966 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
24967 version}.
24968
24969 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
24970 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
24971
24972 @item
24973 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
24974 version number.
24975
24976 @item
24977 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
24978 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
24979
24980 @item
24981 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
24982 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
24983 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
24984 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
24985 those compilers.
24986
24987 @item
24988 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
24989 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
24990 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
24991 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
24992
24993 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
24994 and then we might not encounter the bug.
24995
24996 @item
24997 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
24998 reproduce the bug.
24999
25000 @item
25001 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
25002 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
25003
25004 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
25005 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
25006 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
25007 a chance to make a mistake.
25008
25009 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
25010 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
25011 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
25012 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
25013 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
25014 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
25015 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
25016 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
25017
25018 @pindex script
25019 @cindex recording a session script
25020 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
25021 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
25022 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
25023 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
25024
25025 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
25026 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
25027
25028 @item
25029 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
25030 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
25031 it by context, not by line number.
25032
25033 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
25034 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
25035
25036 @end itemize
25037
25038 Here are some things that are not necessary:
25039
25040 @itemize @bullet
25041 @item
25042 A description of the envelope of the bug.
25043
25044 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
25045 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
25046 changes will not affect it.
25047
25048 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
25049 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
25050 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
25051 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
25052
25053 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
25054 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
25055 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
25056 less time, and so on.
25057
25058 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
25059 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
25060
25061 @item
25062 A patch for the bug.
25063
25064 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
25065 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
25066 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
25067 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
25068
25069 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
25070 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
25071 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
25072 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
25073
25074 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
25075 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
25076 help us to understand.
25077
25078 @item
25079 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
25080
25081 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
25082 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
25083 @end itemize
25084
25085 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
25086 @c and consists of the two following files:
25087 @c rluser.texinfo
25088 @c inc-hist.texinfo
25089 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
25090 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
25091 @include rluser.texi
25092 @include inc-hist.texinfo
25093
25094
25095 @node Formatting Documentation
25096 @appendix Formatting Documentation
25097
25098 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
25099 @cindex reference card
25100 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
25101 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
25102 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
25103 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
25104 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
25105 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
25106
25107 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
25108 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
25109
25110 @smallexample
25111 make refcard.dvi
25112 @end smallexample
25113
25114 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
25115 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
25116 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
25117 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
25118 your @sc{dvi} output program.
25119
25120 @cindex documentation
25121
25122 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
25123 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
25124 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
25125 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
25126 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
25127 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
25128
25129 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
25130 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
25131 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
25132 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
25133 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
25134 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
25135 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
25136 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
25137
25138 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
25139 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
25140 @code{makeinfo}.
25141
25142 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
25143 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
25144 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
25145
25146 @smallexample
25147 cd gdb
25148 make gdb.info
25149 @end smallexample
25150
25151 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
25152 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
25153 Texinfo definitions file.
25154
25155 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
25156 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
25157 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
25158 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
25159 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
25160 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
25161 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
25162
25163 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
25164 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
25165 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
25166 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
25167 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
25168 directory.
25169
25170 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
25171 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
25172 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
25173 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
25174
25175 @smallexample
25176 make gdb.dvi
25177 @end smallexample
25178
25179 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
25180
25181 @node Installing GDB
25182 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
25183 @cindex installation
25184
25185 @menu
25186 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
25187 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
25188 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
25189 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
25190 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
25191 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
25192 @end menu
25193
25194 @node Requirements
25195 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
25196 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
25197
25198 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
25199 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
25200
25201 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
25202 @table @asis
25203 @item ISO C90 compiler
25204 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
25205 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
25206
25207 @end table
25208
25209 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
25210 @table @asis
25211 @item Expat
25212 @anchor{Expat}
25213 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
25214 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
25215 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
25216 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
25217 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
25218 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
25219
25220 Expat is used for:
25221
25222 @itemize @bullet
25223 @item
25224 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
25225 @item
25226 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
25227 @item
25228 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
25229 @item
25230 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
25231 @end itemize
25232
25233 @item zlib
25234 @cindex compressed debug sections
25235 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
25236 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
25237 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
25238 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
25239 information in such binaries.
25240
25241 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
25242 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
25243 @url{http://zlib.net}.
25244
25245 @item iconv
25246 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
25247 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
25248 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
25249 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
25250
25251 On systems with @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
25252 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
25253 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
25254
25255 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
25256 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
25257 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
25258 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
25259 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
25260 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
25261 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
25262 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
25263 @end table
25264
25265 @node Running Configure
25266 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
25267 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
25268 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
25269 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
25270 build the @code{gdb} program.
25271 @iftex
25272 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
25273 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
25274 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
25275 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
25276 @end iftex
25277
25278 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
25279 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
25280 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
25281
25282 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
25283 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
25284
25285 @table @code
25286 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
25287 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
25288
25289 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
25290 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
25291
25292 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
25293 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
25294
25295 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
25296 @sc{gnu} include files
25297
25298 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
25299 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
25300
25301 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
25302 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
25303
25304 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
25305 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
25306
25307 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
25308 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
25309
25310 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
25311 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
25312 @end table
25313
25314 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
25315 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
25316 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
25317
25318 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
25319 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
25320 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
25321 argument.
25322
25323 For example:
25324
25325 @smallexample
25326 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
25327 ./configure @var{host}
25328 make
25329 @end smallexample
25330
25331 @noindent
25332 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
25333 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
25334 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
25335 correct value by examining your system.)
25336
25337 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
25338 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
25339 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
25340 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
25341
25342 @need 750
25343 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
25344 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
25345 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
25346
25347 @smallexample
25348 sh configure @var{host}
25349 @end smallexample
25350
25351 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
25352 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
25353 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
25354 @file{configure}
25355 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
25356 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
25357
25358 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
25359 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
25360 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
25361 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
25362 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
25363 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
25364 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
25365 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
25366 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
25367
25368 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
25369 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
25370 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
25371 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
25372 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
25373
25374 @node Separate Objdir
25375 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
25376
25377 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
25378 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
25379 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
25380 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
25381 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
25382 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
25383 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
25384 program specified there.
25385
25386 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
25387 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
25388 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
25389 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
25390 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
25391 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
25392
25393 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
25394 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
25395
25396 @smallexample
25397 @group
25398 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
25399 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
25400 cd ../gdb-sun4
25401 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
25402 make
25403 @end group
25404 @end smallexample
25405
25406 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
25407 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
25408 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
25409 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
25410 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
25411 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
25412
25413 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
25414 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
25415 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
25416 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
25417 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
25418
25419 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
25420 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
25421 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
25422 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
25423 You specify a cross-debugging target by
25424 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
25425
25426 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
25427 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
25428 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
25429
25430 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
25431 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
25432 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
25433 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
25434 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
25435
25436 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
25437 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
25438 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
25439 with each other.
25440
25441 @node Config Names
25442 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
25443
25444 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
25445 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
25446 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
25447 of information in the following pattern:
25448
25449 @smallexample
25450 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
25451 @end smallexample
25452
25453 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
25454 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
25455 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
25456
25457 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
25458 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
25459 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
25460 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
25461 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
25462 abbreviations---for example:
25463
25464 @smallexample
25465 % sh config.sub i386-linux
25466 i386-pc-linux-gnu
25467 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
25468 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
25469 % sh config.sub hp9k700
25470 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
25471 % sh config.sub sun4
25472 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
25473 % sh config.sub sun3
25474 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
25475 % sh config.sub i986v
25476 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
25477 @end smallexample
25478
25479 @noindent
25480 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
25481 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
25482
25483 @node Configure Options
25484 @section @file{configure} Options
25485
25486 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
25487 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
25488 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
25489 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
25490
25491 @smallexample
25492 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
25493 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
25494 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
25495 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
25496 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
25497 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
25498 @var{host}
25499 @end smallexample
25500
25501 @noindent
25502 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
25503 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
25504 @samp{--}.
25505
25506 @table @code
25507 @item --help
25508 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
25509
25510 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
25511 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
25512 @file{@var{dir}}.
25513
25514 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
25515 Configure the source to install programs under directory
25516 @file{@var{dir}}.
25517
25518 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
25519 @need 2000
25520 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
25521 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
25522 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
25523 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
25524 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
25525 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
25526 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
25527 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
25528 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
25529 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
25530 @var{dirname}.
25531
25532 @item --norecursion
25533 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
25534 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
25535
25536 @item --target=@var{target}
25537 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
25538 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
25539 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
25540
25541 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
25542
25543 @item @var{host} @dots{}
25544 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
25545
25546 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
25547 @end table
25548
25549 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
25550 needed for special purposes only.
25551
25552 @node System-wide configuration
25553 @section System-wide configuration and settings
25554 @cindex system-wide init file
25555
25556 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
25557 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
25558 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
25559
25560 Here is the corresponding configure option:
25561
25562 @table @code
25563 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
25564 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
25565 @var{file}.
25566 @end table
25567
25568 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
25569 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
25570
25571 @itemize @bullet
25572 @item
25573 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
25574 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
25575 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
25576 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
25577 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
25578 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
25579
25580 @item
25581 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
25582 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
25583 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
25584 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
25585 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
25586 @end itemize
25587
25588 @node Maintenance Commands
25589 @appendix Maintenance Commands
25590 @cindex maintenance commands
25591 @cindex internal commands
25592
25593 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
25594 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
25595 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
25596 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
25597 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
25598
25599 @table @code
25600 @kindex maint agent
25601 @item maint agent @var{expression}
25602 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
25603 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
25604 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
25605
25606 @kindex maint info breakpoints
25607 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
25608 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
25609 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
25610 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
25611 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
25612 is shown:
25613
25614 @table @code
25615 @item breakpoint
25616 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
25617
25618 @item watchpoint
25619 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
25620
25621 @item longjmp
25622 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
25623 @code{longjmp} calls.
25624
25625 @item longjmp resume
25626 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
25627
25628 @item until
25629 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
25630
25631 @item finish
25632 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
25633
25634 @item shlib events
25635 Shared library events.
25636
25637 @end table
25638
25639 @kindex set displaced-stepping
25640 @kindex show displaced-stepping
25641 @cindex displaced stepping support
25642 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
25643 @item set displaced-stepping
25644 @itemx show displaced-stepping
25645 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
25646 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
25647 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
25648 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
25649 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
25650
25651 @table @code
25652 @item set displaced-stepping on
25653 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
25654 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
25655
25656 @item set displaced-stepping off
25657 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
25658 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
25659
25660 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
25661 @item set displaced-stepping auto
25662 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
25663 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
25664 architecture supports displaced stepping.
25665 @end table
25666
25667 @kindex maint check-symtabs
25668 @item maint check-symtabs
25669 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
25670
25671 @kindex maint cplus first_component
25672 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
25673 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
25674
25675 @kindex maint cplus namespace
25676 @item maint cplus namespace
25677 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
25678
25679 @kindex maint demangle
25680 @item maint demangle @var{name}
25681 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
25682
25683 @kindex maint deprecate
25684 @kindex maint undeprecate
25685 @cindex deprecated commands
25686 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
25687 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
25688 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
25689 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
25690 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
25691 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
25692 the replacement as part of the warning.
25693
25694 @kindex maint dump-me
25695 @item maint dump-me
25696 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
25697 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
25698 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
25699 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
25700
25701 @kindex maint internal-error
25702 @kindex maint internal-warning
25703 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
25704 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
25705 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
25706 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
25707 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
25708 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
25709 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
25710 @value{GDBN} session.
25711
25712 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
25713 used as the text of the error or warning message.
25714
25715 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
25716
25717 @smallexample
25718 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
25719 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
25720 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
25721 debugging may prove unreliable.
25722 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
25723 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
25724 (@value{GDBP})
25725 @end smallexample
25726
25727 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
25728 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
25729
25730 @kindex maint set internal-error
25731 @kindex maint show internal-error
25732 @kindex maint set internal-warning
25733 @kindex maint show internal-warning
25734 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
25735 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
25736 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
25737 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
25738 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
25739 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
25740 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
25741 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
25742 described in the table below.
25743
25744 @table @samp
25745 @item quit
25746 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
25747 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
25748
25749 @item corefile
25750 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
25751 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
25752 @end table
25753
25754 @kindex maint packet
25755 @item maint packet @var{text}
25756 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
25757 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
25758 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
25759 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
25760 checksum.
25761
25762 @kindex maint print architecture
25763 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25764 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
25765 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
25766
25767 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
25768 @item maint print c-tdesc
25769 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
25770 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
25771 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
25772
25773 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
25774 @item maint print dummy-frames
25775 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
25776
25777 @smallexample
25778 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
25779 @dots{}
25780 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
25781 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
25782 58 return (a + b);
25783 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
25784 @dots{}
25785 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
25786 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
25787 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
25788 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
25789 (@value{GDBP})
25790 @end smallexample
25791
25792 Takes an optional file parameter.
25793
25794 @kindex maint print registers
25795 @kindex maint print raw-registers
25796 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
25797 @kindex maint print register-groups
25798 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25799 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25800 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25801 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25802 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
25803
25804 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
25805 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
25806 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
25807 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
25808 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
25809 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
25810
25811 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
25812 write the information.
25813
25814 @kindex maint print reggroups
25815 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25816 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
25817 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
25818 information.
25819
25820 The register groups info looks like this:
25821
25822 @smallexample
25823 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
25824 Group Type
25825 general user
25826 float user
25827 all user
25828 vector user
25829 system user
25830 save internal
25831 restore internal
25832 @end smallexample
25833
25834 @kindex flushregs
25835 @item flushregs
25836 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
25837
25838 @kindex maint print objfiles
25839 @cindex info for known object files
25840 @item maint print objfiles
25841 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
25842 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
25843 and symtabs.
25844
25845 @kindex maint print statistics
25846 @cindex bcache statistics
25847 @item maint print statistics
25848 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
25849 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
25850 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
25851 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
25852 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
25853 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
25854 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
25855 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
25856 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
25857 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
25858 lengths.
25859
25860 @kindex maint print target-stack
25861 @cindex target stack description
25862 @item maint print target-stack
25863 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
25864 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
25865 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
25866 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
25867 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
25868 address.
25869
25870 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
25871 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
25872
25873 @kindex maint print type
25874 @cindex type chain of a data type
25875 @item maint print type @var{expr}
25876 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
25877 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
25878 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
25879 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
25880 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
25881
25882 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
25883 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
25884 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
25885 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
25886 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
25887
25888 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
25889 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
25890 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
25891 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
25892 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
25893 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
25894 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
25895 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
25896 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
25897
25898 @kindex maint set profile
25899 @kindex maint show profile
25900 @cindex profiling GDB
25901 @item maint set profile
25902 @itemx maint show profile
25903 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
25904
25905 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
25906 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
25907 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
25908 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
25909 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
25910 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
25911 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
25912
25913 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
25914 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
25915
25916 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
25917 @cindex hardware debug registers
25918 @item maint show-debug-regs
25919 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
25920 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
25921 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
25922 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
25923 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
25924
25925 @kindex maint space
25926 @cindex memory used by commands
25927 @item maint space
25928 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
25929 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
25930 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
25931 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
25932 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
25933
25934 @kindex maint time
25935 @cindex time of command execution
25936 @item maint time
25937 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
25938 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
25939 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
25940 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
25941 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
25942 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
25943 it's not possibly currently
25944 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
25945 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
25946
25947 @kindex maint translate-address
25948 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
25949 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
25950 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
25951 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
25952 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
25953 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
25954 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
25955
25956 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
25957 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
25958 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
25959
25960 @end table
25961
25962 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
25963 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
25964
25965 @table @code
25966 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
25967 @kindex set watchdog
25968 @cindex watchdog timer
25969 @cindex timeout for commands
25970 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
25971 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
25972 reports and error and the command is aborted.
25973
25974 @item show watchdog
25975 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
25976 @end table
25977
25978 @node Remote Protocol
25979 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
25980
25981 @menu
25982 * Overview::
25983 * Packets::
25984 * Stop Reply Packets::
25985 * General Query Packets::
25986 * Register Packet Format::
25987 * Tracepoint Packets::
25988 * Host I/O Packets::
25989 * Interrupts::
25990 * Notification Packets::
25991 * Remote Non-Stop::
25992 * Packet Acknowledgment::
25993 * Examples::
25994 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
25995 * Library List Format::
25996 * Memory Map Format::
25997 @end menu
25998
25999 @node Overview
26000 @section Overview
26001
26002 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
26003 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
26004 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
26005 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
26006
26007 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
26008 transmitted and received data, respectively.
26009
26010 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
26011 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
26012 @cindex remote serial protocol
26013 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
26014 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
26015 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
26016 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
26017 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
26018
26019 @smallexample
26020 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
26021 @end smallexample
26022 @noindent
26023
26024 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
26025 @noindent
26026 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
26027 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
26028 eight bit unsigned checksum).
26029
26030 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
26031 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
26032
26033 @smallexample
26034 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
26035 @end smallexample
26036
26037 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
26038 @noindent
26039 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
26040 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
26041 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
26042
26043 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
26044 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
26045 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
26046 retransmission):
26047
26048 @smallexample
26049 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
26050 <- @code{+}
26051 @end smallexample
26052 @noindent
26053
26054 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
26055 once a connection is established.
26056 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
26057
26058 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
26059 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
26060 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
26061 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
26062 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
26063 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
26064 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
26065
26066 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
26067 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
26068 exceptions).
26069
26070 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
26071 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
26072 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
26073 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
26074
26075 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
26076 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
26077 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
26078
26079 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
26080 @anchor{Binary Data}
26081 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
26082 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
26083 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
26084 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
26085 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
26086 binary data.
26087
26088 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
26089 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
26090 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
26091 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
26092 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
26093 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
26094 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
26095 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
26096 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
26097 (described next).
26098
26099 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
26100 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
26101 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
26102 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
26103 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
26104 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
26105 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
26106 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
26107 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
26108 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
26109 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
26110 3}} more times.
26111
26112 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
26113 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
26114 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
26115 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
26116 @samp{0*"00}.
26117
26118 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
26119 error number. That number is not well defined.
26120
26121 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
26122 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
26123 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
26124 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
26125 on that response.
26126
26127 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
26128 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
26129 optional.
26130
26131 @node Packets
26132 @section Packets
26133
26134 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
26135 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
26136 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
26137 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
26138
26139 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
26140 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
26141 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
26142 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
26143 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
26144 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
26145 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
26146 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
26147 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
26148 @var{baz}.
26149
26150 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
26151 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
26152 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
26153 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
26154 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
26155 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
26156 pick any thread.
26157
26158 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
26159 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
26160 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
26161 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
26162 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
26163 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
26164 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
26165 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
26166 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
26167 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
26168 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
26169 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
26170 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
26171
26172 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
26173 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
26174 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
26175 more information.
26176
26177 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
26178 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
26179
26180 Here are the packet descriptions.
26181
26182 @table @samp
26183
26184 @item !
26185 @cindex @samp{!} packet
26186 @anchor{extended mode}
26187 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
26188 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
26189 debugged.
26190
26191 Reply:
26192 @table @samp
26193 @item OK
26194 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
26195 @end table
26196
26197 @item ?
26198 @cindex @samp{?} packet
26199 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
26200 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
26201 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
26202
26203 Reply:
26204 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26205
26206 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
26207 @cindex @samp{A} packet
26208 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
26209 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
26210 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
26211
26212 Reply:
26213 @table @samp
26214 @item OK
26215 The arguments were set.
26216 @item E @var{NN}
26217 An error occurred.
26218 @end table
26219
26220 @item b @var{baud}
26221 @cindex @samp{b} packet
26222 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
26223 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
26224
26225 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
26226 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
26227 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
26228
26229 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
26230 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
26231 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
26232 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
26233 of view, nothing actually happened.}
26234
26235 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
26236 @cindex @samp{B} packet
26237 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
26238 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
26239
26240 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
26241 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
26242
26243 @item bc
26244 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
26245 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
26246 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
26247
26248 Reply:
26249 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26250
26251 @item bs
26252 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
26253 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
26254 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
26255
26256 Reply:
26257 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26258
26259 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
26260 @cindex @samp{c} packet
26261 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
26262 resume at current address.
26263
26264 Reply:
26265 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26266
26267 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
26268 @cindex @samp{C} packet
26269 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
26270 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
26271
26272 Reply:
26273 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26274
26275 @item d
26276 @cindex @samp{d} packet
26277 Toggle debug flag.
26278
26279 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
26280 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
26281
26282 @item D
26283 @itemx D;@var{pid}
26284 @cindex @samp{D} packet
26285 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
26286 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
26287 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
26288
26289 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
26290 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
26291 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
26292 big-endian hex string.
26293
26294 Reply:
26295 @table @samp
26296 @item OK
26297 for success
26298 @item E @var{NN}
26299 for an error
26300 @end table
26301
26302 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
26303 @cindex @samp{F} packet
26304 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
26305 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
26306 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
26307
26308 @item g
26309 @anchor{read registers packet}
26310 @cindex @samp{g} packet
26311 Read general registers.
26312
26313 Reply:
26314 @table @samp
26315 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
26316 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
26317 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
26318 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
26319 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
26320 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
26321 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
26322 @item E @var{NN}
26323 for an error.
26324 @end table
26325
26326 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
26327 @cindex @samp{G} packet
26328 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
26329 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
26330
26331 Reply:
26332 @table @samp
26333 @item OK
26334 for success
26335 @item E @var{NN}
26336 for an error
26337 @end table
26338
26339 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
26340 @cindex @samp{H} packet
26341 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
26342 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
26343 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
26344 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
26345 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
26346
26347 Reply:
26348 @table @samp
26349 @item OK
26350 for success
26351 @item E @var{NN}
26352 for an error
26353 @end table
26354
26355 @c FIXME: JTC:
26356 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
26357 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
26358 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
26359 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
26360 @c described. For example:
26361 @c
26362 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
26363 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
26364 @c otherwise returns current registers.
26365 @c
26366 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
26367 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
26368 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
26369
26370 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
26371 @anchor{cycle step packet}
26372 @cindex @samp{i} packet
26373 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
26374 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
26375 step starting at that address.
26376
26377 @item I
26378 @cindex @samp{I} packet
26379 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
26380 step packet}.
26381
26382 @item k
26383 @cindex @samp{k} packet
26384 Kill request.
26385
26386 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
26387 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
26388 thread?)}.
26389
26390 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
26391 @cindex @samp{m} packet
26392 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
26393 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
26394
26395 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
26396 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
26397 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
26398 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
26399 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
26400 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
26401 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
26402 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
26403
26404 Reply:
26405 @table @samp
26406 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
26407 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
26408 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
26409 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
26410 @item E @var{NN}
26411 @var{NN} is errno
26412 @end table
26413
26414 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
26415 @cindex @samp{M} packet
26416 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
26417 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
26418 hexadecimal number.
26419
26420 Reply:
26421 @table @samp
26422 @item OK
26423 for success
26424 @item E @var{NN}
26425 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
26426 written).
26427 @end table
26428
26429 @item p @var{n}
26430 @cindex @samp{p} packet
26431 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
26432 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
26433 register value is encoded.
26434
26435 Reply:
26436 @table @samp
26437 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
26438 the register's value
26439 @item E @var{NN}
26440 for an error
26441 @item
26442 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
26443 @end table
26444
26445 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
26446 @anchor{write register packet}
26447 @cindex @samp{P} packet
26448 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
26449 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
26450 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
26451
26452 Reply:
26453 @table @samp
26454 @item OK
26455 for success
26456 @item E @var{NN}
26457 for an error
26458 @end table
26459
26460 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
26461 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
26462 @cindex @samp{q} packet
26463 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
26464 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
26465 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
26466
26467 @item r
26468 @cindex @samp{r} packet
26469 Reset the entire system.
26470
26471 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
26472
26473 @item R @var{XX}
26474 @cindex @samp{R} packet
26475 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
26476 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
26477
26478 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
26479
26480 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
26481 @cindex @samp{s} packet
26482 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
26483 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
26484
26485 Reply:
26486 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26487
26488 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
26489 @anchor{step with signal packet}
26490 @cindex @samp{S} packet
26491 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
26492 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
26493
26494 Reply:
26495 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26496
26497 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
26498 @cindex @samp{t} packet
26499 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
26500 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
26501 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
26502
26503 @item T @var{thread-id}
26504 @cindex @samp{T} packet
26505 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
26506
26507 Reply:
26508 @table @samp
26509 @item OK
26510 thread is still alive
26511 @item E @var{NN}
26512 thread is dead
26513 @end table
26514
26515 @item v
26516 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
26517 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
26518
26519 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
26520 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
26521 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
26522 The process ID is a
26523 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
26524 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
26525 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
26526
26527 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
26528 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
26529 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
26530 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
26531 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
26532 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
26533 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
26534 @c stopping or restarting threads.
26535
26536 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
26537
26538 Reply:
26539 @table @samp
26540 @item E @var{nn}
26541 for an error
26542 @item @r{Any stop packet}
26543 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
26544 @item OK
26545 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
26546 @end table
26547
26548 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
26549 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
26550 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
26551 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
26552 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
26553 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
26554 in their current state in non-stop mode.
26555 Specifying multiple
26556 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
26557 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
26558
26559 Currently supported actions are:
26560
26561 @table @samp
26562 @item c
26563 Continue.
26564 @item C @var{sig}
26565 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
26566 @item s
26567 Step.
26568 @item S @var{sig}
26569 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
26570 @item t
26571 Stop.
26572 @item T @var{sig}
26573 Stop with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
26574 @end table
26575
26576 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
26577 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
26578 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
26579
26580 The @samp{t} and @samp{T} actions are only relevant in non-stop mode
26581 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
26582 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
26583 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
26584 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
26585 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
26586 as an implementation detail.
26587
26588 Reply:
26589 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26590
26591 @item vCont?
26592 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
26593 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
26594
26595 Reply:
26596 @table @samp
26597 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
26598 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
26599 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
26600 @item
26601 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
26602 @end table
26603
26604 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
26605 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
26606 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
26607 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
26608
26609 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
26610 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
26611 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
26612 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
26613 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
26614 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
26615 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
26616 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
26617 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
26618 packet is received.
26619
26620 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
26621 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
26622 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
26623 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
26624 @var{thread-id}.
26625
26626 Reply:
26627 @table @samp
26628 @item OK
26629 for success
26630 @item E @var{NN}
26631 for an error
26632 @end table
26633
26634 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
26635 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
26636 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
26637 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
26638 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
26639 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
26640 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
26641 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
26642 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
26643 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
26644 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
26645 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
26646
26647
26648 Reply:
26649 @table @samp
26650 @item OK
26651 for success
26652 @item E.memtype
26653 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
26654 @item E @var{NN}
26655 for an error
26656 @end table
26657
26658 @item vFlashDone
26659 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
26660 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
26661 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
26662 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
26663 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
26664 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
26665 request is completed.
26666
26667 @item vKill;@var{pid}
26668 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
26669 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
26670 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
26671 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
26672 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
26673
26674 Reply:
26675 @table @samp
26676 @item E @var{nn}
26677 for an error
26678 @item OK
26679 for success
26680 @end table
26681
26682 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
26683 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
26684 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
26685 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
26686 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
26687 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
26688 state.
26689
26690 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
26691
26692 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
26693
26694 Reply:
26695 @table @samp
26696 @item E @var{nn}
26697 for an error
26698 @item @r{Any stop packet}
26699 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
26700 @end table
26701
26702 @item vStopped
26703 @anchor{vStopped packet}
26704 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
26705
26706 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
26707 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
26708
26709 Reply:
26710 @table @samp
26711 @item @r{Any stop packet}
26712 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
26713 @item OK
26714 if there are no unreported stop events
26715 @end table
26716
26717 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
26718 @anchor{X packet}
26719 @cindex @samp{X} packet
26720 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
26721 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
26722 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
26723
26724 Reply:
26725 @table @samp
26726 @item OK
26727 for success
26728 @item E @var{NN}
26729 for an error
26730 @end table
26731
26732 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
26733 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
26734 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
26735 @cindex @samp{z} packet
26736 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
26737 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
26738 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
26739 @var{length} bytes.
26740
26741 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
26742 separately.
26743
26744 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
26745 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
26746 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
26747 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
26748 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
26749 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
26750
26751 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
26752 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
26753 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
26754 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
26755 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
26756 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
26757
26758 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
26759 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
26760 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
26761 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
26762 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
26763
26764 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
26765 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
26766 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
26767 target, is not defined.}
26768
26769 Reply:
26770 @table @samp
26771 @item OK
26772 success
26773 @item
26774 not supported
26775 @item E @var{NN}
26776 for an error
26777 @end table
26778
26779 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
26780 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
26781 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
26782 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
26783 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
26784 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
26785
26786 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
26787 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
26788
26789 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
26790 movement.}
26791
26792 Reply:
26793 @table @samp
26794 @item OK
26795 success
26796 @item
26797 not supported
26798 @item E @var{NN}
26799 for an error
26800 @end table
26801
26802 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
26803 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
26804 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
26805 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
26806 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
26807
26808 Reply:
26809 @table @samp
26810 @item OK
26811 success
26812 @item
26813 not supported
26814 @item E @var{NN}
26815 for an error
26816 @end table
26817
26818 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
26819 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
26820 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
26821 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
26822 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
26823
26824 Reply:
26825 @table @samp
26826 @item OK
26827 success
26828 @item
26829 not supported
26830 @item E @var{NN}
26831 for an error
26832 @end table
26833
26834 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
26835 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
26836 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
26837 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
26838 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
26839
26840 Reply:
26841 @table @samp
26842 @item OK
26843 success
26844 @item
26845 not supported
26846 @item E @var{NN}
26847 for an error
26848 @end table
26849
26850 @end table
26851
26852 @node Stop Reply Packets
26853 @section Stop Reply Packets
26854 @cindex stop reply packets
26855
26856 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
26857 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
26858 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
26859 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
26860 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
26861 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
26862 @value{GDBN} source code.
26863
26864 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
26865 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
26866 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
26867 components.
26868
26869 @table @samp
26870
26871 @item S @var{AA}
26872 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
26873 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
26874 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
26875
26876 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
26877 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
26878 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
26879 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
26880 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
26881 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
26882 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
26883 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
26884
26885 @itemize @bullet
26886 @item
26887 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
26888 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
26889 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
26890 two-digit hex number.
26891
26892 @item
26893 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
26894 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
26895
26896 @item
26897 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
26898 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
26899 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
26900 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
26901
26902 @item
26903 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
26904 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
26905 future.
26906 @end itemize
26907
26908 The currently defined stop reasons are:
26909
26910 @table @samp
26911 @item watch
26912 @itemx rwatch
26913 @itemx awatch
26914 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
26915 hex.
26916
26917 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
26918 @item library
26919 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
26920 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
26921 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
26922
26923 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
26924 @item replaylog
26925 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
26926 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
26927 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
26928 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
26929 for more information.
26930
26931
26932 @end table
26933
26934 @item W @var{AA}
26935 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
26936 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
26937 applicable to certain targets.
26938
26939 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
26940 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
26941 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
26942 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
26943
26944 @item X @var{AA}
26945 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
26946 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
26947
26948 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
26949 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
26950 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
26951 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
26952
26953 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
26954 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
26955 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
26956 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
26957 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
26958
26959 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
26960 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
26961 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
26962 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
26963 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
26964 system calls.
26965
26966 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
26967 this very system call.
26968
26969 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
26970 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
26971 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
26972 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
26973 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
26974 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
26975
26976 @end table
26977
26978 @node General Query Packets
26979 @section General Query Packets
26980 @cindex remote query requests
26981
26982 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
26983 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
26984 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
26985 sending information to and from the stub.
26986
26987 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
26988 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
26989 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
26990 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
26991 conventions:
26992
26993 @itemize @bullet
26994 @item
26995 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
26996 @item
26997 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
26998 letter.
26999 @item
27000 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
27001 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
27002 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
27003 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
27004 @end itemize
27005
27006 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
27007 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
27008 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
27009 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
27010 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
27011 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
27012 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
27013 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
27014 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
27015 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
27016 packet.}.
27017
27018 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
27019 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
27020 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
27021 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
27022 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
27023
27024 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
27025
27026 @table @samp
27027
27028 @item qC
27029 @cindex current thread, remote request
27030 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
27031 Return the current thread ID.
27032
27033 Reply:
27034 @table @samp
27035 @item QC @var{thread-id}
27036 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
27037 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
27038 @item @r{(anything else)}
27039 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
27040 @end table
27041
27042 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
27043 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
27044 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
27045 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
27046 Reply:
27047 @table @samp
27048 @item E @var{NN}
27049 An error (such as memory fault)
27050 @item C @var{crc32}
27051 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
27052 @end table
27053
27054 @item qfThreadInfo
27055 @itemx qsThreadInfo
27056 @cindex list active threads, remote request
27057 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
27058 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
27059 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
27060 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
27061 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
27062 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
27063 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
27064 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
27065
27066 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
27067
27068 Reply:
27069 @table @samp
27070 @item m @var{thread-id}
27071 A single thread ID
27072 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
27073 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
27074 @item l
27075 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
27076 @end table
27077
27078 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
27079 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
27080 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
27081 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
27082 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
27083 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
27084 fields.
27085
27086 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
27087 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
27088 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
27089 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
27090 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
27091
27092 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
27093 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
27094
27095 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
27096 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
27097 information associated with the variable.)
27098
27099 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
27100 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
27101 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
27102 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
27103 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
27104 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
27105
27106 Reply:
27107 @table @samp
27108 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
27109 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
27110 local storage requested.
27111
27112 @item E @var{nn}
27113 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
27114
27115 @item
27116 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
27117 @end table
27118
27119 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
27120 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
27121 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
27122 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
27123 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
27124 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
27125 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
27126
27127 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
27128
27129 Reply:
27130 @table @samp
27131 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
27132 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
27133 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
27134 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
27135 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
27136 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
27137 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
27138 @end table
27139
27140 @item qOffsets
27141 @cindex section offsets, remote request
27142 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
27143 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
27144 image.
27145
27146 Reply:
27147 @table @samp
27148 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
27149 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
27150 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
27151 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
27152 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
27153 segments by the supplied offsets.
27154
27155 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
27156 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
27157 to the @code{Bss} section.}
27158
27159 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
27160 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
27161 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
27162 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
27163 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
27164 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
27165 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
27166 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
27167 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
27168 @end table
27169
27170 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
27171 @cindex thread information, remote request
27172 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
27173 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
27174 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
27175 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
27176
27177 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
27178 (see below).
27179
27180 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
27181
27182 @item QNonStop:1
27183 @item QNonStop:0
27184 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
27185 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
27186 @anchor{QNonStop}
27187 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
27188 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
27189
27190 Reply:
27191 @table @samp
27192 @item OK
27193 The request succeeded.
27194
27195 @item E @var{nn}
27196 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
27197
27198 @item
27199 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
27200 the stub.
27201 @end table
27202
27203 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27204 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27205 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
27206 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
27207
27208 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
27209 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
27210 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
27211 @anchor{QPassSignals}
27212 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
27213 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
27214 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
27215 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
27216 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
27217 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
27218 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
27219 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
27220 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
27221
27222 Reply:
27223 @table @samp
27224 @item OK
27225 The request succeeded.
27226
27227 @item E @var{nn}
27228 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
27229
27230 @item
27231 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
27232 the stub.
27233 @end table
27234
27235 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
27236 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
27237 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27238 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27239
27240 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
27241 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
27242 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
27243 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
27244 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
27245 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
27246 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
27247 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
27248 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
27249
27250 Reply:
27251 @table @samp
27252 @item OK
27253 A command response with no output.
27254 @item @var{OUTPUT}
27255 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
27256 @item E @var{NN}
27257 Indicate a badly formed request.
27258 @item
27259 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
27260 @end table
27261
27262 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
27263 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
27264 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
27265 packets.)
27266
27267 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
27268 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
27269 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
27270 @anchor{qSearch memory}
27271 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
27272 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
27273 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
27274
27275 Reply:
27276 @table @samp
27277 @item 0
27278 The pattern was not found.
27279 @item 1,address
27280 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
27281 @item E @var{NN}
27282 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
27283 @item
27284 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
27285 @end table
27286
27287 @item QStartNoAckMode
27288 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
27289 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
27290 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
27291 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
27292
27293 Reply:
27294 @table @samp
27295 @item OK
27296 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
27297 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
27298 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
27299 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
27300 @item
27301 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
27302 @end table
27303
27304 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
27305 @cindex supported packets, remote query
27306 @cindex features of the remote protocol
27307 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
27308 @anchor{qSupported}
27309 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
27310 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
27311 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
27312 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
27313 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
27314 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
27315 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
27316 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
27317 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
27318 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
27319 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
27320 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
27321 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
27322 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
27323
27324 Reply:
27325 @table @samp
27326 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
27327 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
27328 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
27329 possible forms).
27330 @item
27331 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
27332 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
27333 @end table
27334
27335 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
27336 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
27337 are:
27338
27339 @table @samp
27340 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
27341 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
27342 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
27343 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
27344 @item @var{name}+
27345 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
27346 need an associated value.
27347 @item @var{name}-
27348 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
27349 @item @var{name}?
27350 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
27351 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
27352 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
27353 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
27354 @end table
27355
27356 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
27357 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
27358 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
27359 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
27360 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
27361
27362 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
27363 are defined:
27364
27365 @table @samp
27366 @item multiprocess
27367 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
27368 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
27369 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
27370 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
27371 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
27372 @end table
27373
27374 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
27375 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
27376 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
27377 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
27378 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
27379 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
27380 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
27381 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
27382 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
27383 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
27384 all the features it supports.
27385
27386 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
27387 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
27388
27389 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
27390 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
27391 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
27392 form response.
27393
27394 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
27395 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
27396 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
27397 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
27398
27399 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
27400 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
27401 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
27402 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
27403 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
27404
27405 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
27406
27407 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
27408 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
27409 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
27410 @item Feature Name
27411 @tab Value Required
27412 @tab Default
27413 @tab Probe Allowed
27414
27415 @item @samp{PacketSize}
27416 @tab Yes
27417 @tab @samp{-}
27418 @tab No
27419
27420 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
27421 @tab No
27422 @tab @samp{-}
27423 @tab Yes
27424
27425 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
27426 @tab No
27427 @tab @samp{-}
27428 @tab Yes
27429
27430 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
27431 @tab No
27432 @tab @samp{-}
27433 @tab Yes
27434
27435 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
27436 @tab No
27437 @tab @samp{-}
27438 @tab Yes
27439
27440 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
27441 @tab No
27442 @tab @samp{-}
27443 @tab Yes
27444
27445 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
27446 @tab No
27447 @tab @samp{-}
27448 @tab Yes
27449
27450 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
27451 @tab No
27452 @tab @samp{-}
27453 @tab Yes
27454
27455 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
27456 @tab No
27457 @tab @samp{-}
27458 @tab Yes
27459
27460 @item @samp{QNonStop}
27461 @tab No
27462 @tab @samp{-}
27463 @tab Yes
27464
27465 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
27466 @tab No
27467 @tab @samp{-}
27468 @tab Yes
27469
27470 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
27471 @tab No
27472 @tab @samp{-}
27473 @tab Yes
27474
27475 @item @samp{multiprocess}
27476 @tab No
27477 @tab @samp{-}
27478 @tab No
27479
27480 @end multitable
27481
27482 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
27483
27484 @table @samp
27485 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
27486 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
27487 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
27488 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
27489 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
27490 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
27491 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
27492 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
27493 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
27494 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
27495
27496 @item qXfer:auxv:read
27497 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
27498 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
27499
27500 @item qXfer:features:read
27501 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
27502 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
27503
27504 @item qXfer:libraries:read
27505 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
27506 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
27507
27508 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
27509 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
27510 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
27511
27512 @item qXfer:spu:read
27513 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
27514 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
27515
27516 @item qXfer:spu:write
27517 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
27518 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
27519
27520 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
27521 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
27522 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
27523
27524 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
27525 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
27526 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
27527
27528 @item QNonStop
27529 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
27530 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
27531
27532 @item QPassSignals
27533 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
27534 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
27535
27536 @item QStartNoAckMode
27537 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
27538 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
27539
27540 @item multiprocess
27541 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
27542 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
27543 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
27544 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
27545 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
27546 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
27547 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
27548 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
27549 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
27550 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
27551 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
27552
27553 @item qXfer:osdata:read
27554 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
27555 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
27556
27557 @end table
27558
27559 @item qSymbol::
27560 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
27561 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
27562 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
27563 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
27564
27565 Reply:
27566 @table @samp
27567 @item OK
27568 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
27569 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
27570 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
27571 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
27572 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
27573 below.
27574 @end table
27575
27576 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
27577 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
27578
27579 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
27580 target has previously requested.
27581
27582 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
27583 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
27584 will be empty.
27585
27586 Reply:
27587 @table @samp
27588 @item OK
27589 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
27590 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
27591 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
27592 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
27593 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
27594 @end table
27595
27596 @item QTDP
27597 @itemx QTFrame
27598 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
27599
27600 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
27601 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
27602 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
27603 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
27604 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
27605 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
27606 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
27607 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
27608 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
27609 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
27610 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
27611
27612 Reply:
27613 @table @samp
27614 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
27615 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
27616 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
27617 the thread's attributes.
27618 @end table
27619
27620 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
27621 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
27622 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
27623 packets.)
27624
27625 @item QTStart
27626 @itemx QTStop
27627 @itemx QTinit
27628 @itemx QTro
27629 @itemx qTStatus
27630 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
27631
27632 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27633 @cindex read special object, remote request
27634 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
27635 @anchor{qXfer read}
27636 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
27637 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
27638 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
27639 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
27640 additional details about what data to access.
27641
27642 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
27643 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
27644 formats, listed below.
27645
27646 @table @samp
27647 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27648 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
27649 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
27650 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
27651
27652 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27653 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27654
27655 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27656 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
27657 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
27658 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
27659 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
27660
27661 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27662 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27663
27664 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27665 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
27666 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
27667 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
27668 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
27669
27670 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
27671 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
27672 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
27673
27674 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27675 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27676
27677 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27678 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
27679 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
27680 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
27681 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
27682
27683 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27684 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27685
27686 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27687 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
27688 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
27689 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
27690 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
27691
27692 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27693 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
27694 (@pxref{qSupported}).
27695
27696 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27697 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
27698 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
27699 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
27700 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
27701 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
27702 in that context to be accessed.
27703
27704 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27705 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
27706 (@pxref{qSupported}).
27707
27708 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27709 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
27710 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
27711 @xref{Operating System Information}.
27712
27713 @end table
27714
27715 Reply:
27716 @table @samp
27717 @item m @var{data}
27718 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
27719 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
27720 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
27721 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
27722 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
27723 request.
27724
27725 @item l @var{data}
27726 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
27727 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
27728 than the @var{length} in the request.
27729
27730 @item l
27731 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
27732 There is no more data to be read.
27733
27734 @item E00
27735 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
27736
27737 @item E @var{nn}
27738 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
27739 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
27740
27741 @item
27742 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
27743 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
27744 @end table
27745
27746 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
27747 @cindex write data into object, remote request
27748 @anchor{qXfer write}
27749 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
27750 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
27751 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
27752 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
27753 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
27754 to access.
27755
27756 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
27757 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
27758 formats, listed below.
27759
27760 @table @samp
27761 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
27762 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
27763 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
27764 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
27765 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
27766
27767 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27768 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
27769 (@pxref{qSupported}).
27770
27771 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
27772 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
27773 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
27774 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
27775 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
27776 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
27777 in that context to be accessed.
27778
27779 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27780 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27781 @end table
27782
27783 Reply:
27784 @table @samp
27785 @item @var{nn}
27786 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
27787 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
27788
27789 @item E00
27790 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
27791
27792 @item E @var{nn}
27793 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
27794 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
27795
27796 @item
27797 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
27798 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
27799 @end table
27800
27801 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
27802 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
27803 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
27804 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
27805 must respond with an empty packet.
27806
27807 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
27808 @cindex query attached, remote request
27809 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
27810 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
27811 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
27812 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
27813 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
27814 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
27815 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
27816
27817 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
27818 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
27819 the @code{quit} command.
27820
27821 Reply:
27822 @table @samp
27823 @item 1
27824 The remote server attached to an existing process.
27825 @item 0
27826 The remote server created a new process.
27827 @item E @var{NN}
27828 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
27829 @end table
27830
27831 @end table
27832
27833 @node Register Packet Format
27834 @section Register Packet Format
27835
27836 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
27837 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
27838 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
27839 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
27840 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
27841 most-significant - least-significant.
27842
27843 @table @r
27844
27845 @item MIPS32
27846
27847 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
27848 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
27849 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
27850
27851 @item MIPS64
27852
27853 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
27854 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
27855 as @code{MIPS32}.
27856
27857 @end table
27858
27859 @node Tracepoint Packets
27860 @section Tracepoint Packets
27861 @cindex tracepoint packets
27862 @cindex packets, tracepoint
27863
27864 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
27865 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
27866
27867 @table @samp
27868
27869 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
27870 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
27871 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
27872 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
27873 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
27874 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
27875 tracepoint's actions.
27876
27877 Replies:
27878 @table @samp
27879 @item OK
27880 The packet was understood and carried out.
27881 @item
27882 The packet was not recognized.
27883 @end table
27884
27885 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
27886 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
27887 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
27888 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
27889 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
27890 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
27891 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
27892
27893 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
27894 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
27895 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
27896 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
27897 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
27898 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
27899 tracepoint actions.
27900
27901 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
27902 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
27903 following forms:
27904
27905 @table @samp
27906
27907 @item R @var{mask}
27908 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
27909 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
27910 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
27911 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
27912 not fit in a 32-bit word.
27913
27914 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
27915 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
27916 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
27917 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
27918 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
27919 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
27920 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
27921
27922 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
27923 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
27924 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
27925 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
27926 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
27927 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
27928 packet).
27929
27930 @end table
27931
27932 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
27933 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
27934 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
27935 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
27936 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
27937 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
27938 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
27939 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
27940
27941 Replies:
27942 @table @samp
27943 @item OK
27944 The packet was understood and carried out.
27945 @item
27946 The packet was not recognized.
27947 @end table
27948
27949 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
27950 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
27951 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
27952 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
27953
27954 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
27955 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
27956 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
27957 one of the following forms:
27958
27959 @table @samp
27960 @item F @var{f}
27961 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
27962 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
27963 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
27964
27965 @item T @var{t}
27966 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
27967 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
27968
27969 @end table
27970
27971 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
27972 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
27973 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
27974 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
27975
27976 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
27977 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
27978 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
27979 is a hexadecimal number.
27980
27981 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
27982 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
27983 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
27984 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
27985 numbers.
27986
27987 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
27988 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
27989 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
27990
27991 @item QTStart
27992 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
27993 hits in the trace frame buffer.
27994
27995 @item QTStop
27996 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
27997
27998 @item QTinit
27999 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
28000
28001 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
28002 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
28003 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
28004 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
28005
28006 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
28007 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
28008 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
28009 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
28010
28011 @item qTStatus
28012 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
28013
28014 Replies:
28015 @table @samp
28016 @item T0
28017 There is no trace experiment running.
28018 @item T1
28019 There is a trace experiment running.
28020 @end table
28021
28022 @end table
28023
28024
28025 @node Host I/O Packets
28026 @section Host I/O Packets
28027 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
28028 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
28029
28030 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
28031 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
28032 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
28033 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
28034 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
28035 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
28036 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
28037 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
28038 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
28039 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
28040
28041 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
28042 its arguments. They have this format:
28043
28044 @table @samp
28045
28046 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
28047 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
28048 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
28049 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
28050 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
28051 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
28052 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
28053 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
28054 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
28055
28056 @end table
28057
28058 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
28059
28060 @table @samp
28061
28062 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
28063 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
28064 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
28065 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
28066 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
28067 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
28068 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
28069 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
28070 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
28071 @var{attachment}.
28072
28073 @item
28074 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
28075
28076 @end table
28077
28078 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
28079
28080 @table @samp
28081 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
28082 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
28083 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
28084 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
28085 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
28086 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
28087 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
28088
28089 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
28090 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
28091 -1 if an error occurs.
28092
28093 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
28094 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
28095 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
28096 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
28097 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
28098 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
28099 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
28100 @var{count} was zero.
28101
28102 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
28103 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
28104 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
28105 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
28106 some characters were escaped.
28107
28108 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
28109 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
28110 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
28111 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
28112 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
28113 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
28114 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
28115 error occurred.
28116
28117 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
28118 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
28119 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
28120
28121 @end table
28122
28123 @node Interrupts
28124 @section Interrupts
28125 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
28126
28127 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
28128 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
28129 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
28130 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
28131
28132 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
28133 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
28134 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
28135 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
28136 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
28137
28138 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
28139 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
28140 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
28141 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
28142 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
28143 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
28144 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
28145 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
28146
28147 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
28148 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
28149 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
28150 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
28151 currently-executing threads and processes.
28152 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
28153 running program, it should send one of the stop
28154 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
28155 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
28156 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
28157 Interrupts received while the
28158 program is stopped are discarded.
28159
28160 @node Notification Packets
28161 @section Notification Packets
28162 @cindex notification packets
28163 @cindex packets, notification
28164
28165 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
28166 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
28167 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
28168 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
28169 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
28170 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
28171 is not a problem.
28172
28173 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
28174 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
28175 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
28176 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
28177 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
28178 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
28179 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
28180
28181 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
28182 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
28183
28184 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
28185 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
28186 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
28187 not they understand it.
28188
28189 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
28190 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
28191 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
28192 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
28193 recipients.
28194
28195 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
28196 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
28197 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
28198 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
28199 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
28200
28201 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
28202 defined:
28203
28204 @table @samp
28205 @item Stop: @var{reply}
28206 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
28207 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
28208 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
28209 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
28210 @value{GDBN}.
28211 @end table
28212
28213 @node Remote Non-Stop
28214 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
28215
28216 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
28217 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
28218 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
28219 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
28220
28221 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
28222 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
28223 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
28224 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
28225 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
28226 probe the target state after a mode change.
28227
28228 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
28229 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
28230 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
28231 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
28232 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
28233 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
28234 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
28235 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
28236 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
28237 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
28238 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
28239
28240 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
28241 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
28242 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
28243 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
28244 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
28245 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
28246 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
28247 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
28248 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
28249 sending any queued stop events.
28250
28251 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
28252 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
28253 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
28254 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
28255 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
28256 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
28257 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
28258
28259 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
28260 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
28261 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
28262 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
28263 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
28264 process normally.
28265
28266 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
28267 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
28268 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
28269 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
28270 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
28271 should process normally.
28272
28273 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
28274 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
28275 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
28276 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
28277 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
28278
28279 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
28280 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
28281 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
28282 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
28283 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
28284 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
28285 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
28286 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
28287 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
28288 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
28289 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
28290 @samp{OK}.
28291
28292 @node Packet Acknowledgment
28293 @section Packet Acknowledgment
28294
28295 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
28296 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
28297 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
28298 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
28299 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
28300 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
28301 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
28302
28303 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
28304 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
28305 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
28306 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
28307 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
28308
28309 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
28310 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
28311 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
28312 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
28313
28314 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
28315 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
28316 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
28317 @pxref{qSupported}.
28318 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
28319 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
28320 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
28321 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
28322 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
28323 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
28324 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
28325
28326 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
28327 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
28328 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
28329 connection.
28330 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
28331 new connection is established,
28332 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
28333 for the current connection, once disabled.
28334
28335 @node Examples
28336 @section Examples
28337
28338 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
28339 does not get any direct output:
28340
28341 @smallexample
28342 -> @code{R00}
28343 <- @code{+}
28344 @emph{target restarts}
28345 -> @code{?}
28346 <- @code{+}
28347 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
28348 -> @code{+}
28349 @end smallexample
28350
28351 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
28352
28353 @smallexample
28354 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
28355 <- @code{+}
28356 -> @code{s}
28357 <- @code{+}
28358 @emph{time passes}
28359 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
28360 -> @code{+}
28361 -> @code{g}
28362 <- @code{+}
28363 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
28364 -> @code{+}
28365 @end smallexample
28366
28367 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
28368 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
28369 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
28370
28371 @menu
28372 * File-I/O Overview::
28373 * Protocol Basics::
28374 * The F Request Packet::
28375 * The F Reply Packet::
28376 * The Ctrl-C Message::
28377 * Console I/O::
28378 * List of Supported Calls::
28379 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
28380 * Constants::
28381 * File-I/O Examples::
28382 @end menu
28383
28384 @node File-I/O Overview
28385 @subsection File-I/O Overview
28386 @cindex file-i/o overview
28387
28388 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
28389 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
28390 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
28391 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
28392 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
28393 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
28394
28395 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
28396 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
28397 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
28398 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
28399 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
28400
28401 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
28402 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
28403 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
28404 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
28405 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
28406 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
28407 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
28408
28409 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
28410 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
28411 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
28412 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
28413 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
28414
28415 @smallexample
28416 (@value{GDBP}) continue
28417 <- target requests 'system call X'
28418 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
28419 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
28420 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
28421 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
28422 @end smallexample
28423
28424 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
28425 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
28426 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
28427 system are not supported by this protocol.
28428
28429 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
28430
28431 @node Protocol Basics
28432 @subsection Protocol Basics
28433 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
28434
28435 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
28436 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
28437 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
28438 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
28439 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
28440 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
28441 to call the appropriate host system call:
28442
28443 @itemize @bullet
28444 @item
28445 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
28446
28447 @item
28448 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
28449 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
28450 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
28451 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
28452
28453 @end itemize
28454
28455 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
28456
28457 @itemize @bullet
28458 @item
28459 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
28460 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
28461 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
28462 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
28463 packet.
28464
28465 @item
28466 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
28467 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
28468
28469 @item
28470 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
28471
28472 @item
28473 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
28474
28475 @item
28476 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
28477 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
28478 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
28479 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
28480 packet.
28481
28482 @end itemize
28483
28484 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
28485 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
28486
28487 @itemize @bullet
28488 @item
28489 Return value.
28490
28491 @item
28492 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
28493
28494 @item
28495 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
28496
28497 @end itemize
28498
28499 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
28500 the latest continue or step action.
28501
28502 @node The F Request Packet
28503 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
28504 @cindex file-i/o request packet
28505 @cindex @code{F} request packet
28506
28507 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
28508
28509 @table @samp
28510 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
28511
28512 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
28513 This is just the name of the function.
28514
28515 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
28516 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
28517 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
28518 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
28519 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
28520 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
28521 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
28522
28523 @end table
28524
28525
28526
28527 @node The F Reply Packet
28528 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
28529 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
28530 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
28531
28532 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
28533
28534 @table @samp
28535
28536 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
28537
28538 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
28539
28540 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
28541 representation.
28542 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
28543
28544 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
28545 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
28546 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
28547
28548 @smallexample
28549 F0,0,C
28550 @end smallexample
28551
28552 @noindent
28553 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
28554
28555 @smallexample
28556 F-1,4,C
28557 @end smallexample
28558
28559 @noindent
28560 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
28561
28562 @end table
28563
28564
28565 @node The Ctrl-C Message
28566 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
28567 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
28568
28569 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
28570 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
28571 the target should behave as if it had
28572 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
28573 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
28574 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
28575 packet.
28576
28577 It's important for the target to know in which
28578 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
28579
28580 @itemize @bullet
28581 @item
28582 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
28583
28584 @item
28585 The system call on the host has been finished.
28586
28587 @end itemize
28588
28589 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
28590 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
28591 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
28592 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
28593 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
28594 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
28595
28596 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
28597 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
28598 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
28599 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
28600 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
28601 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
28602 or the full action has been completed.
28603
28604 @node Console I/O
28605 @subsection Console I/O
28606 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
28607
28608 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
28609 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
28610 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
28611 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
28612 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
28613 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
28614 conditions is met:
28615
28616 @itemize @bullet
28617 @item
28618 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
28619 @code{read}
28620 system call is treated as finished.
28621
28622 @item
28623 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
28624 newline.
28625
28626 @item
28627 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
28628 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
28629
28630 @end itemize
28631
28632 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
28633 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
28634 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
28635 is stopped at the user's request.
28636
28637
28638 @node List of Supported Calls
28639 @subsection List of Supported Calls
28640 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
28641
28642 @menu
28643 * open::
28644 * close::
28645 * read::
28646 * write::
28647 * lseek::
28648 * rename::
28649 * unlink::
28650 * stat/fstat::
28651 * gettimeofday::
28652 * isatty::
28653 * system::
28654 @end menu
28655
28656 @node open
28657 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
28658 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
28659
28660 @table @asis
28661 @item Synopsis:
28662 @smallexample
28663 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
28664 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
28665 @end smallexample
28666
28667 @item Request:
28668 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
28669
28670 @noindent
28671 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
28672
28673 @table @code
28674 @item O_CREAT
28675 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
28676 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
28677 are concerned.
28678
28679 @item O_EXCL
28680 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
28681 an error and open() fails.
28682
28683 @item O_TRUNC
28684 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
28685 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
28686 truncated to zero length.
28687
28688 @item O_APPEND
28689 The file is opened in append mode.
28690
28691 @item O_RDONLY
28692 The file is opened for reading only.
28693
28694 @item O_WRONLY
28695 The file is opened for writing only.
28696
28697 @item O_RDWR
28698 The file is opened for reading and writing.
28699 @end table
28700
28701 @noindent
28702 Other bits are silently ignored.
28703
28704
28705 @noindent
28706 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
28707
28708 @table @code
28709 @item S_IRUSR
28710 User has read permission.
28711
28712 @item S_IWUSR
28713 User has write permission.
28714
28715 @item S_IRGRP
28716 Group has read permission.
28717
28718 @item S_IWGRP
28719 Group has write permission.
28720
28721 @item S_IROTH
28722 Others have read permission.
28723
28724 @item S_IWOTH
28725 Others have write permission.
28726 @end table
28727
28728 @noindent
28729 Other bits are silently ignored.
28730
28731
28732 @item Return value:
28733 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
28734 occurred.
28735
28736 @item Errors:
28737
28738 @table @code
28739 @item EEXIST
28740 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
28741
28742 @item EISDIR
28743 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
28744
28745 @item EACCES
28746 The requested access is not allowed.
28747
28748 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28749 @var{pathname} was too long.
28750
28751 @item ENOENT
28752 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
28753
28754 @item ENODEV
28755 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
28756
28757 @item EROFS
28758 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
28759 write access was requested.
28760
28761 @item EFAULT
28762 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
28763
28764 @item ENOSPC
28765 No space on device to create the file.
28766
28767 @item EMFILE
28768 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
28769
28770 @item ENFILE
28771 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
28772 has been reached.
28773
28774 @item EINTR
28775 The call was interrupted by the user.
28776 @end table
28777
28778 @end table
28779
28780 @node close
28781 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
28782 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
28783
28784 @table @asis
28785 @item Synopsis:
28786 @smallexample
28787 int close(int fd);
28788 @end smallexample
28789
28790 @item Request:
28791 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
28792
28793 @item Return value:
28794 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
28795
28796 @item Errors:
28797
28798 @table @code
28799 @item EBADF
28800 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
28801
28802 @item EINTR
28803 The call was interrupted by the user.
28804 @end table
28805
28806 @end table
28807
28808 @node read
28809 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
28810 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
28811
28812 @table @asis
28813 @item Synopsis:
28814 @smallexample
28815 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
28816 @end smallexample
28817
28818 @item Request:
28819 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
28820
28821 @item Return value:
28822 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
28823 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
28824 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
28825
28826 @item Errors:
28827
28828 @table @code
28829 @item EBADF
28830 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
28831 reading.
28832
28833 @item EFAULT
28834 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28835
28836 @item EINTR
28837 The call was interrupted by the user.
28838 @end table
28839
28840 @end table
28841
28842 @node write
28843 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
28844 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
28845
28846 @table @asis
28847 @item Synopsis:
28848 @smallexample
28849 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
28850 @end smallexample
28851
28852 @item Request:
28853 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
28854
28855 @item Return value:
28856 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
28857 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
28858 is returned.
28859
28860 @item Errors:
28861
28862 @table @code
28863 @item EBADF
28864 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
28865 writing.
28866
28867 @item EFAULT
28868 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28869
28870 @item EFBIG
28871 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
28872 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
28873
28874 @item ENOSPC
28875 No space on device to write the data.
28876
28877 @item EINTR
28878 The call was interrupted by the user.
28879 @end table
28880
28881 @end table
28882
28883 @node lseek
28884 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
28885 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
28886
28887 @table @asis
28888 @item Synopsis:
28889 @smallexample
28890 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
28891 @end smallexample
28892
28893 @item Request:
28894 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
28895
28896 @var{flag} is one of:
28897
28898 @table @code
28899 @item SEEK_SET
28900 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
28901
28902 @item SEEK_CUR
28903 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
28904 bytes.
28905
28906 @item SEEK_END
28907 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
28908 bytes.
28909 @end table
28910
28911 @item Return value:
28912 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
28913 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
28914 value of -1 is returned.
28915
28916 @item Errors:
28917
28918 @table @code
28919 @item EBADF
28920 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
28921
28922 @item ESPIPE
28923 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
28924
28925 @item EINVAL
28926 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
28927
28928 @item EINTR
28929 The call was interrupted by the user.
28930 @end table
28931
28932 @end table
28933
28934 @node rename
28935 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
28936 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
28937
28938 @table @asis
28939 @item Synopsis:
28940 @smallexample
28941 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
28942 @end smallexample
28943
28944 @item Request:
28945 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
28946
28947 @item Return value:
28948 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
28949
28950 @item Errors:
28951
28952 @table @code
28953 @item EISDIR
28954 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
28955 directory.
28956
28957 @item EEXIST
28958 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
28959
28960 @item EBUSY
28961 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
28962 process.
28963
28964 @item EINVAL
28965 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
28966 of itself.
28967
28968 @item ENOTDIR
28969 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
28970 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
28971 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
28972
28973 @item EFAULT
28974 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
28975
28976 @item EACCES
28977 No access to the file or the path of the file.
28978
28979 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28980
28981 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
28982
28983 @item ENOENT
28984 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
28985
28986 @item EROFS
28987 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
28988
28989 @item ENOSPC
28990 The device containing the file has no room for the new
28991 directory entry.
28992
28993 @item EINTR
28994 The call was interrupted by the user.
28995 @end table
28996
28997 @end table
28998
28999 @node unlink
29000 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
29001 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
29002
29003 @table @asis
29004 @item Synopsis:
29005 @smallexample
29006 int unlink(const char *pathname);
29007 @end smallexample
29008
29009 @item Request:
29010 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
29011
29012 @item Return value:
29013 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
29014
29015 @item Errors:
29016
29017 @table @code
29018 @item EACCES
29019 No access to the file or the path of the file.
29020
29021 @item EPERM
29022 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
29023
29024 @item EBUSY
29025 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
29026 being used by another process.
29027
29028 @item EFAULT
29029 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
29030
29031 @item ENAMETOOLONG
29032 @var{pathname} was too long.
29033
29034 @item ENOENT
29035 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
29036
29037 @item ENOTDIR
29038 A component of the path is not a directory.
29039
29040 @item EROFS
29041 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
29042
29043 @item EINTR
29044 The call was interrupted by the user.
29045 @end table
29046
29047 @end table
29048
29049 @node stat/fstat
29050 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
29051 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
29052 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
29053
29054 @table @asis
29055 @item Synopsis:
29056 @smallexample
29057 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
29058 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
29059 @end smallexample
29060
29061 @item Request:
29062 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
29063 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
29064
29065 @item Return value:
29066 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
29067
29068 @item Errors:
29069
29070 @table @code
29071 @item EBADF
29072 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
29073
29074 @item ENOENT
29075 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
29076 path is an empty string.
29077
29078 @item ENOTDIR
29079 A component of the path is not a directory.
29080
29081 @item EFAULT
29082 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
29083
29084 @item EACCES
29085 No access to the file or the path of the file.
29086
29087 @item ENAMETOOLONG
29088 @var{pathname} was too long.
29089
29090 @item EINTR
29091 The call was interrupted by the user.
29092 @end table
29093
29094 @end table
29095
29096 @node gettimeofday
29097 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
29098 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
29099
29100 @table @asis
29101 @item Synopsis:
29102 @smallexample
29103 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
29104 @end smallexample
29105
29106 @item Request:
29107 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
29108
29109 @item Return value:
29110 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
29111
29112 @item Errors:
29113
29114 @table @code
29115 @item EINVAL
29116 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
29117
29118 @item EFAULT
29119 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
29120 @end table
29121
29122 @end table
29123
29124 @node isatty
29125 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
29126 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
29127
29128 @table @asis
29129 @item Synopsis:
29130 @smallexample
29131 int isatty(int fd);
29132 @end smallexample
29133
29134 @item Request:
29135 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
29136
29137 @item Return value:
29138 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
29139
29140 @item Errors:
29141
29142 @table @code
29143 @item EINTR
29144 The call was interrupted by the user.
29145 @end table
29146
29147 @end table
29148
29149 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
29150 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
29151 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
29152 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
29153 needed.
29154
29155
29156 @node system
29157 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
29158 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
29159
29160 @table @asis
29161 @item Synopsis:
29162 @smallexample
29163 int system(const char *command);
29164 @end smallexample
29165
29166 @item Request:
29167 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
29168
29169 @item Return value:
29170 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
29171 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
29172 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
29173 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
29174 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
29175 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
29176 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
29177
29178 @item Errors:
29179
29180 @table @code
29181 @item EINTR
29182 The call was interrupted by the user.
29183 @end table
29184
29185 @end table
29186
29187 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
29188 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
29189 the host is simplified before it's returned
29190 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
29191 is discarded, and the return value consists
29192 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
29193
29194 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
29195 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
29196 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
29197
29198 @table @code
29199 @item set remote system-call-allowed
29200 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
29201 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
29202 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
29203
29204 @item show remote system-call-allowed
29205 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
29206 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
29207 protocol.
29208 @end table
29209
29210 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
29211 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
29212 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
29213
29214 @menu
29215 * Integral Datatypes::
29216 * Pointer Values::
29217 * Memory Transfer::
29218 * struct stat::
29219 * struct timeval::
29220 @end menu
29221
29222 @node Integral Datatypes
29223 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
29224 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
29225
29226 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
29227 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
29228 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
29229
29230 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
29231 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
29232
29233 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
29234
29235 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
29236 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
29237
29238 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
29239
29240 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
29241 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
29242 byte order.
29243
29244 @node Pointer Values
29245 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
29246 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
29247
29248 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
29249 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
29250 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
29251 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
29252
29253 @smallexample
29254 @code{1aaf/12}
29255 @end smallexample
29256
29257 @noindent
29258 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
29259 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
29260 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
29261 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
29262
29263 @smallexample
29264 @code{123456/d}
29265 @end smallexample
29266
29267 @node Memory Transfer
29268 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
29269 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
29270
29271 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
29272 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
29273 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
29274 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
29275 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
29276 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
29277 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
29278
29279
29280 @node struct stat
29281 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
29282 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
29283
29284 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
29285 is defined as follows:
29286
29287 @smallexample
29288 struct stat @{
29289 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
29290 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
29291 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
29292 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
29293 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
29294 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
29295 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
29296 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
29297 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
29298 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
29299 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
29300 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
29301 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
29302 @};
29303 @end smallexample
29304
29305 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
29306 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
29307 structure is of size 64 bytes.
29308
29309 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
29310 range of values.
29311
29312 @table @code
29313
29314 @item st_dev
29315 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
29316
29317 @item st_ino
29318 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
29319
29320 @item st_mode
29321 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
29322 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
29323
29324 @item st_uid
29325 @itemx st_gid
29326 @itemx st_rdev
29327 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
29328
29329 @item st_atime
29330 @itemx st_mtime
29331 @itemx st_ctime
29332 These values have a host and file system dependent
29333 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
29334 support exact timing values.
29335 @end table
29336
29337 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
29338 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
29339 continuing.
29340
29341 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
29342 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
29343 get truncated on the target.
29344
29345 @node struct timeval
29346 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
29347 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
29348
29349 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
29350 is defined as follows:
29351
29352 @smallexample
29353 struct timeval @{
29354 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
29355 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
29356 @};
29357 @end smallexample
29358
29359 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
29360 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
29361 structure is of size 8 bytes.
29362
29363 @node Constants
29364 @subsection Constants
29365 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
29366
29367 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
29368 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
29369 values before and after the call as needed.
29370
29371 @menu
29372 * Open Flags::
29373 * mode_t Values::
29374 * Errno Values::
29375 * Lseek Flags::
29376 * Limits::
29377 @end menu
29378
29379 @node Open Flags
29380 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
29381 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
29382
29383 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
29384
29385 @smallexample
29386 O_RDONLY 0x0
29387 O_WRONLY 0x1
29388 O_RDWR 0x2
29389 O_APPEND 0x8
29390 O_CREAT 0x200
29391 O_TRUNC 0x400
29392 O_EXCL 0x800
29393 @end smallexample
29394
29395 @node mode_t Values
29396 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
29397 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
29398
29399 All values are given in octal representation.
29400
29401 @smallexample
29402 S_IFREG 0100000
29403 S_IFDIR 040000
29404 S_IRUSR 0400
29405 S_IWUSR 0200
29406 S_IXUSR 0100
29407 S_IRGRP 040
29408 S_IWGRP 020
29409 S_IXGRP 010
29410 S_IROTH 04
29411 S_IWOTH 02
29412 S_IXOTH 01
29413 @end smallexample
29414
29415 @node Errno Values
29416 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
29417 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
29418
29419 All values are given in decimal representation.
29420
29421 @smallexample
29422 EPERM 1
29423 ENOENT 2
29424 EINTR 4
29425 EBADF 9
29426 EACCES 13
29427 EFAULT 14
29428 EBUSY 16
29429 EEXIST 17
29430 ENODEV 19
29431 ENOTDIR 20
29432 EISDIR 21
29433 EINVAL 22
29434 ENFILE 23
29435 EMFILE 24
29436 EFBIG 27
29437 ENOSPC 28
29438 ESPIPE 29
29439 EROFS 30
29440 ENAMETOOLONG 91
29441 EUNKNOWN 9999
29442 @end smallexample
29443
29444 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
29445 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
29446
29447 @node Lseek Flags
29448 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
29449 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
29450
29451 @smallexample
29452 SEEK_SET 0
29453 SEEK_CUR 1
29454 SEEK_END 2
29455 @end smallexample
29456
29457 @node Limits
29458 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
29459 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
29460
29461 All values are given in decimal representation.
29462
29463 @smallexample
29464 INT_MIN -2147483648
29465 INT_MAX 2147483647
29466 UINT_MAX 4294967295
29467 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
29468 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
29469 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
29470 @end smallexample
29471
29472 @node File-I/O Examples
29473 @subsection File-I/O Examples
29474 @cindex file-i/o examples
29475
29476 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
29477 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
29478
29479 @smallexample
29480 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
29481 @emph{request memory read from target}
29482 -> @code{m1234,6}
29483 <- XXXXXX
29484 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
29485 -> @code{F6}
29486 @end smallexample
29487
29488 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
29489 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
29490
29491 @smallexample
29492 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29493 @emph{request memory write to target}
29494 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
29495 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
29496 -> @code{F6}
29497 @end smallexample
29498
29499 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
29500 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
29501
29502 @smallexample
29503 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29504 -> @code{F-1,9}
29505 @end smallexample
29506
29507 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
29508 host is called:
29509
29510 @smallexample
29511 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29512 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
29513 <- @code{T02}
29514 @end smallexample
29515
29516 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
29517 host is called:
29518
29519 @smallexample
29520 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29521 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
29522 <- @code{T02}
29523 @end smallexample
29524
29525 @node Library List Format
29526 @section Library List Format
29527 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
29528
29529 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
29530 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
29531 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
29532 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
29533 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
29534 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
29535 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
29536 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
29537 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
29538 are loaded.
29539
29540 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
29541 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
29542 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
29543 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
29544
29545 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
29546 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
29547 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
29548 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
29549 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
29550 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
29551
29552 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
29553 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
29554
29555 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
29556 offset, looks like this:
29557
29558 @smallexample
29559 <library-list>
29560 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
29561 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
29562 </library>
29563 </library-list>
29564 @end smallexample
29565
29566 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
29567 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
29568
29569 @smallexample
29570 <library-list>
29571 <library name="sharedlib.o">
29572 <section address="0x10000000"/>
29573 <section address="0x20000000"/>
29574 <section address="0x30000000"/>
29575 </library>
29576 </library-list>
29577 @end smallexample
29578
29579 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
29580
29581 @smallexample
29582 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
29583 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
29584 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
29585 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
29586 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
29587 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
29588 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
29589 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
29590 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
29591 @end smallexample
29592
29593 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
29594 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
29595 section for each library.
29596
29597 @node Memory Map Format
29598 @section Memory Map Format
29599 @cindex memory map format
29600
29601 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
29602 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
29603 memory map.
29604
29605 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
29606 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
29607 lists memory regions.
29608
29609 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
29610 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
29611
29612 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
29613
29614 @smallexample
29615 <?xml version="1.0"?>
29616 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
29617 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
29618 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
29619 <memory-map>
29620 region...
29621 </memory-map>
29622 @end smallexample
29623
29624 Each region can be either:
29625
29626 @itemize
29627
29628 @item
29629 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
29630 bytes from there:
29631
29632 @smallexample
29633 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
29634 @end smallexample
29635
29636
29637 @item
29638 A region of read-only memory:
29639
29640 @smallexample
29641 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
29642 @end smallexample
29643
29644
29645 @item
29646 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
29647 bytes in length:
29648
29649 @smallexample
29650 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
29651 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
29652 </memory>
29653 @end smallexample
29654
29655 @end itemize
29656
29657 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
29658 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
29659 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
29660
29661 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
29662
29663 @smallexample
29664 <!-- ................................................... -->
29665 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
29666 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
29667 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
29668 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
29669 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
29670 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
29671 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
29672 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
29673 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
29674 and its type, or device. -->
29675 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
29676 start CDATA #REQUIRED
29677 length CDATA #REQUIRED
29678 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
29679 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
29680 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
29681 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
29682 @end smallexample
29683
29684 @include agentexpr.texi
29685
29686 @node Target Descriptions
29687 @appendix Target Descriptions
29688 @cindex target descriptions
29689
29690 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
29691 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
29692 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
29693
29694 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
29695 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
29696 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
29697 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
29698 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
29699 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
29700 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
29701
29702 @itemize @bullet
29703 @item
29704 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
29705 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
29706 @item
29707 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
29708 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
29709 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
29710 @item
29711 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
29712 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
29713 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
29714 @end itemize
29715
29716 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
29717 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
29718 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
29719 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
29720 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
29721
29722 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
29723 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
29724
29725 @menu
29726 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
29727 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
29728 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
29729 descriptions.
29730 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
29731 @end menu
29732
29733 @node Retrieving Descriptions
29734 @section Retrieving Descriptions
29735
29736 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
29737 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
29738 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
29739 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
29740 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
29741 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
29742 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
29743 Format}.
29744
29745 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
29746 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
29747 specify a file are:
29748
29749 @table @code
29750 @cindex set tdesc filename
29751 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
29752 Read the target description from @var{path}.
29753
29754 @cindex unset tdesc filename
29755 @item unset tdesc filename
29756 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
29757 will use the description supplied by the current target.
29758
29759 @cindex show tdesc filename
29760 @item show tdesc filename
29761 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
29762 @end table
29763
29764
29765 @node Target Description Format
29766 @section Target Description Format
29767 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
29768
29769 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
29770 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
29771 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
29772 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
29773 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
29774 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
29775 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
29776
29777 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
29778 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
29779 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
29780 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
29781
29782 Here is a simple target description:
29783
29784 @smallexample
29785 <target version="1.0">
29786 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
29787 </target>
29788 @end smallexample
29789
29790 @noindent
29791 This minimal description only says that the target uses
29792 the x86-64 architecture.
29793
29794 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
29795 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
29796 are explained further below.
29797
29798 @smallexample
29799 <?xml version="1.0"?>
29800 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
29801 <target version="1.0">
29802 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
29803 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
29804 </target>
29805 @end smallexample
29806
29807 @noindent
29808 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
29809 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
29810 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
29811 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
29812 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
29813 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
29814 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
29815 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
29816 the version mismatch.
29817
29818 @subsection Inclusion
29819 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
29820 @cindex XInclude
29821 @ifnotinfo
29822 @cindex <xi:include>
29823 @end ifnotinfo
29824
29825 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
29826 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
29827 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
29828 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
29829 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
29830
29831 @smallexample
29832 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
29833 @end smallexample
29834
29835 @noindent
29836 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
29837 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
29838 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
29839 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
29840 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
29841 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
29842 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
29843 original description.
29844
29845 @subsection Architecture
29846 @cindex <architecture>
29847
29848 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
29849
29850 @smallexample
29851 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
29852 @end smallexample
29853
29854 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
29855 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
29856 Debugging Target}).
29857
29858 @subsection Features
29859 @cindex <feature>
29860
29861 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
29862 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
29863 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
29864 has this form:
29865
29866 @smallexample
29867 <feature name="@var{name}">
29868 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
29869 @var{reg}@dots{}
29870 </feature>
29871 @end smallexample
29872
29873 @noindent
29874 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
29875 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
29876 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
29877 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
29878
29879 @subsection Types
29880
29881 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
29882 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
29883 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
29884 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
29885 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
29886
29887 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
29888 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
29889 Types must be defined before they are used.
29890
29891 @cindex <vector>
29892 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
29893 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
29894 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
29895 @var{count}:
29896
29897 @smallexample
29898 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
29899 @end smallexample
29900
29901 @cindex <union>
29902 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
29903 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
29904 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
29905 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
29906
29907 @smallexample
29908 <union id="@var{id}">
29909 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
29910 @dots{}
29911 </union>
29912 @end smallexample
29913
29914 @subsection Registers
29915 @cindex <reg>
29916
29917 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
29918
29919 @smallexample
29920 <reg name="@var{name}"
29921 bitsize="@var{size}"
29922 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
29923 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
29924 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
29925 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
29926 @end smallexample
29927
29928 @noindent
29929 The components are as follows:
29930
29931 @table @var
29932
29933 @item name
29934 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
29935
29936 @item bitsize
29937 The register's size, in bits.
29938
29939 @item regnum
29940 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
29941 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
29942 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
29943 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
29944 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
29945 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
29946 in order of increasing register number.
29947
29948 @item save-restore
29949 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
29950 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
29951 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
29952 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
29953 ABI.
29954
29955 @item type
29956 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
29957 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
29958 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
29959 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
29960 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
29961 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
29962
29963 @item group
29964 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
29965 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
29966 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
29967 in @code{info registers}.
29968
29969 @end table
29970
29971 @node Predefined Target Types
29972 @section Predefined Target Types
29973 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
29974
29975 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
29976 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
29977 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
29978 types. The currently supported types are:
29979
29980 @table @code
29981
29982 @item int8
29983 @itemx int16
29984 @itemx int32
29985 @itemx int64
29986 @itemx int128
29987 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
29988
29989 @item uint8
29990 @itemx uint16
29991 @itemx uint32
29992 @itemx uint64
29993 @itemx uint128
29994 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
29995
29996 @item code_ptr
29997 @itemx data_ptr
29998 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
29999 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
30000 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
30001 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
30002 may be marked as data pointers.
30003
30004 @item ieee_single
30005 Single precision IEEE floating point.
30006
30007 @item ieee_double
30008 Double precision IEEE floating point.
30009
30010 @item arm_fpa_ext
30011 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
30012
30013 @end table
30014
30015 @node Standard Target Features
30016 @section Standard Target Features
30017 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
30018
30019 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
30020 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
30021 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
30022 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
30023 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
30024 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
30025 can recognize them.
30026
30027 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
30028 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
30029 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
30030 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
30031 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
30032 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
30033 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
30034 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
30035
30036 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
30037 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
30038 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
30039
30040 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
30041 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
30042 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
30043 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
30044
30045 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
30046 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
30047 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
30048
30049 @menu
30050 * ARM Features::
30051 * MIPS Features::
30052 * M68K Features::
30053 * PowerPC Features::
30054 @end menu
30055
30056
30057 @node ARM Features
30058 @subsection ARM Features
30059 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
30060
30061 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
30062 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
30063 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
30064
30065 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
30066 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
30067
30068 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
30069 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
30070 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
30071 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
30072
30073 @node MIPS Features
30074 @subsection MIPS Features
30075 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
30076
30077 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
30078 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
30079 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
30080 on the target.
30081
30082 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
30083 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
30084 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
30085
30086 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
30087 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
30088 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
30089 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
30090
30091 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
30092 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
30093 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
30094
30095 @node M68K Features
30096 @subsection M68K Features
30097 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
30098
30099 @table @code
30100 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
30101 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
30102 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
30103 One of those features must be always present.
30104 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
30105 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
30106 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
30107 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
30108
30109 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
30110 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
30111 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
30112 @samp{fpiaddr}.
30113 @end table
30114
30115 @node PowerPC Features
30116 @subsection PowerPC Features
30117 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
30118
30119 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
30120 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
30121 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
30122 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
30123
30124 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
30125 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
30126
30127 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
30128 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
30129 and @samp{vrsave}.
30130
30131 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
30132 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
30133 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
30134 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
30135 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
30136 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
30137
30138 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
30139 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
30140 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
30141 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
30142 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
30143 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
30144 user.
30145
30146 @node Operating System Information
30147 @appendix Operating System Information
30148 @cindex operating system information
30149
30150 @menu
30151 * Process list::
30152 @end menu
30153
30154 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
30155 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
30156 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
30157 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
30158 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
30159 on a different aspect of target.
30160
30161 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
30162 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
30163 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
30164 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
30165
30166 @node Process list
30167 @appendixsection Process list
30168 @cindex operating system information, process list
30169
30170 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
30171 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
30172 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
30173 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
30174
30175 An example document is:
30176
30177 @smallexample
30178 <?xml version="1.0"?>
30179 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
30180 <osdata type="processes">
30181 <item>
30182 <column name="pid">1</column>
30183 <column name="user">root</column>
30184 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
30185 </item>
30186 </osdata>
30187 @end smallexample
30188
30189 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
30190 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
30191 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
30192 displayed by @value{GDBN}. Target may provide additional columns,
30193 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
30194
30195 @include gpl.texi
30196
30197 @raisesections
30198 @include fdl.texi
30199 @lowersections
30200
30201 @node Index
30202 @unnumbered Index
30203
30204 @printindex cp
30205
30206 @tex
30207 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
30208 % meantime:
30209 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
30210 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
30211 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
30212 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
30213 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
30214 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
30215 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
30216 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
30217 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
30218 \page\colophon
30219 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
30220 @end tex
30221
30222 @bye
This page took 0.745373 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.